Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
.
Contents
AVR-X7200W
INTEGRATED NETWORK AV RECEIVER
Owner’s Manual
You can print more than one page of a PDF onto a single sheet of paper.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
1
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
8
9
9
10
10
11
14
15
15
19
21
24
Accessories
Inserting the batteries
Operating range of the remote control unit
Features
High quality sound
High performance
Easy operation
Part names and functions
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
Remote control unit
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
Appendix
Connecting a playback device
Connecting a set-top box (Satellite tuner/cable TV)
Connecting a DVD player or Blu-ray Disc player
Connecting a Blu-ray Disc player compatible with the Denon Link
HD function
Connecting a video camcorder or game console
Connecting a turntable
Connecting a device with a multi-channel output connector
Connecting an iPod or USB memory device to the USB port
Connecting an FM/AM antenna
Connecting to a home network (LAN)
Wired LAN
Wireless LAN
Connecting an external control device
REMOTE CONTROL jacks
TRIGGER OUT jacks
Connecting the power cord
Connections
Connecting speakers
Speaker installation
Speaker connection
Speaker configuration and “Amp Assign” settings
Connecting a TV
Connection 1 : TV equipped with an HDMI connector and
compatible with the ARC (Audio Return Channel)
Connection 2 : TV equipped with an HDMI connector and
incompatible with the ARC (Audio Return Channel)
Connection 3 : TV equipped without an HDMI connector
Tips
29
29
36
39
56
57
58
59
2
Remote
Index
60
61
62
63
64
65
66
67
70
72
72
73
74
74
75
76
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Playback
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
Appendix
Listening to FM/AM broadcasts
Listening to FM/AM broadcasts
Tuning in by entering the frequency (Direct Tune)
RDS search
PTY search
TP search
Radio Text
Changing the tune mode (Tune Mode)
Tuning in to stations and presetting them automatically (Auto
Preset Memory)
Presetting the current broadcast station (Preset Memory)
Listening to preset stations
Specify a name for the preset broadcast station (Preset Name)
Skipping preset broadcast stations (Preset Skip)
Cancelling Preset Skip
Listening to Internet Radio
Listening to Internet Radio
Playing the last played Internet Radio station
Using vTuner to add Internet Radio stations to favorites
Playing back files stored on a PC and NAS
Applying media sharing settings
Playing back files stored on a PC and NAS
78
78
78
79
79
79
80
81
82
83
84
84
85
86
88
89
90
92
Basic operation
Turning the power on
Selecting the input source
Adjusting the volume
Turning off the sound temporarily (Muting)
Playback a DVD player/Blu-ray Disc player
Playing an iPod
Listening to music on an iPod
iPod Browse Mode settings
Setting the USB port to use (USB Select)
Performing repeat playback
Performing random playback
Playing a USB memory device
Playing files stored on USB memory devices
Listening to music on a Bluetooth device
Pairing with a Bluetooth device
Playing a Bluetooth device
Pairing with the Pairing Mode
Tips
3
Remote
Index
93
94
96
96
97
98
98
99
99
100
100
101
102
103
104
105
106
107
108
109
110
Contents
Connections
Playback
Viewing photographs on the Flickr site
Viewing photographs shared by particular users
Viewing all photographs on Flickr
AirPlay function
Playing songs from your iPhone, iPod touch or iPad
Playing iTunes music with this unit
Selecting multiple speakers (devices)
Perform iTunes playback operations with the remote control unit
of this unit
Spotify Connect function
Playing Spotify music with this unit
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
Settings
112
113
115
116
117
117
118
Tips
Appendix
Convenience functions
Performing repeat playback
Performing random playback
Registering to Favorites
Playing back content added to the “Save to Favorites”
Deleting content added to favorites
Searching content with keywords (Text Search)
Playing back music and a favorite picture at the same time
(Slideshow)
Setting the Slideshow Interval
Adjusting the audibility of dialog and vocals (Dialog Enhancer)
Adjusting the volume of each channel to match the input source
(Channel Level Adjust)
Adjusting the tone (Tone)
Displaying your desired video during audio playback (Video
Select)
Adjusting the picture quality for your viewing environment (Picture
Mode)
Playing the same music in all zones (All Zone Stereo)
118
119
119
4
Remote
Index
120
121
121
122
122
123
123
124
125
125
126
127
128
129
130
Contents
Connections
Playback
Display
Rear panel
Tips
Appendix
Settings
131
132
133
133
134
146
146
147
148
149
150
151
152
152
154
154
159
Selecting a sound mode
Selecting a sound mode
Direct playback
Pure Direct playback
Auto surround playback
HDMI control function
Setting procedure
Sleep timer function
Using the sleep timer
Quick select plus function
Calling up the settings
Changing the settings
Web control function
Controlling the unit from a web control
Playback in ZONE2/ZONE3 (Separate room)
Connecting ZONE
Playback in ZONE2/ZONE3
Front panel
Settings
161
164
165
166
166
167
167
167
168
173
174
174
175
179
181
181
183
188
192
193
194
Menu map
Menu operations
Inputting characters
Using the keyboard screen
Using the number buttons
Audio
Subwoofer Level Adjust
Bass Sync
Surround Parameter
Restorer
Audio Delay
Volume
Audyssey
Graphic EQ
Video
Picture Adjust
HDMI Setup
Output Settings
Analog Video Out
On Screen Display
TV Format
5
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
195
195
197
197
197
198
200
200
202
208
210
211
211
230
234
235
236
237
238
238
Inputs
Input Assign
Source Rename
Hide Sources
Source Level
Input Select
Speakers
Audyssey® Setup
Procedure for speaker settings (Audyssey® Setup)
Error messages
Retrieving Audyssey® Setup settings
Manual Setup
Amp Assign
Speaker Config.
Distances
Levels
Crossovers
Bass
Front Speaker
2ch Playback
Front panel
Display
Settings
Rear panel
Tips
241
241
241
242
244
245
246
246
247
248
248
248
250
252
252
252
253
253
254
255
256
258
Network
Information
Connection
Wi-Fi Setup
Settings
IP Control
Friendly Name
Diagnostics
Maintenance Mode
General
Language
ECO
ZONE2 Setup / ZONE3 Setup
Zone Rename
Quick Select Names
Remote ID
Trigger Out 1 / Trigger Out 2
Front Display
Information
Usage Data
Firmware
Setup Lock
6
Remote
Appendix
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Operating external devices with the remote control unit
Registering preset codes
Operating devices
Operating learning function
Operating macro function
Specifying the zone used with the remote control unit
Setting the Remote ID
Setting the display time length of the remote control unit display
Setting the back light
Restoring all settings of the remote control unit to default
Settings
Front panel
About HDMI
Video conversion function
Playing back a USB memory devices
Playing back a Bluetooth device
Playing back a file saved on a PC or NAS
Playing back Internet Radio
Personal memory plus function
Last function memory
Sound modes and channel output
Sound modes and surround parameters
Types of input signals, and corresponding sound modes
Explanation of terms
Trademark information
Specifications
Index
License
278
280
298
Display
Rear panel
Appendix
Appendix
259
260
264
267
270
274
275
275
276
276
Tips
Tips
Troubleshooting
Resetting factory settings
Tips
7
Remote
Index
299
302
304
305
306
307
307
307
308
310
313
316
328
330
336
339
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Thank you for purchasing this Denon product.
To ensure proper operation, please read this owner’s manual carefully before using the product.
After reading this manual, be sure to keep it for future reference.
Accessories
CD-ROM
(Owner’s Manual)
Safety Instructions
Notes on radio
Cable labels
.
.
.
.
.
Quick Start Guide
.
.
.
.
.
Check that the following parts are supplied with the product.
FM indoor antenna
Remote control unit
(RC-1194)
R6P/AA batteries
AM loop antenna
Sound calibration
microphone
(ACM1HB)
.
.
.
Power cord
Front panel
Display
External antennas for
Bluetooth/wireless
connectivity
Rear panel
8
Remote
Index
Sound calibration
microphone stand
Connections
Contents
Playback
Settings
Inserting the batteries
2
Appendix
NOTE
0 To prevent damage or leakage of battery fluid:
0 Do not use a new battery together with an old one.
0 Do not use two different types of batteries.
0 Remove the batteries from the remote control unit if it will not be in use for long
periods.
0 If the battery fluid should leak, carefully wipe the fluid off the inside of the battery
compartment and insert new batteries.
Slide the rear cover off the remote control unit in the
arrow direction.
Operating range of the remote control
unit
.
1
Tips
Insert two batteries correctly into the battery
compartment as indicated.
Point the remote control unit at the remote sensor when operating it.
R6P/AA batteries
Approx. 7 m
30°
.
30°
Put the rear cover back on.
.
3
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
9
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Features
0 Discrete subwoofers and Audyssey Sub EQ HT™ (v p. 201)
High quality sound
The unit has two subwoofer output capability and can adjust the level
and delay for each subwoofer individually.
Audyssey Sub EQ HT™ makes the integration seamless by first
compensating for any level and delay differences between the two
subwoofers and then applying Audyssey MultEQ® XT32 to both
subwoofers together for improved deep bass response and detail.
0 DTS Neo:X (v p. 320)
This technology enables the playback of 2-channel source audio or
7.1/5.1 multi-channel source audio through a maximum 11.1-channel
speakers, achieving an even broader soundstage.
0 Denon’s unique high quality playback technology “Denon Link
HD” (v p. 63)
This unit is equipped with our exclusive “Denon Link HD” technology.
When connected to a Denon disc player that has Denon Link HD, the
sound localization becomes more precise, with increased detail and
definition. The system works by carrying the critical clock timing signals
via the dedicated Denon Link HD connection, minimizing the jitter
caused by conventional digital connections. This effect can be applied
to an audio source of any media from a Blu-ray disc player.
0 With discrete circuit technology, the power amplifier provides
identical quality for all 9-channels (190 Watts x 9-channels)
For optimum realism and stunning dynamic range, the power amplifier
section features discrete power devices (not integrated circuitry).
By using high current, high power discrete power devices, the amplifier
is able to easily drive high quality speakers.
0 Dolby Atmos (v p. 317)
This unit is equipped with a decoder that supports Dolby Atmos, a
completely new audio format. The placement or movement of sound is
accurately reproduced by the addition of overhead speakers, enabling
you to experience an incredibly natural and realistic surround sound
field.
0 Audyssey DSX® (v p. 178)
This unit is equipped with Audyssey DSX® processor. By connecting
front height speakers to this unit and playing back with Audyssey DSX®
processing you can experience a more vertically expansive front
soundstage. By connecting two front wide speakers, you can
experience a wider and more expanded front soundstage.
0 Audyssey LFC™ (Low Frequency Containment) (v p. 177)
Audyssey LFC™ solves the problem of low frequency sounds
disturbing people in neighboring rooms or apartments. Audyssey
LFC™ dynamically monitors the audio content and removes the low
frequencies that pass through walls, floors and ceilings. It then applies
psychoacoustic processing to restore the perception of low bass for
listeners in the room. The result is great sound that no longer disturbs
the neighbors.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
10
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Appendix
0 Digital video processor upscales analog video signals (SD
High performance
resolution) to HD (720p/1080p) and 4K (v p. 190)
0 4K 60Hz input/output supported
4K 60p
4:4:4
4K
4K
Up to 1080p
4K
Up scaling
.
4K 60p
4:4:4
Tips
.
This unit is equipped with a 4K video upscaling function that allows
analog video or SD (Standard Definition) video to be output via HDMI at
4K (3840 × 2160 pixels) resolution. This function enables the device to
be connected to a TV using a single HDMI cable, and produces high
definition images for any video source.
When 4K Ultra HD (High Definition) is used, an input/output speed of 60
frames per second (60p) is achieved for video signals. When connected
to 4K Ultra HD and 60p video signal input compatible TV, you can enjoy
the sense of realism only available from high-definition images, even
when viewing fast-moving video.
This unit also supports image processing for 4K 60p, 4:4:4 and 24-bit
videos. By processing the video at the original resolution, this unit lets
you enjoy flawless, high-definition picture quality.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
0 Equipped with HDMI ZONE2 output (v p. 154)
The ZONE2 multi-room output includes an HDMI output that lets you
enjoy a different A/V source in that room, with another program playing
in the main room.
11
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
0 HDMI connections enable connection to various digital AV
Appendix
0 The device is equipped with a AirPlay® function in addition to
devices (8 inputs, 3 output)
/
Tips
network functions such as Internet radio etc. (v p. 116)
8 3
Out
.
In
.
You can enjoy a wide variety of content, including listening to Internet
Radio, playing audio files stored on your PC, and displaying
photographs stored on your PC on our television.
This unit also supports Apple AirPlay which lets you stream your music
library from an iPhone®, iPad®, iPod touch® or iTunes®.
For connection to a broad range of digital sources, this unit features 8
HDMI inputs, including 1 on the front panel that lets you quickly and
conveniently connect a camcorder, game console or other HDMIequipped device. There are dual HDMI outputs for the main room, and a
third HDMI output for another room.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
0 Playback of DSD and FLAC files via USB and networks
This unit supports the playback of high resolution audio formats such as
DSD (2.8 MHz) and FLAC 192 kHz files. It provides high quality
playback of high resolution files.
12
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
0 Wireless connection with Bluetooth devices can be carried out
Tips
Appendix
0 Multi-Room audio (v p. 130)
easily (v p. 88)
【MAIN ZONE】
.
【ZONE2】/【ZONE3】
.
You can select and play back the respective inputs in MAIN ZONE,
ZONE2 and ZONE3.
In addition, when the All Zone Stereo function is used, the music being
played back in MAIN ZONE can be enjoyed in all the zones at the same
time. This is useful when you want to let the BGM propagate throughout
the whole house.
You can enjoy music simply by connecting wirelessly with your
smartphone, tablet, PC, etc.
0 Compatible with the “Denon Remote App”z for performing basic
operations of the unit with an iPad, iPhone or Android™ devices
(Google, Amazon Kindle Fire)
“Denon Remote App” is application software that allows you to perform
basic operations with an iPad, iPhone, Android smartphone or Android
tablet such as turning the unit ON/OFF, controlling the volume, and
switching the source.
0 Energy-saving design
This unit is equipped with an ECO Mode function that allows you to
enjoy music and movies while reducing the power consumption during
use, and also an auto-standby function that automatically turns off the
power supply when the unit is not in use. This helps reduce
unnecessary power use.
z Download the appropriate “Denon Remote App” for your iOS or Android
devices. This unit needs to be connected to the same LAN or Wi-Fi (wireless
LAN) network that the iPhone or iPod touch is connected to.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
13
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Easy operation
0 “Setup Assistant” provides easy-to-follow setup instructions
First select the language when prompted. Then simply follow the
instructions displayed on the TV screen to set up the speakers, network,
etc.
0 Easy to use Graphical User Interface
This unit is equipped with a Graphical User Interface for improved
operability.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
14
Remote
Index
Appendix
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Part names and functions
Front panel
A
B
q w
C
e
D
r
E
t
F
y
.
G
u
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
15
Remote
Index
Contents
qw
e r
Connections
Playback
t
Settings
Tips
Appendix
C SOURCE SELECT knob
This selects the input source. (v p. 78)
y
D Remote control sensor
This receives signals from the remote control unit. (v p. 9)
E Display
This displays various pieces of information. (v p. 19)
.
F MASTER VOLUME knob
This adjusts the volume level. (v p. 79)
G Door
When you are using buttons and/or connectors behind the door, press
the bottom of the door to open it. Be careful not to catch your fingers
when closing the door.
u
A Power operation button (X)
Used to turn the power of the MAIN ZONE (room where this unit is
located) on/off (standby). (v p. 78)
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
.
B Power indicator
This is lit as follows according to the power status:
0 Green : Power on
0 Off: Normal standby
0 Red:
0 When “HDMI Pass Through” is set to “On” (v p. 185)
0 When “HDMI Control” is set to “On” (v p. 186)
0 When “IP Control” is set to “Always On” (v p. 245)
16
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
With the door open
q w e
r t y u i o
Tips
Appendix
E STATUS button
Each press of this switches the status information that is shown on the
display. (v p. 82)
Q0
F Information button (INFO)
This displays the status information on the TV screen. (v p. 255)
G Cursor buttons (uio p)
These select items. (v p. 164)
H OPTION button
This displays the option menu on the TV screen. (v p. 120)
I DIMMER button
Each press of this switches the brightness of the display. (v p. 253)
.
J QUICK SELECT buttons
These call up settings registered to each button, such as input source,
volume level and sound mode settings. (v p. 149)
A ZONE2 ON/OFF button
This turns the power of ZONE2 on/off. (v p. 159)
B ZONE2 SOURCE button
This selects the input source for ZONE2. (v p. 159)
C ZONE3 ON/OFF button
This turns the power of ZONE3 on/off. (v p. 159)
D ZONE3 SOURCE button
This selects the input source for ZONE3. (v p. 159)
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
17
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
N BACK button
This returns to the previous screen. (v p. 164)
O ENTER button
This determines the selection. (v p. 164)
.
P SETUP button
This displays the menu on the TV screen. (v p. 164)
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Q5 Q6
Q7
Q AUX1 INPUT connector
Used to connect analog output compatible devices such as video
camcorders and game consoles. (v p. 64)
Q8
R SETUP MIC jack
This is used to connect the supplied Sound calibration microphone.
(v p. 203)
K AUX1 HDMI connector
This is used to connect HDMI output compatible devices such as video
camcorders and game consoles. (v p. 64)
L USB port
This is used to connect USB storages (such as USB memory devices)
and the USB cable supplied with iPod. (v p. 67)
M Headphones jack (PHONES)
This is used to connect headphones.
When the headphones are plugged into this jack, audio will no longer
be output from the connected speakers or from the PRE OUT
connectors.
NOTE
To prevent hearing loss, do not raise the volume level excessively when using
headphones.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
18
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Display
w
e
r
t
y
J
Q0
.
q
H o
I
u
Gi
K
Q1
A Input signal indicators
The respective indicator will light corresponding to the input signal.
(v p. 198)
L
Q2
B Decoder indicators
These light when Dolby or DTS signals are input or when the Dolby or
DTS decoder is running.
D Tuner reception mode indicators
These light up according to the reception conditions when the input
source is set to “Tuner”.
TUNED: Lights up when the broadcast is properly tuned in.
STEREO: Lights up when receiving FM stereo broadcasts.
RDS : Lights up when receiving RDS broadcasts.
C Audyssey® indicator
This lights when “MultEQ® XT32”, “Dynamic EQ”, “Dynamic Volume”,
“Audyssey DSX®” or “Audyssey LFCTM” is set. (v p. 175 - 178)
E Monitor output indicator
These light according to the HDMI monitor output setting. When set to
“Auto(Dual)”, the indicators light according to connection status.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
F MULTI ZONE indicator
This lights up when ZONE2 or ZONE3 (separate room) power is turned
on. (v p. 159)
19
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
.
When playing HD Audio sources, the A indicator lights when a
signal from an extension channel (a channel other than the front,
center, surround, surround back, front height, front wide or LFE
channel) is input.
Q1 Q2
G Sleep timer indicator
This lights when the sleep mode is selected. (v p. 148)
H MUTE indicator
This blinks while the sound is muted. (v p. 79, 160)
I Volume indicator
J Information display
The input source name, sound mode, setting values and other
information are displayed here.
K Front speaker indicator
This lights according to the setting of the front A and B speakers.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
Appendix
L Input/output signal channel indicators
The channel for input/output signals is displayed according to the
setting configured for “Channel Indicators”. (v p. 253)
0 When “Channel Indicators” is set to “Output” (Default)
These light when audio signals are being output from the speakers.
0 When “Channel Indicators” is set to “Input”
These light corresponding to the channels that include the input
signals.
ui o
Q0
Tips
20
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Rear panel
B
wC
e
A
q
D
r
F
y
E
t
HDMI
2 DVD
1 CBL/SAT
G i
H
u
HDMI
(ASSIGNABLE)
3 Blu-ray
4 GAME
5 MEDIA PLAYER
6 AUX2
NETWORK
MONITOR1
ZONE2
7 CD
A
q
MONITOR2
ARC
Bluetooth/Wi-Fi
ANTENNA
Denon Link HD
FM
1 CBL/SAT
FRONT
4 GAME
SURROUND BACK
FRONT
CENTER
FRONT WIDE
SURROUND
SUBWOOFER
1
HEIGHT1
1 CBL/SAT 4 GAME
1 CBL/SAT
2 DVD
Bluetooth/Wi-Fi
ANTENNA
3 Blu-ray MONITOR/ZONE3 ZONE2
Y
2 DVD
5 CD
SURROUND
CENTER
SUBWOOFER
AM
7.1CH IN
SIGNAL
GND
3 Blu-ray
ANTENNA
AUDIO
6 MEDIA PLAYER
1
ZONE2
STRAIGHT CABLE
2
PB/
CB
SURROUND BACK
2 DVD 1 TV
AUDIO
AC IN
PR/
CR
HEIGHT2
PRE OUT
1 CBL/SAT
5V/1A
MONITOR/ZONE3
2
ZONE3
(ASSIGNABLE)
DC12V 150mA MAX.
2 DVD
3 Blu-ray
ZONE2
VIDEO VIDEO
2 CD
COMPONENT VIDEO
COMPONENT VIDEO
(ASSIGNABLE)
(ASSIGNABLE)
IR
PHONO
AUDIO
FRONT
TRIGGER OUT
REMOTE CONTROL
FRONT
RS-232C
CENTER
COAXIAL
DIGITAL AUDIO
SURROUND
OPTICAL
(ASSIGNABLE)
SURROUND
SURROUND BACK
SURROUND BACK
FRONT WIDE/HEIGHT2
ASSIGNABLE
FRONT WIDE/HEIGHT2
ASSIGNABLE
SPEAKERS
.
J
Q0
Front panel
D
r
K
Q1
L
Q2
Display
M
Q3
N
Q4
Rear panel
O
Q5
P
Q6
21
HEIGHT1
ASSIGNABLE
IMPEDANCE : 4㹼16Ȑ
Q
Q7
Remote
HEIGHT1
R
Q8
Index
I
o
Contents
Connections
r q we r
y
t
HDMI
2 DVD
1 CBL/SAT
Playback
HDMI
5 MEDIA PLAYER
4 GAME
6 AUX2
NETWORK
MONITOR1
ZONE2
7 CD
MONITOR2
ARC
Bluetooth/Wi-Fi
ANTENNA
Denon Link HD
FM
1 CBL/SAT
FRONT
4 GAME
FRONT
CENTER
FRONT WIDE
SURROUND
SUBWOOFER
1
HEIGHT1
2 DVD
HEIGHT2
3 Blu-ray
SURROUND BACK
1 CBL/SAT 4 GAME
1 CBL/SAT
2 DVD
Bluetooth/Wi-Fi
ANTENNA
3 Blu-ray MONITOR/ZONE3 ZONE2
Y
2 DVD
5 CD
SURROUND
CENTER
SUBWOOFER
AM
7.1CH IN
SIGNAL
GND
3 Blu-ray
ANTENNA
AUDIO
6 MEDIA PLAYER
STRAIGHT CABLE
DC12V 150mA MAX.
1
2
PB/
CB
PRE OUT
2 DVD 1 TV
AUDIO
1 CBL/SAT
AC IN
PR/
CR
SURROUND BACK
ZONE3
5V/1A
MONITOR/ZONE3
2
ZONE2
(ASSIGNABLE)
ZONE2
VIDEO VIDEO
2 CD
COMPONENT VIDEO
COMPONENT VIDEO
(ASSIGNABLE)
(ASSIGNABLE)
IR
PHONO
AUDIO
FRONT
TRIGGER OUT
RS-232C
REMOTE CONTROL
FRONT
CENTER
COAXIAL
OPTICAL
DIGITAL AUDIO
SURROUND
(ASSIGNABLE)
SURROUND
SURROUND BACK
SURROUND BACK
FRONT WIDE/HEIGHT2
ASSIGNABLE
FRONT WIDE/HEIGHT2
HEIGHT1
ASSIGNABLE
SPEAKERS
HEIGHT1
ASSIGNABLE
.
IMPEDANCE : 4㹼16Ȑ
A Bluetooth/wireless LAN antenna connectors
Used to connect the included external antennas for Bluetooth/wireless
connectivity when connecting to a network via wireless LAN, or when
connecting to a handheld device via Bluetooth. (v p. 73)
A Place the external antennas for Bluetooth/wireless connectivity
evenly over the screw terminal of rear.
B Turn clockwise until the antennas is fully connected.
C Rotate the antenna upwards for best reception.
q
w
HDMI
1 CBL/SAT
2 DVD
e
HDMI
(ASSIGNABLE)
4 GAME
3 Blu-ray
5 MEDIA PLAYER
6 AUX2
NETWORK
MONITOR1
ZONE2
7 CD
Tips
MONITOR2
ARC
Bluetooth/Wi-Fi
ANTENNA
Denon Link HD
FM
1 CBL/SAT
FRONT
4 GAME
SURROUND BACK
FRONT
CENTER
FRONT WIDE
SURROUND
SUBWOOFER
1
HEIGHT1
2 DVD
HEIGHT2
3 Blu-ray
1 CBL/SAT 4 GAME
1 CBL/SAT
2 DVD
Bluetooth/Wi-Fi
ANTENNA
3 Blu-ray MONITOR/ZONE3 ZONE2
Y
2 DVD
5 CD
SURROUND
CENTER
SUBWOOFER
AM
7.1CH IN
SIGNAL
GND
3 Blu-ray
ANTENNA
AUDIO
6 MEDIA PLAYER
1
ZONE2
STRAIGHT CABLE
PRE OUT
2
1 CBL/SAT
2 DVD 1 TV
AUDIO
5V/1A
MONITOR/ZONE3
P B/
CB
2
SURROUND BACK
ZONE3
(ASSIGNABLE)
DC12V 150mA MAX.
AC IN
P R/
CR
ZONE2
VIDEO VIDEO
2 CD
(ASSIGNABLE)
COMPONENT VIDEO
COMPONENT VIDEO
(ASSIGNABLE)
IR
PHONO
AUDIO
FRONT
TRIGGER OUT
FRONT
REMOTE CONTROL
CENTER
RS-232C
COAXIAL
DIGITAL AUDIO
SURROUND
OPTICAL
(ASSIGNABLE)
SURROUND
SURROUND BACK
SURROUND BACK
ASSIGNABLE
FRONT WIDE/HEIGHT2
HEIGHT1
ASSIGNABLE
HEIGHT1
ASSIGNABLE
IMPEDANCE : 4㹼16Ȑ
.
SPEAKERS
FRONT WIDE/HEIGHT2
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
Appendix
B Denon Link HD connector
Used to connect a Denon Link HD compatible Blu-ray Disc player.
(v p. 63)
C SIGNAL GND terminal
Used to connect a ground wire for the turntable. (v p. 65)
D Analog audio connectors (AUDIO)
Used to connect devices equipped with analog audio connectors.
(v p. 61)
E 7.1-channel input connectors (7.1CH IN)
Used to connect to a device that has multi-channel audio output
connectors. (v p. 66)
F HDMI connectors
Used to connect devices equipped with HDMI connectors.
(v p. 57)
G NETWORK connector
Used to connect to a LAN cable when connecting to a wired LAN
network. (v p. 72)
H USB port
This is used to connect USB storages (such as USB memory devices)
and the USB cable supplied with iPod. (v p. 67)
I AC inlet (AC IN)
Used to connect the power cord. (v p. 76)
ui q o
(ASSIGNABLE)
3 Blu-ray
Settings
22
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
HDMI
2 DVD
1 CBL/SAT
Playback
HDMI
(ASSIGNABLE)
3 Blu-ray
4 GAME
5 MEDIA PLAYER
6 AUX2
MONITOR2
ARC
Bluetooth/Wi-Fi
ANTENNA
Denon Link HD
FM
1 CBL/SAT
FRONT
4 GAME
SURROUND BACK
FRONT
CENTER
FRONT WIDE
SURROUND
SUBWOOFER
1
HEIGHT1
1 CBL/SAT 4 GAME
1 CBL/SAT
2 DVD
Bluetooth/Wi-Fi
ANTENNA
3 Blu-ray MONITOR/ZONE3 ZONE2
Y
2 DVD
5 CD
SURROUND
CENTER
SUBWOOFER
AM
7.1CH IN
SIGNAL
GND
3 Blu-ray
ANTENNA
AUDIO
6 MEDIA PLAYER
STRAIGHT CABLE
DC12V 150mA MAX.
1
ZONE2
PRE OUT
2
1 CBL/SAT
2 DVD 1 TV
AUDIO
5V/1A
MONITOR/ZONE3
PB/
CB
2
SURROUND BACK
ZONE3
(ASSIGNABLE)
2 DVD
AC IN
PR/
CR
HEIGHT2
3 Blu-ray
ZONE2
VIDEO VIDEO
2 CD
(ASSIGNABLE)
COMPONENT VIDEO
COMPONENT VIDEO
(ASSIGNABLE)
IR
PHONO
AUDIO
FRONT
TRIGGER OUT
REMOTE CONTROL
FRONT
CENTER
RS-232C
COAXIAL
DIGITAL AUDIO
SURROUND
OPTICAL
(ASSIGNABLE)
SURROUND
SURROUND BACK
SURROUND BACK
ASSIGNABLE
FRONT WIDE/HEIGHT2
FRONT WIDE/HEIGHT2
ASSIGNABLE
SPEAKERS
.
Q0
Q1 Q2
Q3
Q4
Q5 Q6 Q7
HEIGHT1
Tips
Appendix
M RS-232C connector
Used to connect home automation controller devices fitted with
RS-232C connectors. Consult the owner’s manual of the home
automation controller for more information about serial control of this
unit.
Perform the operation below beforehand.
A Turn on the power of this unit.
B Turn off the power of this unit from the external controller.
C Check that the unit is in the standby mode.
NETWORK
MONITOR1
ZONE2
7 CD
Settings
HEIGHT1
N Digital audio connectors (DIGITAL AUDIO)
Used to connect devices equipped with digital audio connectors.
(v p. 58)
O Speaker terminals (SPEAKERS)
Used to connect speakers. (v p. 36)
P PRE OUT connectors
Used to connect a subwoofer with built-in amplifier or an external power
amplifier. (v p. 37, 55)
Q Video connectors (VIDEO)
Used to connect devices equipped with video connectors.
(v p. 59, 155)
R Component video connectors (COMPONENT VIDEO)
Used to connect devices equipped with component video connectors.
(v p. 59, 155)
ASSIGNABLE
IMPEDANCE : 4㹼16Ȑ
Q8
J FM/AM antenna terminals (ANTENNA)
Used to connect FM antennas and AM loop antennas. (v p. 70)
K TRIGGER OUT jacks
Used to connect devices equipped with the trigger function.
(v p. 75)
L REMOTE CONTROL jacks
Used to connect infrared receivers/transmitters in order to operate this
unit and external devices from a different room. (v p. 74)
NOTE
Do not touch the inner pins of the connectors on the rear panel. Electrostatic
discharge may cause permanent damage to the unit.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
23
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Remote control unit
A p indicator
This is lit when signals are sent from the remote control unit.
q
w
e
r
q
w
B Zone select button (ZONE SELECT)
These switch the zone (MAIN ZONE, ZONE2, ZONE3) that is operated
through the remote control unit. (v p. 159, 164)
t
C AVR operation button
When preset codes are registered to the remote control unit, press this
button and then operate the menu on the unit.
y
D Display
A Zone select indicators
B Information indicator
0 This displays “AVR” when operating this unit.
0 This displays the input source name when operating an external
device.
0 This displays “TV” when operating TV.
0 This displays details about the setting on the remote control unit.
E Device operation buttons (DEVICE X / DEVICE MENU)
These turn the power of external devices on/off and call up menus.
Preset codes need to be registered in order to use these buttons.
(v p. 260)
.
F Input source select buttons
These select the input source. (v p. 78, 159)
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
24
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
G QUICK SELECT buttons (1 – 4)
These call up settings registered to each button, such as input source,
volume level and sound mode settings. (v p. 149)
H Channel/page search buttons (CH/PAGE df)
These select radio stations registered to presets or switch pages.
(v p. 82, 100)
I MUTE button (:)
This mutes the output audio. (v p. 79, 159)
J Information button (INFO)
This displays the status information on the TV screen. (v p. 255)
K Cursor buttons (uio p)
These select items. (v p. 164)
u
L BACK button
This returns to the previous screen. (v p. 164)
i
M System buttons
These perform playback related operations. (v p. 82)
0 Skip buttons (8, 9)
0 Play button (1)
0 Search buttons (6, 7)
0 Pause button (3)
0 Stop button (2)
Tuning up / Tuning down buttons (TUNE +, –)
These select either FM broadcast or AM broadcast. (v p. 94)
o
Q0
Q1
Q2
.
Q3
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
25
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
N Number / Character buttons
These enter letters or numbers into the unit. (v p. 94, 166)
Q5
O Remote control signal transmitter
This transmits signals from the remote control unit. (v p. 9)
Q6
P POWER button (X)
This turns the power on/off. (v p. 78, 159)
Q TV operation buttons (TV X / TV MENU / TV INPUT)
These turn the TV power on/off, switch the TV input and call up menus.
Preset codes need to be registered in order to use these buttons.
(v p. 265)
Q7
R ECO Mode button (G)
This switches to ECO Mode. (v p. 248)
Q8
S VOLUME buttons (df)
These adjust the volume level. (v p. 79, 160)
Q9
T OPTION button
This displays the option menu on the TV screen. (v p. 120)
W0
W1
U ENTER button
This determines the selection. (v p. 164)
Q4
.
W1
Front panel
Display
Appendix
Rear panel
26
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
V SETUP button
This displays the menu on the TV screen. (v p. 164)
W SOUND MODE buttons
These select the sound mode. (v p. 131)
0 MOVIE button
0 MUSIC button
0 GAME button
0 PURE button
X SLEEP button
This sets the sleep timer. (v p. 147)
Y RC SETUP button
This used to set up the remote control unit. (v p. 259 - 276)
Z MACRO buttons (A – D)
These are used to turn on a TV or player, and consecutive series of
operations can be registered to each button. (v p. 270)
W2
W3
W4
W5
.
W6
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
27
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
o Contents
Tips
Appendix
o Cables used for connections
56
Connecting a playback device
60
Connecting an iPod or USB memory device to the USB port
67
Connecting an FM/AM antenna
70
Connecting to a home network (LAN)
72
Connecting an external control device
74
Connecting the power cord
76
Speaker cable
.
Connecting a TV
Provide necessary cables according to the devices you want to
connect.
Subwoofer cable
.
29
HDMI cable
.
Connecting speakers
NOTE
Component video cable
.
0 Do not plug in the power cord until all connections have been completed.
However, when the “Setup Assistant” is running, follow the instructions in the
“Setup Assistant” (page 9 in the separate “Quick Start Guide”) screen for making
connections. (During “Setup Assistant” operation, the input/output connectors do
not conduct current.)
0 Do not bundle power cords together with connection cables. Doing so can result in
noise.
.
Video cable
.
Coaxial digital cable
.
Optical cable
L
L
R
R
.
Audio cable
.
LAN cable
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
28
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Connecting speakers
Install speakers and connect them to this unit. (v p. 29, 36)
Speaker installation
Determine the speaker system depending on the number of speakers you
are using and install each speaker and subwoofer in the room.
Speaker installation is explained using this example of a typical
installation.
SL
FWL
FL
FR
C
FWR
SW2
C (Center
speaker):
Place the CENTER speaker in between the front
speakers and above or below your TV.
SL/SR (Surround
speaker left/right):
Place the SURROUND left and right speakers an
equal distance to the left and right sides of the main
listening position. If you don’t have surround back
speakers, move the surround speakers slightly behind
your listening position.
Place the SURROUND BACK left and right speakers
an equal distance from the main listening position and
SBL/SBR(Surround back
directly behind the main listening position. When using
speaker L/R):
a single surround back speaker (SB), place it directly
behind the listening position.
SBR
.
SB
Place the FRONT left and right speakers an equal
distance from the main listening position. The distance
between each speaker and your TV should also be the
same.
SR
SW1
SBL
FL/FR (Front
speaker left/right):
FWL/FWR
Place the FRONT WIDE left and right speakers
(Front wide speakers left/ outside of the front left and right speakers so that there
is an equal distance between all front speakers.
right):
SW 1/2 (Subwoofer) :
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
29
Remote
Place the SUBWOOFER at a convenient location near
the front speakers. If you have two subwoofers, place
them asymmetrically across the front of your room.
Index
Contents
RHL
Connections
TRL
TML
TFL
Settings
RHR
FHR
.
FHL
TRR
TMR
TFR
Playback
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
30
Tips
Appendix
FHL/FHR (Front
height speaker left/
right):
Place the FRONT HEIGHT left and right speakers
directly above the front speakers. Mount them as
close to the ceiling as possible and aim them
towards the main listening position.
TFL/TFR (Top front
speaker left/right):
Mount the TOP FRONT left and right speakers on
the ceiling slightly in front of your main listening
position and aligned with the left and right front
speakers.
TML/TMR (Top
middle speaker left/
right):
Mount the TOP MIDDLE left and right speakers
directly above the main listening position and
aligned with the left and right front speakers.
TRL/TRR (Top rear
speaker left/right):
Mount the TOP REAR left and right speakers on
the ceiling slightly behind your main listening
position and aligned with the left and right front
speakers.
RHL/RHR (Rear
height speaker left/
right):
Place the REAR HEIGHT left and right speakers
directly behind the main listening position. Mount
them as close to the ceiling as possible and
aligned with the left and right front speakers.
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
FDL
Playback
Settings
Tips
About Dolby Atmos Enabled speakers
Dolby Atmos Enabled speakers reflect the sound off the ceiling to allow
the sound to come from over your head by using a special upwardpointing speaker that is placed on the floor.
You can enjoy the Dolby Atmos 3D sound even in an environment where
speakers cannot be installed on the ceiling.
FDR
SDL
SDR
BDR
.
BDL
Place the FRONT Dolby Atmos Enabled speaker
on the front speaker. For a Dolby Atmos Enabled
integrated with a front speaker, place the Dolby
Atmos Enabled speaker instead of the front
speaker.
.
FDL/FDR (Front
Dolby speaker left/
right):
Place the SURROUND Dolby Atmos Enabled
SDL/SDR (Surround speaker on the surround speaker. For a Dolby
Dolby speaker left/
Atmos Enabled speaker integrated with a surround
right):
speaker, place the Dolby Atmos Enabled speaker
instead of the surround speaker.
BDL/BDR (Back
Dolby speaker left/
right):
Front panel
Place the BACK Dolby Atmos Enabled speaker on
the surround back speaker. For a Dolby Atmos
Enabled speaker integrated with a surround back
speaker, place the Dolby Atmos Enabled speaker
instead of the surround back speaker.
Display
Appendix
Rear panel
31
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Height speakers layout
DSX®,
0 This unit is compatible with Audyssey
Dolby Atmos and DTS Neo:X which
offers an even wider and deeper surround sensation. (v p. 316, 317, 320)
When using Audyssey DSX®, install front wide speakers or front height speakers.
0 Use the illustration below as a guide for how high each speaker should be
installed. The height does not need to be exactly the same.
TFL
Top middle speaker
Top front speaker
Top rear speaker
TML
z3
2
z
Front speaker
5
z2 30° - 55°
z5 135° - 150°
TMR
TRR
RHL
RHR
GViewed from the topH
Surround
speaker
z3 65° - 100°
.
z1 30° - 45°
z4 125° - 150°
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
TFR
SR
TRL
Surround
back
speaker
GViewed from the sideH
C
SL
Rear height
speaker
Point slightly
downwards
z
z1
Front wide
speaker
z4
FR
FL
.
Front height
speaker
Point slightly
downwards
FHR
FHL
32
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
z1
z2
FWL
z2
z1
z3
z3
SL
z2:90°
- 110°
SBR
SBL
SBR
z3:135°
SR
.
Listening
position
z1:
- 150°
22° - 30°
z2:
55° - 60°
z3:
90° - 110°
When using a single surround back speaker, place it directly behind the listening
position.
Front panel
Display
FWR
z4
SL
SR
.
- 30°
C
SW
SW C
z1:22°
FR
FL
FR
FL
Appendix
o When 9.1-channel speakers are installed using
front wide speakers
o When 7.1-channel speakers are installed using
surround back speakers
SBL
Tips
Rear panel
33
Remote
Index
z4:
135° - 150°
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
o When 5.1-channel speakers are installed
FL
FR
SW
C
z1
z2
SL
.
SR
z1:22°
Front panel
- 30°
z2:120°
Display
Rear panel
34
Remote
Index
Appendix
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
o Layout including height speakers and top
speakers
Tips
Appendix
n DTS Neo:X layout example
Combination of 9.1-channel layout with surround back/front wide
speakers, and front height speakers.
n Dolby Atmos layout example
Combination of 7.1-channel layout with surround back speaker and
top front/top rear speakers.
FHL
TRL
TFL
TFR
SL
FL
FWL
FL
SW
FR
C
C
SBL
SR
SR
SBL
SBR
SBR
.
Front panel
FWR
FR
SW
.
SL
FHR
TRR
Display
Rear panel
35
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Speaker connection
Appendix
NOTE
0 Carry out the following settings when using a speaker with an impedance of 4 – 6
Ω/ohms.
Here we connect the speakers in the room to this unit.
This section explains how to connect them using typical examples.
1. Press and hold the main unit’s o and p at the same time for at least 3 seconds.
“zVideo Format < PAL>” appears on the display.
2. Press i on the main unit twice.
NOTE
“zSp. Impedance <8ohms>” appears on the display.
0 Disconnect this unit’s power plug from the power outlet before connecting the
speakers. Also, turn off the subwoofer.
0 Connect so that the speaker cable core wires do not protrude from the speaker
terminal. The protection circuit may be activated if the core wires touch the rear
panel or if the + and - sides touch each other. (“Protection circuit” (v p. 327))
0 Never touch the speaker terminals while the power cord is connected. Doing so
could result in electric shock. When the “Setup Assistant” (page 9 in the separate
“Quick Start Guide”) is running, follow the instructions in the “Setup Assistant”
screen for making connections. (Power is not supplied to the speaker terminals
while the “Setup Assistant” is running.)
0 Use speakers with an impedance of 4 – 16 Ω/ohms.
Front panel
Tips
Display
Rear panel
3. Use o or p on the main unit to select the impedance.
6ohms:
Select when the impedance for any of the connected speakers
is 6 Ω/ohms.
4ohms:
Select when the impedance for any of the connected speakers
is 4 Ω/ohms.
4. Press the main unit’s ENTER to complete the setting.
36
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
o Connecting the speaker cables
Appendix
o Connecting the subwoofer
Carefully check the left (L) and right (R) channels and + (red) and –
(black) polarities on the speakers being connected to this unit, and be
sure to connect the channels and polarities correctly.
1
Tips
Use a subwoofer cable to connect the subwoofer. Two subwoofers can
be connected to this unit.
To use two subwoofers, set “Subwoofer” to “2 spkrs” in the “Speaker
Config.” setting. (v p. 231)
The level and distance can be set separately for Subwoofer 1 and
Subwoofer 2.
Peel off about 10 mm of sheathing from the tip of the
speaker cable, then either twist the core wire tightly or
terminate it.
1 CBL/SAT
2 DVD
FRONT
4 GAME
5 CD
SURROUND
SURROUND BACK
CENTER
SUBWOOFER
FRONT
CENTER
FRONT WIDE
SURROUND
SUBWOOFER
1
HEIGHT1
7.1CH IN
3 Blu-ray
AUDIO
6 MEDIA PLAYER
1
ZONE2
STRAIGHT CABLE
2
SURROUND BACK
ZONE3
PRE OUT
(ASSIGNABLE)
DC12V 150mA MAX.
2
1 CBL/SAT
2 DVD 1 TV
AUDIO
HEIGHT2
2 CD
.
IR
2
PHONO
AUDIO
Turn the speaker terminal counterclockwise to loosen it.
FRONT
TRIGGER OUT
REMOTE CONTROL
FRONT
CENTER
RS-232C
COAXIAL
DIGITAL AUDIO
SURROUND
OPTICAL
(ASSIGNABLE)
SURROUND
SURROUND BACK
SURROUND BACK
ASSIGNABLE
FRONT WIDE/HEIGHT2
FRONT WIDE/HEIGHT2
ASSIGNABLE
SPEAKERS
.
SW1
SW2
Turn the speaker terminal clockwise to tighten it.
.
4
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
37
Remote
Index
HEIGHT1
ASSIGNABLE
IMPEDANCE : 4㹼16Ȑ
.
Insert the speaker cable’s core wire to the hilt into the
speaker terminal.
.
3
HEIGHT1
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
o About the speaker cable label (supplied) for
channel identification
Display
Rear panel
Appendix
Attach the speaker cable label for each channel to its speaker cable as
shown in the diagram.
Refer to the table and attach the label to each speaker cable.
Then, make connection so that the color of the speaker terminal
matches that of the speaker cable label.
The channel display section for speaker terminals on the rear panel is
color-coded for each channel to be identifiable.
Speaker terminals
Color
FRONT L
White
FRONT R
Red
CENTER
Green
SURROUND L
Light blue
SURROUND R
Blue
SURROUND BACK L
Beige
SURROUND BACK R
Brown
FRONT WIDE L
Light Purple
FRONT WIDE R
Purple
FRONT HEIGHT L
Light Yellow
FRONT HEIGHT R
Yellow
TOP FRONT L
Light Yellow
TOP FRONT R
Yellow
TOP MIDDLE L
Light Purple
TOP MIDDLE R
Purple
TOP REAR L
Light Purple
TOP REAR R
Purple
REAR HEIGHT L
Light Purple
REAR HEIGHT R
Purple
FRONT DOLBY L
Light Yellow
FRONT DOLBY R
Yellow
SURROUND DOLBY L
Light Purple
SURROUND DOLBY R
Purple
BACK DOLBY L
Light Purple
BACK DOLBY R
Purple
SUBWOOFER
Black
Front panel
Tips
G How to attach the speaker cable label H
Speaker
.
This unit
38
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Speaker configuration and “Amp Assign” settings
This unit has a built-in 9-channel power amplifier. In addition to the basic 5.1-channel system, a variety of speaker systems can be configured by changing
the “Amp Assign” (v p. 211) settings to suit the application, such as 7.1-channel systems, bi-amp connections and 2-channel systems for multi-zone
playback.
Perform “Amp Assign” settings to suit the number of rooms and speaker configuration to be installed. (v p. 211)
Playback speaker in each zone
MAIN ZONE
ZONE2
Not used
Not used
Not used
Not used
Not used
Not used
Not used
Not used
2-channel
Not used
2-channel
2-channel
1-channel
Not used
Not used
5.1-channel playback
7.1-channel playback (surround back)
9.1-channel playback
11.1-channel playback
7.1-channel playback (bi-amp connection of front speakers)
9.1-channel playback + 2-channel speakers for stereo playback
7.1-channel playback + 2-channel bi-amp speakers for stereo playback
7.1-channel playback + front speakers of second unit
7.1-channel playback
7.1-channel playback
5.1-channel playback (bi-amp connection of front speakers)
5.1-channel playback
7.1-channel playback
Dolby Atmos playback
11.1-channel playback (using this unit as a pre amplifier)
ZONE3
Not used
Not used
Not used
Not used
Not used
Not used
Not used
Not used
Not used
2-channel
Not used
2-channel
1-channel
Not used
Not used
“Amp Assign” settings
Connection page
7.1ch + ZONE2
7.1ch + ZONE2
9.1ch (Default)
11.1ch
7.1ch (Bi-Amp)
9.1ch/2ch Front
7.1ch/2ch Front (Bi-Amp)
7.1ch + Front B
7.1ch + ZONE2
7.1ch + ZONE3
5.1ch (Bi-Amp) + ZONE2
5.1ch + ZONE2/3
7.1ch + ZONE2/3-MONO
Dolby Atmos
Pre Amplifier
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
49
50
51
52
53
55
The sound mode that can be selected varies according to the speaker configuration. See “Relationship between sound modes and channel output”
(v p. 308) for the sound modes that are supported.
The following pages provide basic connection examples.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
39
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
In addition to the connections described in (v p. 41 - 55), this unit allows for
various speaker connections with the “Amp Assign” setting.
Also refer to the menu screen in “View Terminal Config.” on the “Amp Assign” setting
screen, which shows how to make connections in your environment.
Speakers/Amp Assign
Assign Mode
-Height Speakers
-Height Layout
-Wide/Height2 Front Wide
-Pre-out
Top Rear
11.1ch
4 Height Speakers
Top Front & Top Rear
PRE OUT
SUBWOOFER
1
2
SPEAKERS
FRONT
FRONT
T.REAR
CENTER
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND BACK
SURROUND BACK
FRONT WIDE/HEIGHT2
FRONT WIDE/HEIGHT2
HEIGHT1
HEIGHT1
HEIGHT1
AUTO SWITCHING AUTO SWITCHING AUTO SWITCHING
.
Back
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
40
Remote
Index
Appendix
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
o Standard configuration and connection
n 5.1-channel playback
This serves as a basic 5.1-channel surround system.
1 CBL/SAT
2 DVD
FRONT
4 GAME
5 CD
SURROUND
SURROUND BACK
CENTER
SUBWOOFER
FRONT
CENTER
FRONT WIDE
SURROUND
SUBWOOFER
1
HEIGHT1
7.1CH IN
3 Blu-ray
AUDIO
FL
FR
1
ZONE2
STRAIGHT CABLE
2
SURROUND BACK
ZONE3
PRE OUT
1 CBL/SAT
2 DVD 1 TV
AUDIO
HEIGHT2
2 CD
IR
PHONO
AUDIO
FRONT
SW
6 MEDIA PLAYER
(ASSIGNABLE)
DC12V 150mA MAX.
2
TRIGGER OUT
FRONT
REMOTE CONTROL
CENTER
RS-232C
COAXIAL
DIGITAL AUDIO
SURROUND
OPTICAL
(ASSIGNABLE)
SURROUND
SURROUND BACK
ASSIGNABLE
C
SL
SPEAKERS
.
SR
SW
FR
FL
C
SR
SL
.
Front panel
Display
SURROUND BACK
Rear panel
41
Remote
Index
FRONT WIDE/HEIGHT2
FRONT WIDE/HEIGHT2
HEIGHT1
ASSIGNABLE
HEIGHT1
ASSIGNABLE
IMPEDANCE : 4㹼16Ȑ
CLASS 2 WIRING
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
n 7.1-channel playback (surround back)
This 7.1-channel surround system is the same as a basic 5.1-channel system but with surround back speakers.
1 CBL/SAT
2 DVD
FRONT
4 GAME
5 CD
SURROUND
SURROUND BACK
CENTER
SUBWOOFER
FRONT
CENTER
FRONT WIDE
SURROUND
SUBWOOFER
1
HEIGHT1
7.1CH IN
3 Blu-ray
AUDIO
FL
6 MEDIA PLAYER
1
ZONE2
STRAIGHT CABLE
2
SURROUND BACK
ZONE3
PRE OUT
(ASSIGNABLE)
DC12V 150mA MAX.
FR
2
1 CBL/SAT
2 DVD 1 TV
AUDIO
HEIGHT2
2 CD
IR
PHONO
AUDIO
FRONT
TRIGGER OUT
FRONT
REMOTE CONTROL
CENTER
RS-232C
COAXIAL
DIGITAL AUDIO
SURROUND
OPTICAL
(ASSIGNABLE)
SURROUND
SURROUND BACK
SURROUND BACK
ASSIGNABLE
SW
SL
SPEAKERS
FRONT WIDE/HEIGHT2
HEIGHT1
ASSIGNABLE
HEIGHT1
ASSIGNABLE
IMPEDANCE : 4㹼16Ȑ
.
SR
SBR
Display
Rear panel
SW
FR
FL
C
SR
SL
SBR
SBL
When using a single surround back speaker, connect it to the SURROUND BACK L
connector.
.
SBL
Front panel
FRONT WIDE/HEIGHT2
42
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
o Advanced connections
n 9.1-channel playback
This system, which is based on a 5.1-channel system, plays back up to 9.1-channels at the same time.
You can connect speakers for up to 11-channels for MAIN ZONE. When you connect speakers for 10 or more channels, the output speakers
automatically switch according to the input signal and sound mode.
FHL
FHR
1 CBL/SAT
2 DVD
FRONT
4 GAME
5 CD
SURROUND
SURROUND BACK
CENTER
SUBWOOFER
FRONT
CENTER
FRONT WIDE
SURROUND
SUBWOOFER
1
HEIGHT1
7.1CH IN
FL
3 Blu-ray
FR
AUDIO
1
FRONT
FWL
C
SL
TRIGGER OUT
FRONT
REMOTE CONTROL
CENTER
RS-232C
SURROUND BACK
ZONE3
PRE OUT
1 CBL/SAT
2 DVD 1 TV
AUDIO
COAXIAL
DIGITAL AUDIO
HEIGHT2
2 CD
SURROUND
OPTICAL
(ASSIGNABLE)
SURROUND
SURROUND BACK
FWR
SURROUND BACK
ASSIGNABLE
SPEAKERS
FRONT WIDE/HEIGHT2
FRONT WIDE/HEIGHT2
HEIGHT1
ASSIGNABLE
HEIGHT1
ASSIGNABLE
IMPEDANCE : 4㹼16Ȑ
SR
SBL
SBR
.
.
Front panel
ZONE2
STRAIGHT CABLE
2
IR
PHONO
AUDIO
SW
6 MEDIA PLAYER
(ASSIGNABLE)
DC12V 150mA MAX.
2
Display
Rear panel
43
SW
FR
FL
Remote
C
SR
SL
SBR
Index
SBL FWR FWL FHR
FHL
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
n 11.1-channel playback
This system, which is based on a 5.1-channel system, plays back up to 11.1-channels at the same time.
You can connect speakers for up to 13-channels for MAIN ZONE by using an external power amplifier. When you connect speakers for 12 or more
channels, the output speakers automatically switch according to the input signal and sound mode.
TRL
TRR
TRR
TFL
TFR
1 CBL/SAT
SL
FWL
FL
FR
SW
TRL
C
FWR
2 DVD
FRONT
4 GAME
5 CD
SURROUND
SURROUND BACK
CENTER
SR
SUBWOOFER
FRONT
CENTER
FRONT WIDE
SURROUND
SUBWOOFER
1
HEIGHT1
7.1CH IN
3 Blu-ray
AUDIO
6 MEDIA PLAYER
1
ZONE2
STRAIGHT CABLE
2
SURROUND BACK
ZONE3
PRE OUT
(ASSIGNABLE)
DC12V 150mA MAX.
1 CBL/SAT
Power amplifier
2
2 DVD 1 TV
AUDIO
HEIGHT2
2 CD
IR
PHONO
AUDIO
FRONT
SBL
TRIGGER OUT
FRONT
REMOTE CONTROL
CENTER
RS-232C
COAXIAL
DIGITAL AUDIO
SURROUND
OPTICAL
(ASSIGNABLE)
SURROUND
SURROUND BACK
SURROUND BACK
FRONT WIDE/HEIGHT2
FRONT WIDE/HEIGHT2
HEIGHT1
HEIGHT1
SBR
ASSIGNABLE
ASSIGNABLE
ASSIGNABLE
IMPEDANCE : 4㨪16ǡ
.
.
SPEAKERS
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
44
SW
FR
FL
Remote
C
SR
SL
SBR
Index
SBL FWR FWL
TFR
TFL
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
n 7.1-channel playback (bi-amp connection of front speakers)
This system plays back 7.1-channels. You can use the bi-amp connection for front speakers. Bi-amp connection is a method to connect separate
amplifiers to the tweeter terminal and woofer terminal of a speaker that supports bi-amplification. This connection enables back EMF (power returned
without being output) from the woofer to flow into the tweeter without affecting the sound quality, producing a higher sound quality.
You can connect speakers for up to 9 channels for MAIN ZONE. When you connect speakers for 8 or more channels, the output speakers
automatically switch according to the input signal and sound mode.
FHL
FHR
1 CBL/SAT
2 DVD
FRONT
4 GAME
5 CD
SURROUND
SURROUND BACK
CENTER
SUBWOOFER
FRONT
CENTER
FRONT WIDE
SURROUND
SUBWOOFER
1
HEIGHT1
7.1CH IN
FL
(Bi-Amp)
FR
(Bi-Amp)
3 Blu-ray
AUDIO
1
ZONE2
STRAIGHT CABLE
2
SURROUND BACK
ZONE3
HEIGHT2
PRE OUT
1 CBL/SAT
2 DVD 1 TV
AUDIO
2 CD
IR
PHONO
AUDIO
FRONT
SW
6 MEDIA PLAYER
(ASSIGNABLE)
DC12V 150mA MAX.
2
TRIGGER OUT
FRONT
RS-232C
REMOTE CONTROL
CENTER
COAXIAL
DIGITAL AUDIO
SURROUND
OPTICAL
(ASSIGNABLE)
SURROUND
SURROUND BACK
C
SL
SURROUND BACK
FRONT WIDE/HEIGHT2
ASSIGNABLE
HEIGHT1
SPEAKERS
HEIGHT1
ASSIGNABLE
IMPEDANCE : 4㹼16Ȑ
SR
SBL
SW
C
SR
SL
SBR
SBL
FHR
.
SBR
(R)
q
(L)
w
q
FL
.
FR
NOTE
When making bi-amp connections, be sure to remove the short-circuiting plate or wire between the speaker’s woofer and tweeter terminals.
Front panel
FRONT WIDE/HEIGHT2
ASSIGNABLE
Display
Rear panel
45
Remote
Index
w
FHL
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
n Exclusive 9.1-channel playback + 2-channel playback speakers
You can connect speakers used exclusively for 2-channel playback, which are used for the direct and stereo modes, and speakers used exclusively
for 9.1 multi-channel playback. The speakers used exclusively for multi-channel playback and the speakers used exclusively for 2-channel playback
are automatically switched for playback in accordance with the sound mode.
1 CBL/SAT
Multi-channel playback
FHL
2 DVD
FRONT
4 GAME
5 CD
SURROUND
SURROUND BACK
CENTER
FHR
SUBWOOFER
FRONT
CENTER
FRONT WIDE
SURROUND
SUBWOOFER
1
HEIGHT1
7.1CH IN
3 Blu-ray
AUDIO
6 MEDIA PLAYER
STRAIGHT CABLE
2
2
SURROUND BACK
ZONE3
PRE OUT
(ASSIGNABLE)
DC12V 150mA MAX.
1
ZONE2
1 CBL/SAT
2 DVD 1 TV
AUDIO
HEIGHT2
2 CD
IR
PHONO
FL’ FL
AUDIO
FR FR’
FRONT
SW
TRIGGER OUT
FRONT
REMOTE CONTROL
CENTER
RS-232C
COAXIAL
DIGITAL AUDIO
SURROUND
OPTICAL
(ASSIGNABLE)
SURROUND
SURROUND BACK
SR
SBL
SBR
.
SL
SW
FR
FL
C
SR
SL
SBR
Switching
FHR
FR FR’
C
SL
SR
SBL
SBR
.
2-channel playback
Display
Rear panel
46
Remote
Index
SBL
FRONT WIDE/HEIGHT2
HEIGHT1
ASSIGNABLE
SPEAKERS
FL’ FL
Front panel
FRONT WIDE/HEIGHT2
ASSIGNABLE
C
FHL
SURROUND BACK
HEIGHT1
ASSIGNABLE
IMPEDANCE : 4㹼16Ȑ
FR’
FL’
FHR
FHL
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
n Exclusive 7.1-channel playback + 2-channel playback (bi-amp connection) speakers
You can connect speakers used exclusively for 2-channel playback, which are used for the direct and stereo modes, and speakers used exclusively
for 7.1 multi-channel playback. You can use the bi-amp connection for the speakers exclusively used for 2-channel playback. The speakers used
exclusively for multi-channel playback and the speakers used exclusively for 2-channel playback are automatically switched for playback in
accordance with the sound mode.
1 CBL/SAT
Multi-channel playback
2 DVD
FRONT
4 GAME
5 CD
SURROUND BACK
SURROUND
CENTER
SUBWOOFER
FRONT
CENTER
FRONT WIDE
SURROUND
SUBWOOFER
1
HEIGHT1
7.1CH IN
3 Blu-ray
AUDIO
6 MEDIA PLAYER
ZONE2
STRAIGHT CABLE
2
SURROUND BACK
ZONE3
PRE OUT
(ASSIGNABLE)
DC12V 150mA MAX.
1
2
1 CBL/SAT
2 DVD 1 TV
AUDIO
HEIGHT2
2 CD
IR
PHONO
FL’
AUDIO
FR FR’
FL
FRONT
SW
TRIGGER OUT
FRONT
RS-232C
REMOTE CONTROL
CENTER
COAXIAL
DIGITAL AUDIO
SURROUND
OPTICAL
(ASSIGNABLE)
SURROUND
SURROUND BACK
SURROUND BACK
FRONT WIDE/HEIGHT2
ASSIGNABLE
C
FRONT WIDE/HEIGHT2
ASSIGNABLE
SR
SBL
SBR
SW
FR
FL
C
SR
SL
SBR
IMPEDANCE : 4㹼16Ȑ
SBL
Switching
FL’
FL’
(Bi-Amp)
FR’
FL’
(Bi-Amp)
FL
C
(R)
q
FR
(L)
w
q
FR’
SR
SBL
SBR
.
SL
.
2-channel playback
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
47
Remote
Index
FL’
HEIGHT1
ASSIGNABLE
SPEAKERS
SL
HEIGHT1
w
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
n 7.1-channel playback + front speakers of second unit
This system enables switching playback between front speakers A and B as desired.
You can connect speakers for up to 9-channels for MAIN ZONE. When you connect speakers for 8 or more channels, the output speakers
automatically switch according to the input signal and sound mode.
FHL
FHR
1 CBL/SAT
2 DVD
FL FL
(B) (A)
FRONT
4 GAME
5 CD
SURROUND
SURROUND BACK
CENTER
SUBWOOFER
FRONT
CENTER
FRONT WIDE
SURROUND
SUBWOOFER
1
HEIGHT1
7.1CH IN
FR FR
(A) (B)
3 Blu-ray
AUDIO
6 MEDIA PLAYER
1
ZONE2
STRAIGHT CABLE
2
SURROUND BACK
ZONE3
PRE OUT
(ASSIGNABLE)
DC12V 150mA MAX.
2
1 CBL/SAT
2 DVD 1 TV
AUDIO
HEIGHT2
2 CD
IR
PHONO
AUDIO
SW
FRONT
C
TRIGGER OUT
FRONT
REMOTE CONTROL
CENTER
RS-232C
COAXIAL
DIGITAL AUDIO
SURROUND
OPTICAL
(ASSIGNABLE)
SURROUND
SURROUND BACK
SURROUND BACK
FRONT WIDE/HEIGHT2
ASSIGNABLE
SBL
SBR
HEIGHT1
ASSIGNABLE
IMPEDANCE : 4㹼16Ȑ
.
SR
HEIGHT1
ASSIGNABLE
SPEAKERS
SL
FRONT WIDE/HEIGHT2
FR
(A)
FL
(A)
C
SR
SL
SBR
.
SW
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
48
Remote
Index
SBL
FR
(B)
FL
(B)
FHR
FHL
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
n 7.1-channel playback (MAIN ZONE) + 2-channel playback (ZONE2 or ZONE3)
This type of configuration plays back 7.1-channels in MAIN ZONE and 2-channels in ZONE2.
(Speakers can output audio from ZONE3 instead of ZONE2 (Assign Mode: 7.1ch + ZONE3).)
You can connect speakers for up to 9-channels for MAIN ZONE. When you connect speakers for 8 or more channels, the output speakers
automatically switch according to the input signal and sound mode.
MAIN ZONE
1 CBL/SAT
FHL
FHR
FL
FR
2 DVD
SURROUND
SURROUND BACK
CENTER
SUBWOOFER
FRONT
CENTER
FRONT WIDE
SURROUND
SUBWOOFER
1
HEIGHT1
7.1CH IN
3 Blu-ray
AUDIO
6 MEDIA PLAYER
1
ZONE2
STRAIGHT CABLE
2
2
SURROUND BACK
ZONE3
PRE OUT
(ASSIGNABLE)
DC12V 150mA MAX.
1 CBL/SAT
2 DVD 1 TV
AUDIO
HEIGHT2
2 CD
IR
PHONO
AUDIO
FRONT
SW
FRONT
4 GAME
5 CD
TRIGGER OUT
FRONT
REMOTE CONTROL
CENTER
RS-232C
COAXIAL
DIGITAL AUDIO
SURROUND
OPTICAL
(ASSIGNABLE)
SURROUND
SURROUND BACK
C
SL
ASSIGNABLE
FRONT WIDE/HEIGHT2
FRONT WIDE/HEIGHT2
HEIGHT1
ASSIGNABLE
SPEAKERS
HEIGHT1
ASSIGNABLE
IMPEDANCE : 4㹼16Ȑ
SR
SBL
SBR
SW
FR
FL
C
SR
SL
SBR
.
ZONE2
ZONE2
R
.
ZONE2
L
Front panel
SURROUND BACK
Display
Rear panel
49
Remote
Index
SBL
ZONE2
R
FHR
ZONE2
L
FHL
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
n 5.1-channel playback (bi-amp connection of front speakers: MAIN ZONE) + 2-channel playback
(ZONE2)
This type of configuration plays back 5.1-channels in MAIN ZONE and 2-channels in ZONE2. You can use the bi-amp connection for front speakers in
MAIN ZONE.
MAIN ZONE
1 CBL/SAT
2 DVD
FRONT
4 GAME
5 CD
SURROUND
SURROUND BACK
CENTER
SUBWOOFER
FRONT
CENTER
FRONT WIDE
SURROUND
SUBWOOFER
1
HEIGHT1
7.1CH IN
3 Blu-ray
FL
(Bi-Amp)
AUDIO
FR
(Bi-Amp)
6 MEDIA PLAYER
STRAIGHT CABLE
2
2
SURROUND BACK
ZONE3
PRE OUT
(ASSIGNABLE)
DC12V 150mA MAX.
1
ZONE2
1 CBL/SAT
2 DVD 1 TV
AUDIO
HEIGHT2
2 CD
IR
PHONO
AUDIO
FRONT
TRIGGER OUT
FRONT
RS-232C
REMOTE CONTROL
CENTER
COAXIAL
DIGITAL AUDIO
SURROUND
OPTICAL
(ASSIGNABLE)
SURROUND
SURROUND BACK
SURROUND BACK
FRONT WIDE/HEIGHT2
SPEAKERS
C
SL
HEIGHT1
ASSIGNABLE
IMPEDANCE : 4㹼16Ȑ
SR
C
SW
SR
ZONE2 ZONE2
R
L
SL
ZONE2
ZONE2
L
ZONE2
R
(R)
q
(L)
w
q
FL
.
.
FR
Front panel
HEIGHT1
ASSIGNABLE
ASSIGNABLE
SW
FRONT WIDE/HEIGHT2
Display
Rear panel
50
Remote
Index
w
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
n 5.1-channel playback (MAIN ZONE) + 2-channel playback (ZONE2) + 2-channel playback (ZONE3)
This type of configuration plays back 5.1-channels in MAIN ZONE and 2-channels in ZONE2 and ZONE3.
MAIN ZONE
1 CBL/SAT
2 DVD
FRONT
4 GAME
5 CD
SURROUND
SURROUND BACK
CENTER
SUBWOOFER
FRONT
CENTER
FRONT WIDE
SURROUND
SUBWOOFER
1
HEIGHT1
7.1CH IN
FL
SW
FR
3 Blu-ray
AUDIO
6 MEDIA PLAYER
1
ZONE2
STRAIGHT CABLE
2
SURROUND BACK
ZONE3
PRE OUT
(ASSIGNABLE)
DC12V 150mA MAX.
2
1 CBL/SAT
2 DVD 1 TV
AUDIO
HEIGHT2
2 CD
IR
PHONO
AUDIO
FRONT
SW
TRIGGER OUT
FRONT
REMOTE CONTROL
CENTER
RS-232C
COAXIAL
DIGITAL AUDIO
SURROUND
OPTICAL
(ASSIGNABLE)
SURROUND
SURROUND BACK
SURROUND BACK
FRONT WIDE/HEIGHT2
ASSIGNABLE
SPEAKERS
SL
ZONE3
FL
C
SR
SL
ZONE2
R
ZONE2
L
.
FR
ZONE2
R
ZONE3
L
ZONE3
R
.
Front panel
HEIGHT1
HEIGHT1
ASSIGNABLE
ASSIGNABLE
IMPEDANCE : 4㹼16Ȑ
SR
ZONE2
ZONE2
L
FRONT WIDE/HEIGHT2
C
Display
Rear panel
51
Remote
Index
ZONE3
R
ZONE3
L
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
n 7.1-channel playback (MAIN ZONE) + 1-channel playback (ZONE2) + 1-channel playback (ZONE3)
This type of configuration plays back 7.1-channels in MAIN ZONE and 1-channel (monaural) in ZONE2 and ZONE3.
You can connect speakers for up to 9-channels for MAIN ZONE. When you connect speakers for 8 or more channels, the output speakers
automatically switch according to the input signal and sound mode.
MAIN ZONE
1 CBL/SAT
2 DVD
FHL
FHR
FL
FR
FRONT
4 GAME
5 CD
SURROUND
SURROUND BACK
CENTER
SUBWOOFER
FRONT
CENTER
FRONT WIDE
SURROUND
SUBWOOFER
1
HEIGHT1
7.1CH IN
3 Blu-ray
AUDIO
6 MEDIA PLAYER
1
ZONE2
STRAIGHT CABLE
2
SURROUND BACK
ZONE3
PRE OUT
(ASSIGNABLE)
DC12V 150mA MAX.
2
1 CBL/SAT
2 DVD 1 TV
AUDIO
HEIGHT2
2 CD
IR
PHONO
AUDIO
FRONT
TRIGGER OUT
FRONT
REMOTE CONTROL
CENTER
RS-232C
COAXIAL
DIGITAL AUDIO
SURROUND
OPTICAL
(ASSIGNABLE)
SURROUND
SURROUND BACK
SURROUND BACK
ASSIGNABLE
SW
SL
SR
SBL
SBR
SW
C
SR
SL
SBR
ZONE3
Mono
.
ZONE2
Mono
FL
.
ZONE3
FR
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
52
Remote
Index
FRONT WIDE/HEIGHT2
HEIGHT1
ASSIGNABLE
SPEAKERS
C
ZONE2
FRONT WIDE/HEIGHT2
SBL
ZONE3
Mono
HEIGHT1
ASSIGNABLE
IMPEDANCE : 4㹼16Ȑ
FHR
ZONE2
Mono
FHL
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
o Dolby Atmos
This speaker configuration is optimized for Dolby Atmos playback.
n 11.1-channel system
This system configuration plays back 11.1-channels by using an external power amplifier.
TRL
TRR
TRR
TFL
TFR
1 CBL/SAT
FL
SL
FR
SW
TRL
C
2 DVD
FRONT
4 GAME
5 CD
SURROUND
SURROUND BACK
CENTER
SR
SUBWOOFER
FRONT
CENTER
FRONT WIDE
SURROUND
SUBWOOFER
1
HEIGHT1
7.1CH IN
3 Blu-ray
AUDIO
6 MEDIA PLAYER
1
ZONE2
STRAIGHT CABLE
2
SURROUND BACK
ZONE3
PRE OUT
(ASSIGNABLE)
DC12V 150mA MAX.
1 CBL/SAT
Power amplifiers
2
2 DVD 1 TV
AUDIO
HEIGHT2
2 CD
IR
PHONO
AUDIO
FRONT
SBL
TRIGGER OUT
FRONT
REMOTE CONTROL
CENTER
RS-232C
COAXIAL
DIGITAL AUDIO
SURROUND
OPTICAL
(ASSIGNABLE)
SURROUND
SURROUND BACK
SURROUND BACK
FRONT WIDE/HEIGHT2
FRONT WIDE/HEIGHT2
HEIGHT1
HEIGHT1
SBR
ASSIGNABLE
ASSIGNABLE
ASSIGNABLE
IMPEDANCE : 4㹼16Ȑ
.
.
SPEAKERS
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
53
SW
FR
FL
Remote
C
SR
SL
SBR
Index
SBL
TFR
TFL
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
n 9.1-channel system
This configuration uses only this unit for Dolby Atmos playback.
1 CBL/SAT
2 DVD
TML
FRONT
4 GAME
5 CD
SURROUND
SURROUND BACK
CENTER
TMR
SUBWOOFER
FRONT
CENTER
FRONT WIDE
SURROUND
SUBWOOFER
1
HEIGHT1
7.1CH IN
3 Blu-ray
AUDIO
6 MEDIA PLAYER
1
ZONE2
STRAIGHT CABLE
2
SURROUND BACK
ZONE3
PRE OUT
(ASSIGNABLE)
DC12V 150mA MAX.
2
1 CBL/SAT
2 DVD 1 TV
AUDIO
HEIGHT2
2 CD
IR
PHONO
AUDIO
FL
SL
FR
SW
C
SBL
FRONT
TRIGGER OUT
FRONT
REMOTE CONTROL
CENTER
RS-232C
COAXIAL
DIGITAL AUDIO
SURROUND
OPTICAL
(ASSIGNABLE)
SURROUND
SURROUND BACK
SR
SURROUND BACK
ASSIGNABLE
SPEAKERS
FRONT WIDE/HEIGHT2
FRONT WIDE/HEIGHT2
HEIGHT1
ASSIGNABLE
HEIGHT1
ASSIGNABLE
IMPEDANCE : 4㹼16Ȑ
.
.
SBR
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
54
SW
FR
FL
Remote
C
SR
SL
SBR
Index
SBL
TMR TML
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
o Connecting an external power amplifier
You can use this unit as a pre-amp by connecting an external power amplifier to the PRE OUT connectors. By adding a power amplifier to each
channel, the realness of the sound can be further enhanced.
Select the terminal to use and connect the device.
Subwoofer
(Primary)
Subwoofer
(Secondary)
Power amplifiers
AUDIO
AUDIO
SUBWOOFER
1
SURROUND SURROUND
BACK
L
R
L
L
R
L
R
L
R
L
R
FRONT
R
L
FRONT
WIDE
R
L
L
R
L
R
L
R
L
R
HDMI
2 DVD
1 CBL/SAT
AUDIO
CENTER
HEIGHT1
R
R
L
R
L
R
L
R
L
R
L
R
L
HDMI
(ASSIGNABLE)
3 Blu-ray
4 GAME
SUBWOOFER
2
HEIGHT2
5 MEDIA PLAYER
6 AUX2
NETWORK
MONITOR1
ZONE2
7 CD
MONITOR2
ARC
Bluetooth/Wi-Fi
ANTENNA
Denon Link HD
FM
1 CBL/SAT
FRONT
4 GAME
SURROUND BACK
CENTER
FRONT
FRONT WIDE
1 CBL/SAT 4 GAME
1 CBL/SAT
2 DVD
Bluetooth/Wi-Fi
ANTENNA
3 Blu-ray MONITOR/ZONE3 ZONE2
Y
2 DVD
5 CD
SURROUND
CENTER
SURROUND
SUBWOOFER
SUBWOOFER
1
AM
7.1CH IN
SIGNAL
GND
3 Blu-ray
ANTENNA
AUDIO
6 MEDIA PLAYER
STRAIGHT CABLE
2
SURROUND BACK
PRE OUT
1 CBL/SAT
2 DVD
HEIGHT2
3 Blu-ray
MONITOR/ZONE3
PB/
CB
2
ZONE3
(ASSIGNABLE)
DC12V 150mA MAX.
1
ZONE2
HEIGHT1
2 DVD 1 TV
AUDIO
5V/1A
AC IN
P R/
CR
ZONE2
VIDEO VIDEO
2 CD
COMPONENT VIDEO
COMPONENT VIDEO
(ASSIGNABLE)
(ASSIGNABLE)
IR
PHONO
AUDIO
FRONT
TRIGGER OUT
FRONT
REMOTE CONTROL
CENTER
RS-232C
COAXIAL
DIGITAL AUDIO
SURROUND
OPTICAL
(ASSIGNABLE)
SURROUND
SURROUND BACK
SURROUND BACK
ASSIGNABLE
SPEAKERS
Front panel
Display
FRONT WIDE/HEIGHT2
FRONT WIDE/HEIGHT2
HEIGHT1
ASSIGNABLE
HEIGHT1
ASSIGNABLE
IMPEDANCE : 4㨪16ǡ
Rear panel
55
0 Set “Assign Mode” to “Pre Amplifier” if connecting all channels to
the Pre-out terminals using an external amplifier. (v p. 211)
This stops operation of the internal power amplifier of this unit,
reducing interference in the pre amplifier created by the power
amplifier.
0 When using just one surround back speaker, connect it to the left
channel (L) terminal.
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Connecting a TV
Connect a TV to this unit so that the input video is output to the TV. You can also enjoy audio from the TV on this unit.
How to connect a TV depends on the connectors and functions equipped on the TV.
ARC (Audio Return Channel) function plays TV audio on this unit by sending the TV audio signal to this unit via HDMI cable.
Is the TV equipped with an HDMI connector?
Yes
Is the TV compatible with the ARC (Audio Return Channel) ?
No
No
.
Yes
“Connection 1 : TV equipped with an HDMI
connector and compatible with the ARC (Audio
Return Channel)” (v p. 57)
Front panel
Display
“Connection 2 : TV equipped with an HDMI
connector and incompatible with the ARC (Audio
Return Channel)” (v p. 58)
Rear panel
56
Remote
“Connection 3 : TV equipped without
an HDMI connector” (v p. 59)
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Connection 1 : TV equipped with an HDMI connector and compatible with the ARC
(Audio Return Channel)
Use an HDMI cable to connect a TV that is compatible with the ARC function to this unit.
Set “HDMI Control” to “On” when using a TV that supports the ARC function. (v p. 186)
TV
HDMI
IN
(ARC)
HDMI
2 DVD
1 CBL/SAT
4 GAME
NETWORK
HDMI
(ASSIGNABLE)
3 Blu-ray
5 MEDIA PLAYER
6 AUX2
MONITOR1
ZONE2
7 CD
MONITOR2
ARC
Bluetooth/Wi-Fi
ANTENNA
Denon Link HD
FM
1 CBL/SAT
FRONT
4 GAME
SURROUND BACK
CENTER
FRONT
FRONT WIDE
1 CBL/SAT 4 GAME
1 CBL/SAT
2 DVD
Bluetooth/Wi-Fi
ANTENNA
3 Blu-ray MONITOR/ZONE3 ZONE2
Y
2 DVD
5 CD
SURROUND
CENTER
SURROUND
SUBWOOFER
SUBWOOFER
1
AM
7.1CH IN
SIGNAL
GND
3 Blu-ray
ANTENNA
AUDIO
6 MEDIA PLAYER
STRAIGHT CABLE
2
SURROUND BACK
PRE OUT
1 CBL/SAT
2 DVD
MONITOR/ZONE3
PB/
CB
2
ZONE3
(ASSIGNABLE)
DC12V 150mA MAX.
1
ZONE2
HEIGHT1
2 DVD 1 TV
AUDIO
5V/1A
AC IN
PR/
CR
HEIGHT2
3 Blu-ray
ZONE2
VIDEO VIDEO
2 CD
(ASSIGNABLE)
COMPONENT VIDEO
COMPONENT VIDEO
(ASSIGNABLE)
IR
PHONO
AUDIO
FRONT
TRIGGER OUT
REMOTE CONTROL
FRONT
CENTER
RS-232C
COAXIAL
DIGITAL AUDIO
SURROUND
OPTICAL
(ASSIGNABLE)
SURROUND
SURROUND BACK
SURROUND BACK
ASSIGNABLE
SPEAKERS
Front panel
Display
FRONT WIDE/HEIGHT2
FRONT WIDE/HEIGHT2
HEIGHT1
ASSIGNABLE
HEIGHT1
When using the HDMI control function, connect to the HDMI
MONITOR 1 connector.
ASSIGNABLE
IMPEDANCE : 4㨪16ǡ
Rear panel
57
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Connection 2 : TV equipped with an HDMI connector and incompatible with the ARC
(Audio Return Channel)
Use an HDMI cable to connect the TV to this unit.
To listen to audio from TV on this unit, use an optical cable to connect the TV to this unit.
TV
OUT
IN
OPTICAL
OUT
HDMI
IN
HDMI
2 DVD
1 CBL/SAT
4 GAME
NETWORK
HDMI
(ASSIGNABLE)
3 Blu-ray
5 MEDIA PLAYER
6 AUX2
MONITOR1
ZONE2
7 CD
MONITOR2
ARC
Bluetooth/Wi-Fi
ANTENNA
Denon Link HD
FM
1 CBL/SAT
FRONT
4 GAME
SURROUND BACK
FRONT
CENTER
FRONT WIDE
SURROUND
SUBWOOFER
1
HEIGHT1
1 CBL/SAT 4 GAME
1 CBL/SAT
2 DVD
Bluetooth/Wi-Fi
ANTENNA
3 Blu-ray MONITOR/ZONE3 ZONE2
Y
2 DVD
5 CD
SURROUND
CENTER
SUBWOOFER
AM
7.1CH IN
SIGNAL
GND
3 Blu-ray
ANTENNA
AUDIO
6 MEDIA PLAYER
STRAIGHT CABLE
DC12V 150mA MAX.
1
ZONE2
2
SURROUND BACK
PRE OUT
1 CBL/SAT
2 DVD 1 TV
AUDIO
5V/1A
MONITOR/ZONE3
PB/
CB
2
ZONE3
(ASSIGNABLE)
2 DVD
AC IN
PR/
CR
HEIGHT2
3 Blu-ray
ZONE2
VIDEO VIDEO
2 CD
(ASSIGNABLE)
COMPONENT VIDEO
COMPONENT VIDEO
(ASSIGNABLE)
IR
PHONO
AUDIO
FRONT
TRIGGER OUT
FRONT
REMOTE CONTROL
CENTER
RS-232C
COAXIAL
DIGITAL AUDIO
SURROUND
OPTICAL
(ASSIGNABLE)
SURROUND
SURROUND BACK
SURROUND BACK
ASSIGNABLE
FRONT WIDE/HEIGHT2
FRONT WIDE/HEIGHT2
HEIGHT1
ASSIGNABLE
SPEAKERS
HEIGHT1
ASSIGNABLE
.
IMPEDANCE : 4㹼16Ȑ
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
58
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Connection 3 : TV equipped without an HDMI connector
Use a component video or a video cable to connect the TV to this unit.
To listen to audio from TV on this unit, use an optical cable to connect the TV to this unit.
TV
OUT
IN
OPTICAL
OUT
COMPONENT VIDEO
IN
Y
PB PR
VIDEO
IN
or
HDMI
2 DVD
1 CBL/SAT
HDMI
(ASSIGNABLE)
3 Blu-ray
4 GAME
5 MEDIA PLAYER
6 AUX2
NETWORK
MONITOR1
ZONE2
7 CD
MONITOR2
ARC
Bluetooth/Wi-Fi
ANTENNA
Denon Link HD
FM
1 CBL/SAT
FRONT
4 GAME
SURROUND BACK
FRONT
CENTER
FRONT WIDE
SURROUND
SUBWOOFER
1
HEIGHT1
1 CBL/SAT 4 GAME
1 CBL/SAT
2 DVD
Bluetooth/Wi-Fi
ANTENNA
3 Blu-ray MONITOR/ZONE3 ZONE2
Y
2 DVD
5 CD
SURROUND
CENTER
SUBWOOFER
AM
7.1CH IN
SIGNAL
GND
3 Blu-ray
ANTENNA
AUDIO
6 MEDIA PLAYER
STRAIGHT CABLE
2
SURROUND BACK
PRE OUT
1 CBL/SAT
2 DVD 1 TV
AUDIO
5V/1A
MONITOR/ZONE3
PB/
CB
2
ZONE3
(ASSIGNABLE)
DC12V 150mA MAX.
1
ZONE2
2 DVD
AC IN
P R/
CR
HEIGHT2
3 Blu-ray
ZONE2
VIDEO VIDEO
2 CD
(ASSIGNABLE)
COMPONENT VIDEO
COMPONENT VIDEO
(ASSIGNABLE)
IR
PHONO
AUDIO
FRONT
TRIGGER OUT
FRONT
REMOTE CONTROL
CENTER
RS-232C
COAXIAL
DIGITAL AUDIO
SURROUND
OPTICAL
(ASSIGNABLE)
SURROUND
SURROUND BACK
SURROUND BACK
ASSIGNABLE
FRONT WIDE/HEIGHT2
FRONT WIDE/HEIGHT2
HEIGHT1
ASSIGNABLE
SPEAKERS
HEIGHT1
ASSIGNABLE
.
IMPEDANCE : 4㨪16ǡ
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
59
Remote
Index
Appendix
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Connecting a playback device
This unit is equipped with three types of video input connectors (HDMI, component video and composite video) and three types of audio input connectors
(HDMI, digital audio and audio).
Select input connectors on this unit according to the connectors equipped on the device you want to connect.
If the device connected to this unit is equipped with an HDMI connector, it is recommended to use HDMI connections.
In the HDMI connection, audio and video signals can be transmitted through a single HDMI cable.
0 “Connecting a set-top box (Satellite tuner/cable TV)” (v p. 61)
“Connecting a DVD player or Blu-ray Disc player” (v p. 62)
“Connecting a Blu-ray Disc player compatible with the Denon Link HD function” (v p. 63)
“Connecting a video camcorder or game console” (v p. 64)
“Connecting a turntable” (v p. 65)
0 “Connecting a device with a multi-channel output connector” (v p. 66)
0
0
0
0
0 Connect devices to this unit as indicated by the input sources printed on the audio/video input connectors of this unit.
0 The source that is assigned to the HDMI IN, DIGITAL AUDIO IN, COMPONENT VIDEO IN, VIDEO IN and AUDIO IN connectors can be changed. See “Input Assign” on how
to change the input source assigned to the input connectors. (v p. 195)
0 To play back audio signals that are input to this unit on a TV connected via HDMI, set in the menu “HDMI Audio Out” to “TV”. (v p. 184)
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
60
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Connecting a set-top box (Satellite tuner/cable TV)
This explanation uses the connection with a satellite tuner/cable TV STB as an example.
Select the input connectors on this unit to match the connectors on the device that you want to connect to.
(HDMI incompatible device)
Satellite tuner/
Cable TV
Satellite tuner/
Cable TV
AUDIO
AUDIO
OUT
R
L
HDMI
OUT
R
VIDEO
VIDEO
OUT
COAXIAL
OUT
L
or
R
2 DVD
or
L
HDMI
1 CBL/SAT
COMPONENT VIDEO
OUT
Y
PB PR
HDMI
(ASSIGNABLE)
3 Blu-ray
4 GAME
5 MEDIA PLAYER
6 AUX2
NETWORK
MONITOR1
ZONE2
7 CD
MONITOR2
ARC
Bluetooth/Wi-Fi
ANTENNA
Denon Link HD
FM
1 CBL/SAT
FRONT
4 GAME
SURROUND BACK
FRONT
CENTER
FRONT WIDE
SURROUND
SUBWOOFER
1
HEIGHT1
1 CBL/SAT 4 GAME
1 CBL/SAT
2 DVD
Bluetooth/Wi-Fi
ANTENNA
3 Blu-ray MONITOR/ZONE3 ZONE2
Y
2 DVD
5 CD
SURROUND
CENTER
SUBWOOFER
AM
7.1CH IN
SIGNAL
GND
3 Blu-ray
ANTENNA
AUDIO
6 MEDIA PLAYER
STRAIGHT CABLE
DC12V 150mA MAX.
1
ZONE2
2
SURROUND BACK
PRE OUT
1 CBL/SAT
2 DVD 1 TV
AUDIO
5V/1A
MONITOR/ZONE3
PB/
CB
2
ZONE3
(ASSIGNABLE)
2 DVD
AC IN
PR/
CR
HEIGHT2
3 Blu-ray
ZONE2
VIDEO VIDEO
2 CD
(ASSIGNABLE)
COMPONENT VIDEO
COMPONENT VIDEO
(ASSIGNABLE)
IR
PHONO
AUDIO
FRONT
TRIGGER OUT
FRONT
REMOTE CONTROL
CENTER
RS-232C
COAXIAL
DIGITAL AUDIO
SURROUND
OPTICAL
(ASSIGNABLE)
SURROUND
SURROUND BACK
SURROUND BACK
ASSIGNABLE
FRONT WIDE/HEIGHT2
FRONT WIDE/HEIGHT2
HEIGHT1
ASSIGNABLE
SPEAKERS
HEIGHT1
ASSIGNABLE
.
IMPEDANCE : 4㨪16ǡ
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
61
Remote
Index
Appendix
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Connecting a DVD player or Blu-ray Disc player
This explanation uses the connection with a DVD player or Blu-ray disc player as an example.
Select the input connectors on this unit to match the connectors on the device that you want to connect to.
DVD player
Blu-ray Disc
player
HDMI
OUT
HDMI
OUT
(HDMI incompatible device)
DVD player
AUDIO
AUDIO
OUT
R
L
R
VIDEO
VIDEO
OUT
COAXIAL
OUT
L
or
R
HDMI
1 CBL/SAT
2 DVD
or
L
HDMI
(ASSIGNABLE)
3 Blu-ray
4 GAME
COMPONENT VIDEO
OUT
Y
PB PR
5 MEDIA PLAYER
6 AUX2
NETWORK
MONITOR1
ZONE2
7 CD
MONITOR2
ARC
Bluetooth/Wi-Fi
ANTENNA
Denon Link HD
FM
1 CBL/SAT
FRONT
4 GAME
SURROUND BACK
FRONT
CENTER
FRONT WIDE
SURROUND
SUBWOOFER
1
HEIGHT1
1 CBL/SAT 4 GAME
1 CBL/SAT
2 DVD
Bluetooth/Wi-Fi
ANTENNA
3 Blu-ray MONITOR/ZONE3 ZONE2
Y
2 DVD
5 CD
SURROUND
CENTER
SUBWOOFER
AM
7.1CH IN
SIGNAL
GND
3 Blu-ray
ANTENNA
AUDIO
6 MEDIA PLAYER
PRE OUT
STRAIGHT CABLE
2
1 CBL/SAT
2 DVD 1 TV
AUDIO
5V/1A
MONITOR/ZONE3
PB/
CB
2
SURROUND BACK
ZONE3
(ASSIGNABLE)
DC12V 150mA MAX.
1
ZONE2
2 DVD
AC IN
PR/
CR
HEIGHT2
3 Blu-ray
ZONE2
VIDEO VIDEO
2 CD
(ASSIGNABLE)
COMPONENT VIDEO
COMPONENT VIDEO
(ASSIGNABLE)
IR
PHONO
AUDIO
FRONT
TRIGGER OUT
FRONT
REMOTE CONTROL
CENTER
RS-232C
COAXIAL
DIGITAL AUDIO
SURROUND
OPTICAL
(ASSIGNABLE)
SURROUND
SURROUND BACK
SURROUND BACK
ASSIGNABLE
FRONT WIDE/HEIGHT2
FRONT WIDE/HEIGHT2
HEIGHT1
ASSIGNABLE
SPEAKERS
HEIGHT1
ASSIGNABLE
.
IMPEDANCE : 4㨪16ǡ
When connecting a Blu-ray Disc Player that is compatible with Denon Link HD, see “Connecting a Blu-ray Disc player compatible with the Denon Link HD
function” (v p. 63).
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
62
Remote
Index
Appendix
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Connecting a Blu-ray Disc player compatible with the Denon Link HD function
By making a Denon Link HD connection to a player compatible with the Denon Link HD function, you can enjoy higher quality playback compared with
when only the HDMI connector connection is made.
Blu-ray Disc
player
Denon
Link HD
HDMI
OUT
HDMI
1 CBL/SAT
2 DVD
HDMI
(ASSIGNABLE)
3 Blu-ray
4 GAME
5 MEDIA PLAYER
6 AUX2
NETWORK
MONITOR1
ZONE2
7 CD
MONITOR2
ARC
Bluetooth/Wi-Fi
ANTENNA
Denon Link HD
FM
1 CBL/SAT
FRONT
4 GAME
SURROUND BACK
FRONT
CENTER
FRONT WIDE
SURROUND
SUBWOOFER
1
HEIGHT1
1 CBL/SAT 4 GAME
1 CBL/SAT
2 DVD
Bluetooth/Wi-Fi
ANTENNA
3 Blu-ray MONITOR/ZONE3 ZONE2
Y
2 DVD
5 CD
SURROUND
CENTER
SUBWOOFER
AM
7.1CH IN
SIGNAL
GND
3 Blu-ray
ANTENNA
AUDIO
6 MEDIA PLAYER
STRAIGHT CABLE
2
SURROUND BACK
PRE OUT
1 CBL/SAT
2 DVD 1 TV
AUDIO
5V/1A
MONITOR/ZONE3
PB/
CB
2
ZONE3
(ASSIGNABLE)
DC12V 150mA MAX.
1
ZONE2
2 DVD
AC IN
PR/
CR
HEIGHT2
3 Blu-ray
ZONE2
VIDEO VIDEO
2 CD
(ASSIGNABLE)
COMPONENT VIDEO
COMPONENT VIDEO
(ASSIGNABLE)
IR
PHONO
AUDIO
FRONT
TRIGGER OUT
REMOTE CONTROL
FRONT
CENTER
RS-232C
COAXIAL
DIGITAL AUDIO
SURROUND
OPTICAL
(ASSIGNABLE)
SURROUND
SURROUND BACK
SURROUND BACK
ASSIGNABLE
SPEAKERS
Front panel
Display
FRONT WIDE/HEIGHT2
FRONT WIDE/HEIGHT2
HEIGHT1
ASSIGNABLE
HEIGHT1
ASSIGNABLE
IMPEDANCE : 4㹼16Ȑ
Rear panel
63
0 Both HDMI and Denon Link HD connections are required for this
connection method.
0 Set “Input Mode” on the menu to “Auto” or “HDMI”. (v p. 198)
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Connecting a video camcorder or game console
This explanation uses the connection with a video camcorders as an example.
Connect a playback device to this unit, such as a video camcorder or game console.
Video
camcorder
.
HDMI
OUT
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
64
Remote
Index
Appendix
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Connecting a turntable
This unit is compatible with turntables equipped with a moving magnet (MM) phono cartridge. When you connect to a turntable with a low output moving
coil (MC) cartridge, use a commercially available MC head amp or a step-up transformer.
If you set this unit’s input source to “Phono” and you accidentally increase the volume without having a turntable connected, you may hear a hum noise
from the speakers.
Turntable
(MM cartridge)
AUDIO
OUT
GND
R
L
HDMI
2 DVD
1 CBL/SAT
HDMI
(ASSIGNABLE)
3 Blu-ray
4 GAME
5 MEDIA PLAYER
6 AUX2
NETWORK
MONITOR1
ZONE2
7 CD
MONITOR2
ARC
Bluetooth/Wi-Fi
ANTENNA
Denon Link HD
FM
1 CBL/SAT
FRONT
4 GAME
SURROUND BACK
CENTER
FRONT
FRONT WIDE
1 CBL/SAT 4 GAME
1 CBL/SAT
2 DVD
Bluetooth/Wi-Fi
ANTENNA
3 Blu-ray MONITOR/ZONE3 ZONE2
Y
2 DVD
5 CD
SURROUND
CENTER
SURROUND
SUBWOOFER
SUBWOOFER
1
AM
7.1CH IN
SIGNAL
GND
3 Blu-ray
ANTENNA
AUDIO
6 MEDIA PLAYER
STRAIGHT CABLE
2
SURROUND BACK
PRE OUT
1 CBL/SAT
2 DVD
MONITOR/ZONE3
PB/
CB
2
ZONE3
(ASSIGNABLE)
DC12V 150mA MAX.
1
ZONE2
HEIGHT1
2 DVD 1 TV
AUDIO
5V/1A
AC IN
PR/
CR
HEIGHT2
3 Blu-ray
ZONE2
VIDEO VIDEO
2 CD
(ASSIGNABLE)
COMPONENT VIDEO
NOTE
COMPONENT VIDEO
(ASSIGNABLE)
IR
PHONO
AUDIO
FRONT
TRIGGER OUT
REMOTE CONTROL
FRONT
CENTER
RS-232C
COAXIAL
DIGITAL AUDIO
SURROUND
OPTICAL
(ASSIGNABLE)
SURROUND
SURROUND BACK
SURROUND BACK
ASSIGNABLE
SPEAKERS
Front panel
Display
FRONT WIDE/HEIGHT2
FRONT WIDE/HEIGHT2
HEIGHT1
ASSIGNABLE
HEIGHT1
ASSIGNABLE
IMPEDANCE : 4㹼16Ȑ
Rear panel
65
The earth terminal (SIGNAL GND) of this unit is not for safety grounding
purposes. If this terminal is connected when there is a lot of noise, the noise can
be reduced. Note that depending on the turntable, connecting the ground line
may have the reverse effect of increasing noise. In this case, it is not necessary
to connect the ground line.
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Connecting a device with a multi-channel output connector
You can connect this unit to an external device fitted with multi-channel sound audio output connectors to enjoy music and video.
To play analog signals input from 7.1CH IN connectors, set “Input Mode” (v p. 198) to “7.1CH IN”.
Devices with a multi-channel output connector
(Blu-ray Disc player, DVD player,
External decoder etc.)
AUDIO
SUBWOOFER
SURROUND
L
FRONT
R
L
CENTER
SURROUND
BACK
R
L
R
L
R
L
R
L
R
L
R
L
R
L
R
HDMI
2 DVD
1 CBL/SAT
HDMI
(ASSIGNABLE)
3 Blu-ray
4 GAME
5 MEDIA PLAYER
6 AUX2
NETWORK
MONITOR1
ZONE2
7 CD
MONITOR2
ARC
Bluetooth/Wi-Fi
ANTENNA
Denon Link HD
FM
1 CBL/SAT
FRONT
4 GAME
SURROUND BACK
FRONT
CENTER
FRONT WIDE
SURROUND
SUBWOOFER
1
HEIGHT1
1 CBL/SAT 4 GAME
1 CBL/SAT
2 DVD
Bluetooth/Wi-Fi
ANTENNA
3 Blu-ray MONITOR/ZONE3 ZONE2
Y
2 DVD
5 CD
SURROUND
CENTER
SUBWOOFER
AM
7.1CH IN
SIGNAL
GND
3 Blu-ray
ANTENNA
AUDIO
6 MEDIA PLAYER
STRAIGHT CABLE
DC12V 150mA MAX.
1
ZONE2
PRE OUT
2
1 CBL/SAT
SURROUND BACK
2 DVD 1 TV
AUDIO
5V/1A
MONITOR/ZONE3
PB/
CB
2
ZONE3
(ASSIGNABLE)
2 DVD
AC IN
PR/
CR
HEIGHT2
3 Blu-ray
ZONE2
VIDEO VIDEO
2 CD
(ASSIGNABLE)
COMPONENT VIDEO
COMPONENT VIDEO
(ASSIGNABLE)
IR
PHONO
AUDIO
FRONT
TRIGGER OUT
REMOTE CONTROL
FRONT
CENTER
RS-232C
COAXIAL
DIGITAL AUDIO
SURROUND
OPTICAL
(ASSIGNABLE)
SURROUND
SURROUND BACK
SURROUND BACK
ASSIGNABLE
SPEAKERS
Front panel
Display
FRONT WIDE/HEIGHT2
FRONT WIDE/HEIGHT2
HEIGHT1
ASSIGNABLE
HEIGHT1
ASSIGNABLE
IMPEDANCE : 4㨪16ǡ
Rear panel
66
The video signal can be connected in the same way as a Blu-ray Disc player/DVD
player.
“Connecting a DVD player or Blu-ray Disc player” (v p. 62)
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Connecting an iPod or USB memory device to the USB port
To connect an iPod to this unit, use the USB adapter cable that was supplied with the iPod.
For operating instructions see “Playing an iPod” (v p. 80) or “Playing a USB memory device” (v p. 85).
GFront panelH
GRear panelH
iPod
USB memory
device
or
iPod
USB memory
device
HDMI
7 CD
1 CBL/SAT 4 GAME
NETWORK
MONITOR1
ZONE2
2
E
MONITOR2
ARC
1 CBL/SAT
2 DVD
Bluetooth/Wi-Fi
ANTENNA
3 Blu-ray MONITOR/ZONE3 ZONE2
Y
or
2 DVD
5V/1A
MONITOR/ZONE3
PB/
CB
AC IN
PR/
CR
3 Blu-ray
ZONE2
VIDEO VIDEO
(ASSIGNABLE)
SURROUND BACK
ABLE
COMPONENT VIDEO
(ASSIGNABLE)
FRONT WIDE/HEIGHT2
FRONT WIDE/HEIGHT2
HEIGHT1
ASSIGNABLE
HEIGHT1
ASSIGNABLE
IMPEDANCE : 4㨪16ǡ
.
.
KERS
COMPONENT VIDEO
Denon does not guarantee that all USB memory devices will operate or receive power. When using a portable USB hard disk drive (HDD) which came with an AC adapter, use
that device’s supplied AC adapter.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
67
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
NOTE
0
0
0
0
You cannot use the USB ports on the front panel and rear panel simultaneously. Select and connect the USB port to use. (v p. 83)
USB memory devices will not work via a USB hub.
It is not possible to use this unit by connecting the unit’s USB port to a PC via a USB cable.
Do not use an extension cable when connecting a USB memory device. This may cause radio interference with other devices.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
68
Remote
Index
Appendix
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
.
o Supported iPod/iPhone models
• iPod classic
• iPod nano
• iPod touch
• iPhone
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
69
Remote
Index
Appendix
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Connecting an FM/AM antenna
Connect the antenna, tune in to a broadcast and then move the antenna to
the location where there is least noise. Then use tape, etc. to fix the
antenna in this location. (“Listening to FM/AM broadcasts” (v p. 94))
AM loop antenna
(supplied)
If you are unable to receive a good broadcast signal, we recommend installing an
outdoor antenna. For details, inquire at the retail store where you purchased the unit.
FM indoor antenna
(supplied)
NOTE
0 Do not connect two FM antennas simultaneously.
0 Make sure the AM loop antenna lead terminals do not touch metal parts of the
panel.
HDMI
2 DVD
1 CBL/SAT
(ASSIGNABLE)
3 Blu-ray
4 GAME
5 MEDIA PLAY
Bluetooth/Wi-Fi
ANTENNA
Denon Link HD
FM
White
1 CBL/SAT
2 DVD
FRONT
4 GAME
5 CD
SURROUND
SURROUND BACK
CENTER
SUBWOOFER
FRONT
CENTER
SURROUND
SUBWOOFER
1
AM
7.1CH IN
SIGNAL
GND
Black
3 Blu-ray
ANTENNA
AUDIO
6 MEDIA PLAYER
2
STRAIGHT CABLE
2
SURROUND BACK
ZONE3
PRE OUT
(ASSIGNABLE)
DC12V 150mA MAX.
1
ZONE2
1 CBL/SAT
2 DVD 1 TV
AUDIO
2 CD
IR
PHONO
AUDIO
FRONT
REMOTE CONTROL
w
CENTER
RS-232C
COAXIAL
DIGITAL AUDIO
e
SURROUND
.
FRONT
q
TRIGGER OUT
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
70
Remote
Index
OPTICAL
(ASSIGNABLE)
SURROUND
SURROUN
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
o AM loop antenna assembly
o Using the AM loop antenna
1
Suspending on a wall
Suspend directly on a wall without assembling.
2
Put the stand section through the bottom of the loop
antenna from the rear and bend it forward.
Insert the projecting part into the square hole in the
stand.
Stand
Square hole
Nail, tack, etc.
.
Loop antenna
Standing alone
Use the procedure shown above to assemble.
When assembling, refer to “AM loop antenna assembly”.
.
Projecting part
.
Front panel
Display
Appendix
Rear panel
71
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Connecting to a home network (LAN)
This unit can connect to a network using a wired LAN or wireless LAN.
You can connect this unit to your home network (LAN) to enable various
types of playback and operations as described below.
0 Playback of network audio such as Internet Radio and from your media
server(s)
0 Playback of music content from online streaming services
0 Using the Apple AirPlay function
0 Operation on this unit via the network
0 Firmware Update
Wired LAN
.
To make connections via wired LAN, use a LAN cable to connect the
router to this unit as shown in the figure below.
PC
NAS
(Network Attached
Storage)
LAN port/ Ethernet
connector
LAN port/ Ethernet
connector
Modem
For connections to the Internet, contact an ISP (Internet Service
Provider) or a computer shop.
Internet
To WAN side
To LAN port
To LAN port
Router
HDMI
2 DVD
1 CBL/SAT
HDMI
(ASSIGNABLE)
3 Blu-ray
4 GAME
5 MEDIA PLAYER
6 AUX2
NETWORK
MONITOR1
ZONE2
7 CD
MONITOR2
ARC
T
4 GAME
FRONT
SURROUND BACK
FRONT
CENTER
FRONT WIDE
1 CBL/SAT 4 GAME
1 CBL/SAT
2 DVD
Bluetooth/Wi-Fi
ANTENNA
3 Blu-ray MONITOR/ZONE3 ZONE2
Y
5 CD
SURROUND
CENTER
SURROUND
SUBWOOFER
7.1CH IN
6 MEDIA PLAYER
ZONE2
STRAIGHT CABLE
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
72
SURROUND BACK
PRE OUT
1 CBL/SAT
Remote
HEIGHT1
2 DVD
MONITOR/ZONE3
PB/
CB
2
ZONE3
(ASSIGNABLE)
SUBWOOFER
1
2 DVD 1 TV
AUDIO
2 CD
PR/
CR
HEIGHT2
3 Blu-ray
5V/1A
ZONE2
VIDEO VIDEO
COMPONENT VIDEO
(ASSIGNABLE)
Index
(ASSIGNABLE)
COMPONENT VIDEO
AC IN
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Wireless LAN
Tips
Appendix
0 When using this unit, we recommend you use a router equipped with the following
functions:
When connecting to the network via wireless LAN, connect the external
antennas for Bluetooth/wireless connectivity connection to the rear panel
and stand them upright.
See “Wi-Fi Setup” (v p. 242) on how to connect to a wireless LAN
router.
Internet
0
Modem
0
0
To WAN side
0
0 Built-in DHCP server
This function automatically assigns IP addresses on the LAN.
0 Built-in 100BASE-TX switch
When connecting multiple devices, we recommend a switching hub with a
speed of 100 Mbps or greater.
Only use a shielded STP or ScTP LAN cable (readily available at electronics
stores). (CAT-5 or greater recommended)
The normal shielded-type LAN cable is recommended.
If a flat-type cable or unshielded-type cable is used, other devices could be
affected by noise.
When using a router that supports the WPS(Wi-Fi Protected Setup)function, WiFi connection can be carried out easily.
When using this unit connected to a network with no DHCP function, configure the
IP address, etc. in “Network”. (v p. 241)
NOTE
0 The types of routers that can be used depend on the ISP. Contact your ISP or a
computer shop for details.
0 This unit is not compatible with PPPoE. A PPPoE compatible router is required if
your contracted line is not set using PPPoE.
0 Do not connect a NETWORK connector directly to the LAN port / Ethernet
connector on your computer.
0 Various online services may be discontinued without prior notice.
Router with access point
HDMI
1 CBL/SAT
2 DVD
HDMI
(ASSIGNABLE)
5 MEDIA PLAYER
4 GAME
3 Blu-ray
6 AUX2
NETWORK
MONITOR1
ZONE2
7 CD
MONITOR2
ARC
Bluetooth/Wi-Fi
ANTENNA
Denon Link HD
FM
1 CBL/SAT
FRONT
4 GAME
SURROUND BACK
FRONT
CENTER
FRONT WIDE
SURROUND
SUBWOOFER
1
HEIGHT1
1 CBL/SAT 4 GAME
1 CBL/SAT
2 DVD
Bluetooth/Wi-Fi
ANTENNA
3 Blu-ray MONITOR/ZONE3 ZONE2
Y
2 DVD
5 CD
SURROUND
CENTER
SUBWOOFER
AM
7.1CH IN
SIGNAL
GND
3 Blu-ray
ANTENNA
AUDIO
6 MEDIA PLAYER
STRAIGHT CABLE
2
PRE OUT
1 CBL/SAT
2 DVD 1 TV
AUDIO
5V/1A
MONITOR/ZONE3
PB /
CB
2
SURROUND BACK
ZONE3
(ASSIGNABLE)
DC12V 150mA MAX.
1
ZONE2
2 DVD
AC IN
PR/
CR
HEIGHT2
3 Blu-ray
ZONE2
VIDEO VIDEO
2 CD
(ASSIGNABLE)
COMPONENT VIDEO
COMPONENT VIDEO
(ASSIGNABLE)
IR
PHONO
AUDIO
FRONT
TRIGGER OUT
FRONT
REMOTE CONTROL
CENTER
RS-232C
COAXIAL
DIGITAL AUDIO
SURROUND
OPTICAL
(ASSIGNABLE)
SURROUND
SURROUND BACK
SURROUND BACK
FRONT WIDE/HEIGHT2
ASSIGNABLE
FRONT WIDE/HEIGHT2
HEIGHT1
ASSIGNABLE
HEIGHT1
ASSIGNABLE
IMPEDANCE : 4㨪16ǡ
.
SPEAKERS
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
73
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Connecting an external control device
REMOTE CONTROL jacks
When this unit is installed in a location where the remote control signals cannot reach (installation in a cabinet etc.), it can still be controlled by the remote
control by connecting a remote control receiver unit (sold separately).
You can also use it to remotely control ZONE2 and ZONE3 (separate room).
Infrared
retransmitter
AUX
OUT
Infrared
sensor
Output
Input
Device fitted with REMOTE CONTROL IN
connectors
HDMI
2 DVD
1 CBL/SAT
HDMI
(ASSIGNABLE)
3 Blu-ray
4 GAME
5 MEDIA PLAYER
6 AUX2
NETWORK
MONITOR1
ZONE2
7 CD
MONITOR2
ARC
Bluetooth/Wi-Fi
ANTENNA
Denon Link HD
FM
1 CBL/SAT
FRONT
4 GAME
FRONT
SURROUND BACK
CENTER
FRONT WIDE
1 CBL/SAT 4 GAME
1 CBL/SAT
2 DVD
Bluetooth/Wi-Fi
ANTENNA
3 Blu-ray MONITOR/ZONE3 ZONE2
Y
2 DVD
5 CD
SURROUND
CENTER
SURROUND
SUBWOOFER
SUBWOOFER
1
AM
7.1CH IN
SIGNAL
GND
3 Blu-ray
ANTENNA
AUDIO
6 MEDIA PLAYER
STRAIGHT CABLE
2
SURROUND BACK
PRE OUT
1 CBL/SAT
2 DVD
MONITOR/ZONE3
PB/
CB
2
ZONE3
(ASSIGNABLE)
DC12V 150mA MAX.
1
ZONE2
HEIGHT1
2 DVD 1 TV
AUDIO
5V/1A
AC IN
PR/
CR
HEIGHT2
3 Blu-ray
ZONE2
VIDEO VIDEO
2 CD
(ASSIGNABLE)
COMPONENT VIDEO
COMPONENT VIDEO
(ASSIGNABLE)
IR
PHONO
AUDIO
FRONT
TRIGGER OUT
FRONT
REMOTE CONTROL
CENTER
RS-232C
COAXIAL
DIGITAL AUDIO
SURROUND
OPTICAL
(ASSIGNABLE)
SURROUND
SURROUND BACK
SURROUND BACK
ASSIGNABLE
FRONT WIDE/HEIGHT2
FRONT WIDE/HEIGHT2
HEIGHT1
ASSIGNABLE
SPEAKERS
HEIGHT1
ASSIGNABLE
.
IMPEDANCE : 4㨪16ǡ
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
74
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
TRIGGER OUT jacks
When a device with TRIGGER IN jack is connected, the connected device’s power on/standby can be controlled through linked operation to this unit.
The TRIGGER OUT jack outputs a maximum 12 V DC /150 mA electrical signal.
12 V DC/150 mA trigger-compatible device
HDMI
2 DVD
1 CBL/SAT
HDMI
(ASSIGNABLE)
3 Blu-ray
4 GAME
5 MEDIA PLAYER
6 AUX2
NETWORK
MONITOR1
ZONE2
7 CD
MONITOR2
ARC
Bluetooth/Wi-Fi
ANTENNA
Denon Link HD
FM
1 CBL/SAT
FRONT
4 GAME
SURROUND BACK
FRONT
CENTER
FRONT WIDE
SURROUND
SUBWOOFER
1
HEIGHT1
1 CBL/SAT 4 GAME
1 CBL/SAT
2 DVD
Bluetooth/Wi-Fi
ANTENNA
3 Blu-ray MONITOR/ZONE3 ZONE2
Y
2 DVD
5 CD
SURROUND
CENTER
SUBWOOFER
AM
7.1CH IN
SIGNAL
GND
3 Blu-ray
ANTENNA
AUDIO
6 MEDIA PLAYER
STRAIGHT CABLE
DC12V 150mA MAX.
1
ZONE2
2
SURROUND BACK
PRE OUT
1 CBL/SAT
2 DVD 1 TV
AUDIO
5V/1A
MONITOR/ZONE3
PB/
CB
2
ZONE3
(ASSIGNABLE)
2 DVD
AC IN
PR/
CR
HEIGHT2
3 Blu-ray
ZONE2
VIDEO VIDEO
2 CD
(ASSIGNABLE)
COMPONENT VIDEO
COMPONENT VIDEO
(ASSIGNABLE)
IR
PHONO
AUDIO
FRONT
TRIGGER OUT
FRONT
REMOTE CONTROL
CENTER
RS-232C
COAXIAL
DIGITAL AUDIO
SURROUND
OPTICAL
(ASSIGNABLE)
SURROUND
SURROUND BACK
SURROUND BACK
ASSIGNABLE
FRONT WIDE/HEIGHT2
FRONT WIDE/HEIGHT2
HEIGHT1
ASSIGNABLE
SPEAKERS
HEIGHT1
ASSIGNABLE
.
IMPEDANCE : 4㹼16Ȑ
NOTE
0 Use a monaural mini-plug cable for connecting the TRIGGER OUT jacks. Do not use a stereo mini-plug cable.
0 If the permissible trigger input level for the connected device is larger than 12 V DC/150 mA, or has shorted, the TRIGGER OUT jack cannot be used. In this case, turn off the
power to the unit, and disconnect it.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
75
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Connecting the power cord
After completing all the connections, insert the power plug into the power outlet.
HDMI
ABLE)
5 MEDIA PLAYER
6 AUX2
NETWORK
MONITOR1
ZONE2
7 CD
MONITOR2
ARC
CENTER
FRONT WIDE
SUBWOOFER
1
HEIGHT1
2 DVD
HEIGHT2
3 Blu-ray
1 CBL/SAT 4 GAME
1 CBL/SAT
2 DVD
Bluetooth/Wi-Fi
ANTENNA
3 Blu-ray MONITOR/ZONE3 ZONE2
Y
D
PB/
CB
2
ACK
5V/1A
MONITOR/ZONE3
AC IN
PR/
CR
ZONE2
VIDEO VIDEO
(ASSIGNABLE)
COMPONENT VIDEO
COMPONENT VIDEO
(ASSIGNABLE)
E)
SURROUND BACK
SURROUND BACK
FRONT WIDE/HEIGHT2
ASSIGNABLE
FRONT WIDE/HEIGHT2
HEIGHT1
ASSIGNABLE
SPEAKERS
HEIGHT1
ASSIGNABLE
IMPEDANCE : 4㨪16ǡ
Power cord (supplied)
.
To household power outlet
(AC 230 V, 50/60 Hz)
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
76
Remote
Index
Appendix
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
o Contents
Playback network audio/service
Basic operation
Listening to Internet Radio
104
Playing back files stored on a PC and NAS
108
Turning the power on
78
Selecting the input source
78
Adjusting the volume
79
Turning off the sound temporarily (Muting)
79
Selecting a sound mode
116
Spotify Connect function
119
Convenience functions
Playing a DVD player/Blu-ray Disc player
79
Playing an iPod
80
Playing a USB memory device
85
Playing a Bluetooth device
90
Listening to FM/AM broadcasts
93
Display
112
AirPlay function
Convenience functions
131
Playback a device
Front panel
Viewing photographs on the Flickr site
Rear panel
120
HDMI control function
146
Sleep timer function
147
Quick select plus function
149
Other functions
77
Web control function
152
Playback in ZONE2/ZONE3 (Separate room)
154
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Basic operation
Turning the power on
POWER X
1
Press POWER X to turn on power to the unit.
0 You can press the input source select button when the unit is in standby mode to
turn on the power.
0 You can also switch the power to standby by pressing X on the main unit.
Input source
select buttons
Selecting the input source
VOLUME df
MUTE :
1
Press the input source select button to be played back.
The desired input source can be selected directly.
.
You can also select the input source by turning SOURCE SELECT on the main unit.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
78
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Adjusting the volume
1
Use VOLUME df to adjust the volume.
The following describes the procedure for playing DVD player/Blu-ray Disc
player.
1
2
3
Turning off the sound temporarily
(Muting)
4
Press MUTE :.
0 MUTE indicator on the display flashes.
Prepare for playback.
A Turn on the power of the TV, subwoofer and player.
B Change the TV input to the input of this unit.
Press POWER X to turn on power to the unit.
Press DVD or Blu-ray to switch an input source for a
player used for playback.
Play the DVD player or Blu-ray Disc player.
o Surround playback (v p. 131)
0 : appears on the TV screen.
0 The sound is reduced to the level set at “Mute Level” in the menu. (v p. 174)
0 To cancel mute, either adjust the sound volume or press MUTE : again.
Front panel
Display
Appendix
Playback a DVD player/Blu-ray Disc
player
0 The variable range differs according to the input signal and channel level setting.
0 You can also adjust the master volume by turning MASTER VOLUME on the main
unit.
1
Tips
Rear panel
79
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Playing an iPod
0 You can use the USB cable provided with the iPod to connect the iPod
with the unit’s USB port and enjoy music stored on the iPod.
0 For information on the iPod models that can be played back with this
unit, see “Supported iPod/iPhone models” (v p. 69).
0 See “AirPlay function” (v p. 116) on how to play a music file saved on
an iPhone, iPod touch, iPad or iTunes on this unit via the network.
iPod/USB
CH/PAGE df
OPTION
uio p
ENTER
BACK
.
1
89
67
3
2
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
80
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Listening to music on an iPod
1
2
0 Depending on the type of iPod and the software version, some functions may not
operate.
0 Note that Denon will accept no responsibility whatsoever for any problems arising
with the data on an iPod when using this unit in conjunction with the iPod.
Connect the iPod to the USB port. (v p. 67)
Press iPod/USB to switch the input source to “iPod/
USB”.
o Operations accessible through the option
menu
This can be operated when the “iPod Browse Mode” (v p. 82) is
set to “From iPod”.
0 “Setting the USB port to use (USB Select)” (v p. 83)
0 “iPod Browse Mode settings” (v p. 82)
0 “Adjusting the audibility of dialog and vocals (Dialog
Enhancer)” (v p. 125)
0 “Adjusting the volume of each channel to match the input source
(Channel Level Adjust)” (v p. 126)
0 “Adjusting the tone (Tone)” (v p. 127)
0 “Displaying your desired video during audio playback (Video
Select)” (v p. 128)
0 “Adjusting the picture quality for your viewing environment (Picture
Mode)” (v p. 129)
0 “Playing the same music in all zones (All Zone Stereo)” (v p. 130)
The USB port on the front panel can be used by default.
0 “Browse from iPod” is displayed on the display of this unit.
0 Nothing is displayed on the TV screen.
Operate iPod itself while seeing the iPod screen to play
back music.
0 “iPod Browse Mode” has two modes, “From iPod” and “On-Screen”. By default,
“From iPod”, where you operate the iPod itself while looking at the iPod screen, is
set.
0 To change to “On-Screen”, where you perform operations while having the iPod
information displayed on the TV screen, see “iPod Browse Mode settings”
(v p. 82).
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
Appendix
NOTE
0 Select the USB port to be used. (v p. 83)
3
Tips
81
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
iPod Browse Mode settings
Operation buttons
In this mode, various lists and screens during playback on the iPod are
displayed on the TV screen.
This section describes the steps up to playing back tracks on the iPod in
“On-Screen”.
1
2
3
Appendix
Function
1
Playback
3
Pause
2
Stop
89
Skip to previous track / Skip to next track
Press OPTION when the input source is “iPod/USB”.
67
(Press and hold) Fast-reverse / Fast-forward
The option menu screen is displayed.
ENTER
Select “iPod Browse Mode”, then press ENTER.
Playback / Pause
(Press and hold) Stop
Skip to previous track / Skip to next track
The “iPod Browse Mode” screen is displayed.
ui
Use o p to select “On-Screen”, then press ENTER.
CH/PAGE d f
0 Operations available for “On-Screen” and “From iPod” are listed
iPod Browse Mode
Playable
files
Active
buttons
From iPod
On-Screen
Music file
P
P
Video file
z
Remote control
unit (This unit)
P
iPod
(Press and hold) Fast-reverse / Fast-forward
Switch to the previous page/next page in the list
display
0 The actions of the operation buttons may differ.
below.
0 The display switches between track title, artist name, and album title etc. each time
the main unit’s STATUS is pressed during playback with “iPod Browse Mode” set
to “On-Screen”.
0 English letters, numbers and certain symbols are displayed. Incompatible
characters are displayed as “.” (period).
P
P
zOnly
4
Tips
the sound is played.
Use ui p to select the file to be played, then press
ENTER.
Playback starts.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
82
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
o Operations accessible through the option
menu
n Supported input sources:
iPod/USB
1
2
3
4
Display
Rear panel
Appendix
Setting the USB port to use (USB
Select)
This can be operated when the “iPod Browse Mode” is set to “OnScreen”. (v p. 82)
0 “Setting the USB port to use (USB Select)” (v p. 83)
0 “iPod Browse Mode settings” (v p. 82)
0 “Performing repeat playback” (v p. 84)
0 “Performing random playback” (v p. 84)
0 “Adjusting the audibility of dialog and vocals (Dialog
Enhancer)” (v p. 125)
0 “Adjusting the volume of each channel to match the input source
(Channel Level Adjust)” (v p. 126)
0 “Adjusting the tone (Tone)” (v p. 127)
0 “Displaying your desired video during audio playback (Video
Select)” (v p. 128)
0 “Playing the same music in all zones (All Zone Stereo)” (v p. 130)
Front panel
Tips
83
Press OPTION.
The option menu screen is displayed.
Use ui to select “USB Select”, then press ENTER.
Use o p to select the USB port to use.
Front
(Default):
Uses the USB port on the front panel.
Rear:
Uses the USB port on the rear panel.
Press ENTER.
The display returns to the playback screen.
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
1
Press OPTION with “iPod Browse Mode” set to “OnScreen”.
4
Press OPTION with “iPod Browse Mode” set to “OnScreen”.
The option menu screen is displayed.
The option menu screen is displayed.
2
3
Appendix
Performing random playback
Performing repeat playback
1
Tips
2
3
Use ui to select “Repeat”, then press ENTER.
Use o p to select repeat playback mode.
Use ui to select “Random”, then press ENTER.
Use o p to select random playback mode.
Off
(Default) :
Repeat playback mode is canceled.
Off
(Default):
Disable random playback.
One:
A file being played is played
repeatedly.
On:
Randomly play back all tracks in the
current playback folder.
All:
All files in the folder currently being
played are played repeatedly.
4
Press ENTER.
The display returns to the playback screen.
0 During random playback, each time playback of a track is completed, another
track is randomly selected for playback from tracks in the folder. Therefore, it’s
possible that you may hear a track played back more than once during random
playback.
0 “Random” settings are stored for each input source.
“Repeat” settings are stored for each input source.
Front panel
Display
Press ENTER.
The display returns to the playback screen.
Rear panel
84
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Playing a USB memory device
0 Playing back music or viewing still picture (JPEG) files stored on a USB
memory device.
0 Only USB memory devices conforming to mass storage class standards
can be played on this unit.
0 This unit is compatible with USB memory devices in “FAT16” or
“FAT32” format.
0 The audio/video format types and specifications supported by this unit
for playback are as follows.
See “Playback a USB memory device” for details. (v p. 304)
iPod/USB
0 WMA
0 MP3
0 WAV
CH/PAGE df
0 MPEG-4 AAC
0 FLAC
OPTION
uio p
ENTER
0 ALAC
0 AIFF
0 DSD
0 JPEG
BACK
.
1
89
67
3
2
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
85
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Playing files stored on USB memory
devices
1
2
Operation buttons
Connect the USB memory device to the USB port.
(v p. 67)
Press iPod/USB to switch the input source to “iPod/
USB”.
USB
Tips
Playback
3
Pause
2
Stop
89
Skip to previous track / Skip to next track
67
(Press and hold) Fast-reverse / Fast-forward
Playback / Pause
(Press and hold) Stop
Skip to previous track / Skip to next track
ui
Folder1
(Press and hold) Fast-reverse / Fast-forward
CH/PAGE d f
Folder2
Function
1
ENTER
[1/9]
Appendix
Folder3
Switch to the previous page/next page in the list
display
Music1
Music2
Music3
0 When an MP3 music file includes album art data, the album art can be displayed while
playing the file.
0 This unit plays back picture (JPEG) files in the order in which they are stored in the
folder.
Music4
Option
.
OPTION
Select the USB port to be used. (v p. 83) The USB port on the
front panel can be used by default.
3
NOTE
Note that Denon will accept no responsibility whatsoever for any problems arising with the
data on a USB memory device when using this unit in conjunction with the USB memory
device.
Use ui p to select the file to be played, then press
ENTER.
Playback starts.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
86
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
o Operations accessible through the option
menu
0 “Setting the USB port to use (USB Select)” (v p. 83)
0 “Performing repeat playback” (v p. 121)
0 “Performing random playback” (v p. 121)
0 “Searching content with keywords (Text Search)” (v p. 123)
0 “Playing back music and a favorite picture at the same time
(Slideshow)” (v p. 124)
0 “Setting the Slideshow Interval” (v p. 125)
0 “Adjusting the audibility of dialog and vocals (Dialog
Enhancer)” (v p. 125)
0 “Adjusting the volume of each channel to match the input source
(Channel Level Adjust)” (v p. 126)
0 “Adjusting the tone (Tone)” (v p. 127)
0 “Displaying your desired video during audio playback (Video
Select)” (v p. 128)
0 “Adjusting the picture quality for your viewing environment (Picture
Mode)” (v p. 129)
0 “Playing the same music in all zones (All Zone Stereo)” (v p. 130)
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
87
Remote
Index
Appendix
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Listening to music on a Bluetooth device
Music files stored on Bluetooth devices such as smartphones, digital
music players, etc. can be enjoyed on this unit by pairing and connecting
this unit with the Bluetooth device.
Communication is possible up to a range of about 10 m.
NOTE
To play back music from a Bluetooth device, the Bluetooth device needs to support
the A2DP profile.
Bluetooth
ui
ENTER
OPTION
BACK
.
1
89
67
3
2
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
88
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Pairing with a Bluetooth device
3
In order to enjoy music from a Bluetooth device on this unit, the Bluetooth
device must first be paired with this unit.
Once the Bluetooth device has been paired, it does not need to be paired
again.
2
At the end of the pairing, the device name appears on the display of
this unit.
0 Connect to the Bluetooth device while “Pairing” is being displayed
on the display of the unit.
Perform the connection with the Bluetooth device close to the unit
(about 1 m).
Prepare for playback.
A Connect the supplied external antennas for Bluetooth/wireless
connectivity to the Bluetooth/wireless LAN antenna connectors
on the rear panel. (v p. 22)
B Press POWER X to turn on power to the unit.
0 When connecting a second Bluetooth device, press and hold Bluetooth for
approximately 3 seconds or select “Pairing Mode” from the options menu to pair
the device. (v p. 92)
0 This unit can be paired with a maximum of 8 Bluetooth devices. When a 9th
Bluetooth device is paired, it will be registered in place of the oldest registered
device.
0 When a number appears on the display of this unit, check that it is the same
number as that shown on the screen of the Bluetooth device and then select “Pair”
for both the Bluetooth device and the unit.
0 Enter “0000” when the password is requested on the screen of the Bluetooth
device.
Press Bluetooth to switch the input source to
“Bluetooth”.
Bluetooth
Now Playing
Device
Music
Artist
Album
OPTION
Option
When using for the first time, the unit will go into the pairing mode
automatically and “Pairing...” will appear on the display of the unit.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
Appendix
Select this unit when its name appears in the list of
devices displayed on the screen of the Bluetooth
device.
.
1
Tips
89
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Playing a Bluetooth device
Operation buttons
Check the following before you play back music.
0 The Bluetooth function of the Bluetooth device must be turned on
0 Pairing must be completed
1
2
Tips
Press Bluetooth to switch the input source to
“Bluetooth”.
Appendix
Function
1
Playback
3
Pause
2
Stop
89
Skip to previous track / Skip to next track
67
(Press and hold) Fast-reverse / Fast-forward
The unit will automatically connect to the most recently used
Bluetooth device.
ENTER
Start playing the Bluetooth device.
ui
Playback / Pause
(Press and hold) Stop
Skip to previous track / Skip to next track
(Press and hold) Fast-reverse / Fast-forward
0 The Bluetooth device can also be operated with the remote
control of this unit.
0 When the power of this unit is turned on, the input source will be automatically
switched to “Bluetooth” if a Bluetooth device is connected.
0 When the “IP Control” setting of this unit is set to “Always On” and a Bluetooth
device is connected with the unit in the standby state, the power of the unit will be
turned on automatically. (v p. 245)
0 Press STATUS on this unit during playback to switch the display between Title
name, Artist name, Album name, etc.
0 English letters, numbers and certain symbols are displayed. Incompatible
characters are displayed as “.” (period).
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
90
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
NOTE
0 To operate the Bluetooth device with the remote control of this unit, the Bluetooth
device needs to support the AVRCP profile.
0 The remote control of this unit is not guaranteed to work with all Bluetooth devices.
0 Depending on the type of Bluetooth device, this unit outputs audio that is coupled
to the volume setting on the Bluetooth device.
o Operations accessible through the option
menu
0 “Pairing with the Pairing Mode” (v p. 92)
0 “Performing repeat playback” (v p. 121)
0 “Performing random playback” (v p. 121)
0 “Adjusting the audibility of dialog and vocals (Dialog
Enhancer)” (v p. 125)
0 “Adjusting the volume of each channel to match the input source
(Channel Level Adjust)” (v p. 126)
0 “Adjusting the tone (Tone)” (v p. 127)
0 “Displaying your desired video during audio playback (Video
Select)” (v p. 128)
0 “Playing the same music in all zones (All Zone Stereo)” (v p. 130)
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
91
Remote
Index
Appendix
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Pairing with the Pairing Mode
2
3
Press OPTION when the input source is “Bluetooth”.
The option menu screen is displayed.
Use ui to select “Pairing Mode”, then press ENTER.
The device will go into the pairing mode.
Select this unit when its name appears in the list of
devices displayed on the screen of the Bluetooth
device.
At the end of the pairing, the device name appears on the display of
this unit.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
Appendix
0 When a number appears on the display of this unit, check that it is the same
number as that shown on the screen of the Bluetooth device and then select “Pair”
for both the Bluetooth device and the unit.
0 Enter “0000” when the password is requested on the screen of the Bluetooth
device.
Pair a Bluetooth device with this unit.
1
Tips
92
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Listening to FM/AM broadcasts
AVR CONTROL
Z2
You can use the built-in tuner of this unit to listen to FM broadcasts and
AM broadcasts.
Make sure the FM antenna and AM loop antenna are connected to this
unit first.
POWER
Z3
MAIN
DEV.
V.
TV
AVR
DEVICE
TV
MENU
MENU
CB /
CBL
SAT
DVD
VD
INP
INPUT
TV
AUDIO
Blu-ray
AUX1
TUNER
Bluetooth
GAME
AUX2
PHONO
iPo
iPod/
USB
MEDIA
IA
PLAYER
ER
CD
ONLINE
MUSIC
INTERNET
RADIO
ADIO
1
2
TUNER
QUICK SELECT
3
4
ECO
CH/PAGE df
uio p
ENTER
BACK
CH /PAGE
PAGE
VOLUME
MUTE
INFO
OPTION
OPTION
ENTER
SETUP
BACK
TUNE
TUNE
TUNE +, –
SOUND MODE
MOVIE
1
GH I
GHI
GAME
PURE
ABC
DEF
SLEEP
EP
2
3
JKL
JK
MNO
MNO
4
5
6
PQ
QR
RS
TUV
WXYZ
WX
7
8
9
+10
0
ENTER
.
0–9
MUSIC
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
93
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Listening to FM/AM broadcasts
1
2
5
Connect the antenna. (“Connecting an FM/AM
antenna” (v p. 70))
6
Press TUNER to switch the input source to “Tuner”.
G TV screen H
STEREO
CH /
Preset
OPTION
FM:
When listening to an FM broadcast.
AM:
When listening to an AM broadcast.
Press TUNE + or TUNE - to select the station you want
listen to.
The modes for receiving FM broadcasts consists of “Auto” mode that automatically
searches available broadcast stations and “Manual” mode that lets you tune in using
buttons to change the frequency. The default setting is “Auto”. You can also use
“Direct Tune” to tune in by entering the frequency directly.
In “Auto” mode, you cannot tune in to radio stations if the reception is not good.
If this is the case, then use the “Manual” mode or “Direct Tune” mode to tune in.
FM 87.50MHz
Tune
Use o p to select “FM” or “AM”, then press ENTER.
AUTO
Now Playing
Option
Operation buttons
.
TUNE+/-
G Display of this unit H
87.50MHz
Function
TUNE +, –
Selects the radio station (up/down)
CH/PAGE d f
Selects preset radio stations
0–9
Preset channel selection/Direct frequency tuning
.
01 FM
3
4
Press OPTION.
The option menu screen is displayed.
Use ui to select “FM/AM”, then press ENTER.
This displays the reception band input screen.
Front panel
Display
Appendix
Scanning is performed until it finds an available radio station. When
it finds a radio station, it stops the scan automatically and tunes in.
Tuner
CH 1
Tips
Rear panel
94
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
o Operations accessible through the option
menu
0 “Tuning in by entering the frequency (Direct Tune)” (v p. 96)
0 “RDS search” (v p. 96)
0 “PTY search” (v p. 97)
0 “TP search” (v p. 98)
0 “Radio Text” (v p. 98)
0 “Changing the tune mode (Tune Mode)” (v p. 99)
0 “Tuning in to stations and presetting them automatically (Auto Preset
Memory)” (v p. 99)
0 “Presetting the current broadcast station (Preset
Memory)” (v p. 100)
0 “Specify a name for the preset broadcast station (Preset
Name)” (v p. 101)
0 “Skipping preset broadcast stations (Preset Skip)” (v p. 102)
0 “Adjusting the audibility of dialog and vocals (Dialog
Enhancer)” (v p. 125)
0 “Adjusting the volume of each channel to match the input source
(Channel Level Adjust)” (v p. 126)
0 “Adjusting the tone (Tone)” (v p. 127)
0 “Displaying your desired video during audio playback (Video
Select)” (v p. 128)
0 “Playing the same music in all zones (All Zone Stereo)” (v p. 130)
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
95
Remote
Index
Appendix
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tuning in by entering the frequency
(Direct Tune)
2
3
4
5
RDS is a broadcasting service which allows a station to send additional
information along with the regular radio program signal.
Use this function to automatically tune to FM stations that provide the RDS
service.
Note that the RDS function only works when receiving RDS compatible
stations.
Press OPTION when the input source is “Tuner”.
The option menu screen is displayed.
1
Use ui to select “Direct Tune”, then press ENTER.
The screen that lets you enter the frequency is displayed.
2
3
Use ui or 0 – 9 to select a number and press p.
0 If o is pressed, the immediately preceding input is cancelled.
Repeat step 3 and enter the frequency of the radio
station you want to hear.
When setting is completed, press ENTER.
Display
Rear panel
Press OPTION when the input source is “Tuner”.
The option menu screen is displayed.
Use ui to select “RDS Search”, then press ENTER.
Press ENTER.
The search for RDS stations begins automatically.
If you use o p within 5 seconds after the broadcast station name is shown on the
display, you can search for a different station.
The preset frequency is tuned in.
Front panel
Appendix
RDS search
You can enter the receiving frequency directly to tune in.
1
Tips
96
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
PTY search
1
Use this function to find RDS stations broadcasting a designated program
type (PTY).
PTY identifies the type of RDS program.
The program types and their displays are as follows:
NEWS
News
WEATHER
Weather
AFFAIRS
Current Affairs
FINANCE
Finance
INFO
Information
CHILDREN
Children’s program
SPORT
Sports
SOCIAL
Social Affairs
EDUCATE
Education
RELIGION
Religion
DRAMA
Drama
PHONE IN
Phone In
CULTURE
Culture
TRAVEL
Travel
SCIENCE
Science
LEISURE
Leisure
VARIED
Varied
JAZZ
Jazz Music
POP M
Pop Music
COUNTRY
Country Music
ROCK M
Rock Music
NATION M
National Music
EASY M
Easy Listening Music
OLDIES
Oldies Music
LIGHT M
Light Classical
FOLK M
Folk Music
CLASSICS
Serious Classical
DOCUMENT
Documentary
OTHER M
Other Music
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
2
3
4
Tips
Appendix
Press OPTION when the input source is “Tuner”.
The option menu screen is displayed.
Use ui to select “PTY Search”, then press ENTER.
Use ui to call out the desired program type.
Press ENTER.
PTY search begins automatically.
If you use o p within 5 seconds after the broadcast station name is shown on the
display, you can search for a different station.
97
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
TP search
Tips
Appendix
Radio Text
TP identifies programs that carry traffic announcements.
This allows you to easily find out the latest traffic conditions in your area
before leaving home.
Use this function to find RDS stations broadcasting traffic programs (TP
stations).
RT allows RDS stations to send text messages that appear on the display.
“Radio text” appears on the display when radio text data is received.
1
2
3
2
3
1
Press OPTION when the input source is “Tuner”.
The option menu screen is displayed.
Use ui to select “TP Search”, then press ENTER.
Press OPTION when the input source is “Tuner”.
The option menu screen is displayed.
Use ui to select “Radio text”, then press ENTER.
Use o p to select “On”, then press ENTER.
0 While receiving an RDS broadcast station, the text data
broadcast from the station is displayed.
Press ENTER.
0 If no text data is being broadcast, “NO TEXT DATA” is displayed.
TP search begins automatically.
If you use o p within 5 seconds after the broadcast station name is shown on the
display, you can search for a different station.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
98
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Changing the tune mode (Tune Mode)
2
3
A maximum of 56 radio stations can be automatically preset.
Press OPTION when the input source is “Tuner”.
1
The option menu screen is displayed.
Use ui to select “Tune Mode”, then press ENTER.
Use o p to select the tune mode, then press ENTER.
2
Auto:
Automatically search for and tune to a receivable radio
station.
3
Manual:
Manually change the frequency one step at a time each
time the button is pressed.
Press OPTION when the input source is “Tuner”.
The option menu screen is displayed.
Use ui to select “Auto Preset Memory”, then press
ENTER.
Press ENTER.
The unit starts to tune in to radio stations automatically and preset
them.
0 When presetting is completed, “Completed” is displayed for about
5 seconds and the option menu screen turns off.
The preset memory is overwritten.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
Appendix
Tuning in to stations and presetting
them automatically (Auto Preset
Memory)
You can change the mode for tuning into FM and AM broadcasts. If you
cannot tune in automatically with “Auto” mode, change the mode to
“Manual” and tune in manually.
1
Tips
99
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Presetting the current broadcast
station (Preset Memory)
Channel
2
3
4
Appendix
Default settings
1–8
87.50 / 89.10 / 98.10 / 108.00 / 90.10 / 90.10 / 90.10 /
90.10 MHz
9 – 16
90.10 / 90.10 / 90.10 / 90.10 / 90.10 / 90.10 / 90.10 / 90.10
MHz
17 – 24
Tune in the broadcast station you want to preset.
(“Listening to FM/AM broadcasts” (v p. 94))
90.10 / 90.10 / 90.10 / 90.10 / 90.10 / 90.10 / 90.10 / 90.10
MHz
25 – 32
90.10 / 90.10 / 90.10 / 90.10 / 90.10 / 90.10 / 90.10 / 90.10
MHz
Press OPTION.
33 – 40
90.10 / 90.10 / 90.10 / 90.10 / 90.10 / 90.10 / 90.10 / 90.10
MHz
41 – 48
90.10 / 90.10 / 90.10 / 90.10 / 90.10 / 90.10 / 90.10 / 90.10
MHz
49 – 56
90.10 / 90.10 / 90.10 / 90.10 / 90.10 / 90.10 / 90.10 / 90.10
MHz
Your favorite broadcast stations can be preset so that you can tune them
in easily.
Up to 56 stations can be preset.
1
Tips
The option menu screen is displayed.
Use ui to select “Preset Memory”, then press ENTER.
The list of already preset channels is displayed.
Use ui or 0 – 9 to select the channel you want to
preset, then press ENTER.
The current broadcast station that is preset.
0 To preset other stations, repeat steps 1 to 4.
Listening to preset stations
1
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
100
Use CH/PAGE df or 0 – 9 to select the desired preset
channel.
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Specify a name for the preset
broadcast station (Preset Name)
5
You can set the name to the preset broadcast station or change it.
Up to eight characters can be input.
1
2
3
4
6
Press OPTION when the input source is “Tuner”.
The option menu screen is displayed.
Tips
Use ui to select a name label, then press ENTER.
The screen that lets you edit the Preset Name is displayed.
0 If you select “Set Defaults”, then the unit returns to displaying the
frequency.
Enter the characters, then press “OK”.
0 For character input, see “Using the keyboard
screen” (v p. 166).
7
Use ui to select “Preset Name”, then press ENTER.
The Preset Name screen is displayed.
Press OPTION to return to the previous screen.
Use o p to select the group of the broadcast station
you want to name.
Use ui to select the broadcast station you want to
name, then press ENTER.
Front panel
Display
Appendix
Rear panel
101
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Skipping preset broadcast stations
(Preset Skip)
2
3
A Use o p to select the group of broadcast stations you want
to skip.
B Use ui to select the broadcast station you want to skip.
C Use o p to select “Skip”.
The station you selected is not displayed.
4
Press OPTION when the input source is “Tuner”.
The option menu screen is displayed.
Press OPTION to return to the previous screen.
Use ui to select “Preset Skip”, then press ENTER.
The “Preset Skip” screen is displayed.
n To set the stations you want to skip by groups
A Use o p to select the group of broadcast stations you want to
skip.
B Press u to select “Set No.z – z to Skip”, then press ENTER.
Skip all the broadcast stations that are included in the
selected group “z-z”.
(z is the selected group number.)
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
Appendix
n To set the stations you want to skip by
stations
Perform auto preset memory to save all the broadcasting stations that can
be received in the memory. Selecting a broadcast station becomes easier
by skipping unnecessary memories.
1
Tips
102
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Cancelling Preset Skip
1
2
3
Use o p to select a group containing a broadcast
station to cancel the skip for while the “Preset Skip ”
screen is displayed.
Use ui to select a broadcast station to cancel the skip
for.
Use o p to select “On”.
The skip is cancelled.
NOTE
Preset skip cannot be cancelled for groups.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
103
Remote
Index
Appendix
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Listening to Internet Radio
0 Internet Radio refers to radio broadcasts distributed over the Internet.
Internet Radio stations from around the world can be received.
0 The Internet radio station list on this unit the database service provided
by vTuner radio station.
0 The audio format types and specifications supported by this unit for
playback are as follows.
See “Playing an Internet Radio Station” (v p. 307) for details.
ONLINE
MUSIC
INTERNET
RADIO
0 WMA
0 MP3
0 MPEG-4 AAC
CH/PAGE df
OPTION
uio p
ENTER
BACK
.
1
2
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
104
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Listening to Internet Radio
1
4
Prepare for playback.
0 Check the network environment, then turn on this unit’s power.
(“Connecting to a home network (LAN)” (v p. 72))
2
Press ONLINE MUSIC.
0 You can also press INTERNET RADIO to select the input source
“Internet Radio” directly.
Use uio p to select “Internet Radio”, then press
ENTER.
Online Music
Favorites
Name of country:
Select the various regions.
Displays typical Internet Radio stations.
Search Stations :
Displays all Internet Radio stations that this
unit can tune in to.
Search Podcasts :
Displays Internet Radio stations in the
podcasts that this unit can tune in to.
Recommended
Stations :
Displays recommended Internet Radio
stations.
radiodenon.com :
Displays Internet Radio stations added to
favorites in vTuner. For instructions on how
to add to favorites in vTuner, see “Using
vTuner to add Internet Radio stations to
favorites” (v p. 107).
Recently Played :
Displays recently played Internet Radio
stations. Up to 20 stations can be stored in
“Recently Played”.
Media Server
Front panel
Appendix
Use ui to select the search method for the radio
station that you wish to playback and then press
ENTER.
Internet Radio
Displays Internet Radio stations searched
Search by Keyword : by keyword. For character input, see
“Using the keyboard screen” (v p. 166).
.
3
Tips
Display
Rear panel
105
Remote
Index
Contents
5
Connections
Playback
Settings
Operation buttons
Function
1
Playback
2
Stop
ENTER
(Press and hold) Stop
CH/PAGE d f
Switch to the previous page/next page in the list
display
Appendix
Playing the last played Internet Radio
station
Use ui p to select the station, then press ENTER.
Playback starts once buffering reaches “100%”.
1
Tips
Press INTERNET RADIO.
The source switches to “Internet Radio” and the last played radio
station plays.
o Operations accessible through the option
menu
0 “Searching content with keywords (Text Search)” (v p. 123)
0 “Playing back music and a favorite picture at the same time
0 The display switches between track title and radio station name etc. each time the
main unit’s STATUS is pressed.
0 Any characters that cannot be displayed are replaced with “.” (period).
(Slideshow)” (v p. 124)
0 “Adjusting the audibility of dialog and vocals (Dialog
Enhancer)” (v p. 125)
NOTE
0 “Adjusting the volume of each channel to match the input source
(Channel Level Adjust)” (v p. 126)
The radio station database service may be suspended or be otherwise unavailable
without notice.
0 “Adjusting the tone (Tone)” (v p. 127)
0 “Displaying your desired video during audio playback (Video
Select)” (v p. 128)
0 “Playing the same music in all zones (All Zone Stereo)” (v p. 130)
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
106
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Using vTuner to add Internet Radio
stations to favorites
4
5
There are many Internet Radio stations in the world, and this unit can tune
into these stations. But finding the radio station you want to hear may be
difficult, because there are too many stations. If this is the case, then
please use vTuner, an Internet Radio station search website specifically
designed for this unit. You can use your PC to search Internet Radio
stations and add them as your favorites. This unit can play radio stations
added to vTuner.
1
6
7
Check the MAC address of this unit.
(“Information” (v p. 241))
Use your PC to access the vTuner website (http://
www.radiodenon.com).
Display
Rear panel
Select the search criteria (genre, region, language,
etc.) of your choice.
Select the radio station of your choice from the list, and
then click the Add to Favorites icon.
Enter the name of the favorite group, then click “Go”.
A new favorite group that includes the selected radio station is
created.
0 Internet Radio stations added to favorites in vTuner can be played
from “radiodenon.com” with this unit. (v p. 105)
You can also add a radio station that is not in the vTuner list.
Enter the MAC address of this unit, then click “Go”.
Front panel
Enter your E-mail address and a password of your
choice.
hear.
vTuner.
3
Appendix
0 You can also enter a keyword to search for a station you want to
0 The MAC address is necessary when you create an account for
2
Tips
107
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Playing back files stored on a PC and NAS
0 This unit can play back music files and playlists (m3u, wpl) stored on a
PC and on Network Attached Storage (NAS) that supports DLNA.
0 The network audio playback function of this unit connects to the server
using technologies shown below.
Windows Media Player Network Sharing Service
0 The audio/video format types and specifications supported by this unit
for playback are as follows.
For details, see “Playing back a file saved on a PC or
NAS” (v p. 306).
ONLINE
MUSIC
0 WMA
0 MP3
0 WAV
0 MPEG-4 AAC
CH/PAGE df
0 FLAC
0 ALAC
OPTION
uio p
ENTER
0 AIFF
0 DSD
0 JPEG
BACK
.
1
89
67
3
2
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
108
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Applying media sharing settings
Here, we apply the settings to share music files stored on a PC and NAS on the network.
If you are using a Media Server, be sure to apply this setting first.
.
o When using Windows Media Player 11
o When using Windows Media Player 12
(Windows 7 / Windows 8)
1
2
3
4
5
1
2
3
Start up Windows Media Player 12 on the PC.
Select “More streaming options...” in the “Stream”.
Select “Allowed” in the “Denon AVR-X7200W” dropdown list.
4
Select “Allowed” in the drop-down list for “Media
programs on this PC and remote connections...”.
5
Follow the screen instructions to end the setting.
Start up Windows Media Player 11 on the PC.
Select “Media Sharing” in the “Library”.
Click the “Share my media” check box, select “Denon
AVR-X7200W”, and then click “Allow”.
As you did in step 3, select the icon of the device (other
PCs and mobile devices) you want to use as a media
controller, and then click “Allow”.
Click “OK” to finish.
o Sharing media stored in NAS
Change settings on the NAS to allow this unit and other devices (PCs
and mobile devices) used as media controllers to access the NAS. For
details, see the owner’s manual that came with the NAS.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
109
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Playing back files stored on a PC and
NAS
4
5
Use this procedure to play music files, image files or playlists.
2
3
Prepare for playback.
Appendix
Use ui to select the server including the file to be
played, then press ENTER.
Use iu p to select the file, then press ENTER.
Playback starts once buffering reaches “100%”.
A Check the network environment, then turn on this unit’s power.
(“Connecting to a home network (LAN)” (v p. 72))
B Prepare the computer. (vComputer’s operating instructions)
Operation buttons
Function
1
Playback
3
Pause
Press ONLINE MUSIC.
2
Stop
Use uio p to select “Media Server”, then press
ENTER.
89
Skip to previous track / Skip to next track
67
(Press and hold) Fast-reverse / Fast-forward
Playback / Pause
ENTER
(Press and hold) Stop
Online Music
Favorites
Skip to previous track / Skip to next track
ui
Internet Radio
(Press and hold) Fast-reverse / Fast-forward
CH/PAGE d f
Media Server
Switch to the previous page/next page in the list
display
.
1
Tips
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
110
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Appendix
o Operations accessible through the option
menu
0 The display switches between track title, artist name, and album title each time the
main unit’s STATUS is pressed.
0 When a WMA (Windows Media Audio), MP3 or MPEG-4 AAC file includes album
art data, the album art can be displayed while the music files are playing.
0 If you use Ver.11 or later of Windows Media Player, the album art for WMA files
can be displayed.
0 WMA Lossless files can be played when using a server supporting transcoding,
such as Windows Media Player (Ver.11 or later).
0 This unit plays back picture (JPEG) files in the order in which they are stored in the
folder.
0 “Performing repeat playback” (v p. 121)
0 “Performing random playback” (v p. 121)
0 “Searching content with keywords (Text Search)” (v p. 123)
0 “Playing back music and a favorite picture at the same time
(Slideshow)” (v p. 124)
0 “Setting the Slideshow Interval” (v p. 125)
0 “Adjusting the audibility of dialog and vocals (Dialog
Enhancer)” (v p. 125)
0 “Adjusting the volume of each channel to match the input source
NOTE
(Channel Level Adjust)” (v p. 126)
0 “Adjusting the tone (Tone)” (v p. 127)
0 When playing back music files with your PC or NAS connected through wireless
LAN, audio may be interrupted depending on your wireless LAN environment. In
this case, connect using a wired LAN.
0 Depending on the size of the still picture (JPEG) file, some time may be required
for the file to be displayed.
0 The order in which the tracks/files are displayed depends on the server
specifications. If the tracks/files are not displayed in alphabetical order due to the
server specifications, searching by the first letter may not work properly.
Front panel
Tips
Display
Rear panel
0 “Displaying your desired video during audio playback (Video
Select)” (v p. 128)
0 “Adjusting the picture quality for your viewing environment (Picture
Mode)” (v p. 129)
0 “Playing the same music in all zones (All Zone Stereo)” (v p. 130)
111
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Viewing photographs on the Flickr site
0 Flickr is an online photo sharing service. You can use this unit to view
photographs that have been made public by Flickr users. You do not
need an account to use Flickr.
To view photographs that you recorded yourself, you need an account
in order to upload these photographs to the Flickr server.
For details, see the Flickr homepage.
http://www.flickr.com/
0 You can view photographs shared by particular users, or all of the
photographs shared on Flickr.
ONLINE
MUSIC
CH/PAGE df
OPTION
uio p
ENTER
BACK
.
1
2
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
112
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Viewing photographs shared by
particular users
1
4
5
Prepare for playback.
Use ui to select “Add Flickr Contact”, then press
ENTER.
Enter the screen name that you wish to add to
“Contact” (Screen Name: User name you wish to view).
screen” (v p. 166).
6
Press ONLINE MUSIC.
Use uio p to select “Flickr”, then press ENTER.
Online Music
Favorites
7
Internet Radio
After inputting the “Contact”, press “OK”.
The screen name is added to “Contact”, and the screen name you
entered in step 5 is displayed on the top screen of Flickr.
0 If you enter a screen name that does not exist, “The Flickr Contact
you entered could not be found” is displayed. Check and enter
the correct screen name.
Use ui to select the screen name added to “Contact”,
then press ENTER.
.
Media Server
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
Appendix
0 For character input, see “Using the keyboard
0 Check the network environment, then turn on this unit’s power.
(“Connecting to a home network (LAN)” (v p. 72))
2
3
Tips
113
Remote
Index
Contents
8
Connections
Playback
Settings
9
Use ui to select the folder, then press ENTER.
Use ui p to select the photograph, then press ENTER.
Displays the favorite photographs of the
specified user.
Operation buttons
Photostream :
Displays a list of shared photographs.
1
Displays the folder (photograph album) list.
Contacts :
Displays the screen name used by the
specified user in Contacts.
Remove this
Contact :
Deletes a user from Flickr Contact.
Add this Contact :
Adds a user from Flickr Contact.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
Function
Playback
Stop
2
Playback
ENTER
114
Appendix
The selected photograph is displayed.
Favorites :
PhotoSets :
Tips
(Press and hold) Stop
ui
Display previous photograph / Display next
photograph
CH/PAGE d f
Switch to the previous page/next page in the list
display
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
0 “Setting the Slideshow Interval” (v p. 125)
Use ui to select “All Content”, then press ENTER.
0 “Adjusting the picture quality for your viewing environment (Picture
Mode)” (v p. 129)
Use ui to select the folder, and then press ENTER.
Displays photographs that are popular from the
Interestingness : number of user comments or number of times
they are added as favorites.
Recent :
Displays the most recently added photographs.
Search by text : Search for photographs by keyword.
3
Use ui p to select the photograph, then press ENTER.
The selected photograph is displayed.
NOTE
Depending on the file format, some photographs may not be viewable.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
Appendix
o Operations accessible through the option
menu
Viewing all photographs on Flickr
1
2
Tips
115
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
AirPlay function
Music files stored on your iPhone, iPod touch, iPad or iTunes can be
played on this unit via the network.
This unit
+ is displayed on the menu screen while AirPlay is being operated.
Source input will be switched to “Online Music” when AirPlay playback is started.
You can stop AirPlay playback by pressing o or choosing other input source.
To see song and artist names together, press STATUS on the main unit.
For information about how to use iTunes, also see the Help for iTunes.
The screen may differ depending on the OS and software versions.
Router
.
0
0
0
0
0
0
PC
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
116
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Playing songs from your iPhone, iPod
touch or iPad
1
2
Connect your iPhone, iPod touch or iPad Wi-Fi to the
same network as this unit.
0 For details, see your device’s manual.
2
Install iTunes 10, or later, on a Mac or Windows PC that
is connected to the same network as this unit.
Turn this unit ON.
Set “IP Control” to “Always On” for this unit. (v p. 245)
NOTE
Play the song on your iPhone, iPod touch or iPad.
When “IP Control” is set to “Always On”, the unit consumes more standby
power.
' is displayed on the iPhone, iPod touch or iPad screen.
3
Tap the AirPlay icon '.
Start iTunes and click the AirPlay icon ' to select the
main unit.
.
3
Appendix
Playing iTunes music with this unit
If you update your “iPhone/iPod touch/iPad” to iOS 4.2.1 or later, you can
stream music stored in your “iPhone/iPod touch/iPad” directly to this unit.
1
Tips
4
AirPlay
.
AirDrop
Choose a song and click play in iTunes.
The music will stream to this unit.
4
Select the speaker (devices) you want to use.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
117
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Selecting multiple speakers (devices)
With this unit’s remote control unit, you can perform iTunes song play,
pause, and auto search (cue) operations.
Click the AirPlay icon ' and select “Multiple”.
1
2
3
Check the speakers you want to use.
NOTE
In playback using the AirPlay function, the sound is output at the iPhone, iPod touch,
iPad or iTunes volume setting level.
You should turn down the iPhone, iPod touch, iPad or iTunes volume prior to
playback and then adjust it to a suitable level.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
Appendix
Perform iTunes playback operations
with the remote control unit of this unit
It is possible to play iTunes songs on your home’s AirPlay compatible
speakers (devices) other than those of this unit.
1
2
Tips
118
Select the “Edit” - “Preferences...” in the iTunes menu.
Select “Devices” in the iTunes setting window.
Check “Allow iTunes audio control from remote
speakers”, and then click “OK”.
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Spotify Connect function
Spotify is the world’s most popular streaming service. If you subscribe to
Spotify Premium, you can control your new speaker with your phone or
tablet. Because Spotify is built-in to your speaker, you can still take calls or
use other apps - the music never stops.
To try Spotify Premium free for 30 days, or learn more about Connect,
please go to www.spotify.com/connect.
Playing Spotify music with this unit
Download the “Spotify App” onto your Android or iOS device beforehand.
To play a Spotify track in this unit, you need to register in the Spotify
premium account first.
1
Spotify server
2
3
4
Launch the Spotify App.
Play back the Spotify track.
Tap the F icon to select the unit.
Control
0:13
4:44
.
Audio streaming/control
Connect the Wi-Fi settings of the iOS or Android device
in the same network as this unit.
The music will stream to this unit.
This unit
.
Spotify App
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
119
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Convenience functions
This section explains how to use convenient functions that can be used for
each input source.
ONLINE
MUSIC
OPTION
.
uio p
ENTER
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
120
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Performing repeat playback
Tips
Performing random playback
n Supported input sources:
USB / Media Server / Bluetooth
n Supported input sources :
USB / Media Server / Bluetooth
1
1
2
3
4
Appendix
While content is playing, press OPTION.
The option menu screen is displayed.
2
3
Use ui to select “Repeat”, then press ENTER.
Use o p to select repeat playback mode.
While content is playing, press OPTION.
The option menu screen is displayed.
Use ui to select “Random”, then press ENTER.
Use o p to select random playback mode.
Off
(Default):
Repeat playback mode is canceled.
Off
(Default):
Disable random playback.
One:
A file being played is played
repeatedly.
On:
Randomly play back all tracks in the
current playback folder.
All:
All files in the folder currently being
played are played repeatedly.
4
Press ENTER.
The display returns to the playback screen.
0 During random playback, each time playback of a track is completed, another
track is randomly selected for playback from tracks in the folder. Therefore, it’s
possible that you may hear a track played back more than once during random
playback.
0 This cannot be set up if the Bluetooth device does not support the random setting
under the AVRCP profile.
0 “Random” settings are stored for each input source.
0 This cannot be set up if the Bluetooth device does not support the repeat setting
under the AVRCP profile.
0 “Repeat” settings are stored for each input source.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
Press ENTER.
The display returns to the playback screen.
121
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Registering to Favorites
n Supported input sources:
Internet Radio / Media Server
1
2
While content is playing, press OPTION.
Press ONLINE MUSIC.
Use uio p to select “Favorites”, then press ENTER.
The option menu screen is displayed.
Online Music
Use ui to select “Save to Favorites”, then press
ENTER.
Favorites
“Favorite added” is displayed, and the current content is added to
favorites.
0 The display returns to the playback screen when the procedure is
completed.
Internet Radio
Media Server
.
2
Appendix
Playing back content added to the
“Save to Favorites”
You can register a total of 100 favorites.
1
Tips
3
Use ui to select the content you want to play, then
press ENTER.
Playback starts.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
122
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Deleting content added to favorites
1
2
3
Appendix
Searching content with keywords (Text
Search)
Press ONLINE MUSIC.
Use uio p to select “Favorites”, then press ENTER.
n Supported input sources :
USB / Internet Radio / Media Server
Use ui to select the content you want to delete from
favorites, then press OPTION.
1
The option menu screen is displayed.
4
Tips
2
Use ui to select “Remove from Favorites”, then press
ENTER.
“Favorite removed” is displayed, and the selected content is deleted
from favorites.
0 The screen returns to the previous screen when the delete
process is complete.
3
While the content is playing, press OPTION.
The option menu screen is displayed.
Use ui to select “Text Search”, then press ENTER.
The keyboard input screen is displayed.
Enter the first character of the Internet Radio station or
file you want to search for, and then press “OK”.
0 For character input, see “Using the keyboard
screen” (v p. 166).
4
Use ui to select the content you want to play, then
press ENTER.
Playback starts.
“Text Search” searches for Internet Radio stations or files that start with the entered
first character from the displayed list.
NOTE
Text Search may not work for some lists.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
123
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Playing back music and a favorite picture at the same time (Slideshow)
n Supported input sources : USB
1
n Supported input sources :
Internet Radio / Media Server
Play back a still picture.
1
0 Playing back still pictures stored on USB memory devices.
(v p. 86)
2
3
4
2
Press OPTION.
The option menu screen is displayed.
3
Use ui to select “Slideshow”, then press ENTER.
The option menu disappears, and the picture you were viewing is
shown on the screen.
Display
0 Play back still pictures stored on Media Server. (v p. 108)
0 Play back still pictures stored on Flickr. (v p. 112)
Play back a music file. (v p. 86)
Front panel
Play back a still picture.
Rear panel
4
124
Play back a music file of Media Server or Internet Radio
station. (v p. 104, 108)
Press OPTION.
The option menu screen is displayed.
Use ui to select “Slideshow”, then press ENTER.
The option menu disappears, and the picture you were viewing is
shown on the screen.
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Setting the Slideshow Interval
This function adjusts the center channel frequency band to enhance the
dialog in the movies and vocals in music for easier listening.
n Supported input sources :
USB / Media Server / Flickr
2
3
1
2
While the list is displayed, press OPTION.
The option menu screen is displayed.
3
Use ui to select “Slideshow Interval”, then press
ENTER.
Use o p to set the display time.
Off:
4
The slide show is not played back.
5s - 60s
Set the time for displaying a single picture when
(Default: 5s): playing back images in the slide show.
4
The “Slideshow Interval” settings are reflected for all input sources.
Display
Rear panel
Press OPTION.
Use ui to select “Dialog Enhancer”, then press
ENTER.
Use o p to select your favorite enhancement effect.
Off
(Default):
Does not enhance the dialog or
vocals.
Low / Medium / High:
Enhances the dialog and vocals.
Press ENTER.
0 “Dialog Enhancer” settings are stored for each source.
0 This cannot be set when the sound mode is set to “Direct”, “Virtual” or “Pure
Direct”.
0 This cannot be set when the input mode is set to “7.1CH IN”.
Press ENTER.
Front panel
Appendix
Adjusting the audibility of dialog and
vocals (Dialog Enhancer)
Set the playback interval when playing back a slideshow of still picture
(JPEG) files stored on a USB memory device or media server, or on the
Flickr website.
1
Tips
125
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Adjusting the volume of each channel
to match the input source (Channel
Level Adjust)
2
Press OPTION.
The option menu screen is displayed.
Use ui to select “Channel Level Adjust”, then press
ENTER.
The channel level adjust screen is displayed.
3
4
Use ui to select the channel that you wish to adjust.
Use o p to adjust the volume.
–12.0 dB – +12.0 dB (Default : 0.0 dB)
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
Appendix
0 Select “Reset” and press ENTER if you want to restore the adjustment values of
the various channels to “0.0 dB” (default).
0 Headphone volume can be adjusted when a headphone is connected.
0 “Channel Level Adjust” settings are stored for each input source.
0 You can only set this for speakers that output audio. In addition, you cannot set
this when in the menu “HDMI Audio Out” is set to “TV”. (v p. 184)
The volume of each channel can be changed while listening to music. You
can set this for each input source.
1
Tips
126
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Adjusting the tone (Tone)
4
Adjusts the tonal quality of the sound.
1
2
3
Press OPTION.
The option menu screen is displayed.
5
Use ui to select “Tone”, then press ENTER.
The Tone screen is displayed.
Tips
Appendix
Select “On” in step 3 and press i to select the sound
range to be adjusted.
Bass:
Adjust bass.
Treble:
Adjust treble.
Use o p to adjust the tone, then press ENTER.
-6 dB – +6 dB (Default : 0 dB)
Use o p to set the tone control function to on/off.
On:
Allow tone adjustment (bass, treble).
Off
(Default):
Playback without tone adjustment.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
“Tone” settings are stored for each input source.
This cannot be set when the sound mode is set to “Direct” or “Pure Direct”.
This item cannot be set when “Dynamic EQ” is set to “On”. (v p. 176)
You cannot set this when no audio signal is input or in the menu “HDMI Audio Out”
is set to “TV”. (v p. 184)
0 This cannot be set when the input mode is set to “7.1CH IN”.
0
0
0
0
127
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Displaying your desired video during
audio playback (Video Select)
4
5
This unit can display video from a different source on TV during audio
playback. You can set this for each input source.
n Supported input sources:
iPod/USB / CDz / Tuner / Online Music /
Bluetooth / Phono
Tips
If you selected “On” in step 3, press i and select
“Source”.
Use o p to select the input source for video you want
to play back, then press ENTER.
“Video Select” settings are stored for each input source.
z This cannot be set when any of the HDMI, component video or video
connectors are assigned.
1
2
3
Press OPTION during audio playback.
The option menu screen is displayed.
Use ui to select “Video Select”, then press ENTER.
Use o p to select the Video Select mode.
Off
(Default):
Disable Video Select mode.
On:
Enable Video Select mode.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
128
Appendix
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Adjusting the picture quality for your
viewing environment (Picture Mode)
3
n Supported input sources :
CBL/SAT / DVD / Blu-ray / Game / AUX1 /
AUX2 / Media Player / iPod/USB /
Online Music / CDz / TV Audioz
z You can set the picture mode when an HDMI, component video or video
connector is assigned.
1
2
Tips
Use o p to select picture mode.
Off:
No picture quality adjustment is done with this unit.
Standard:
The standard mode suited for most living room
viewing environments.
Movie:
A mode suited for watching movies in a dark room
such as a theater room.
Vivid:
A mode that makes graphic images for games, etc.
brighter and more vivid.
Streaming: A mode suited for low bit rate video sources.
Press OPTION during video playback.
The option menu screen is displayed.
Use ui to select “Picture Mode”, then press ENTER.
4
ISF Day:
A mode suited for watching movies in a bright room
during the day.
ISF Night:
A mode suited for watching movies in a dark room at
night.
Custom:
Adjusts the picture quality manually.
Press ENTER.
“Picture Mode” settings are stored for each input source.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
Appendix
129
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
1
You can play back the music being played back in MAIN ZONE
simultaneously in ZONE2 and ZONE3 (other rooms).
It is useful when you want to enjoy the same music at the same time in
multiple rooms during home party or when you want to play back the same
BGM in the entire house.
2
3
Appendix
o Stopping the All Zone Stereo mode
Playing the same music in all zones (All
Zone Stereo)
1
Tips
During playback in All Zone Stereo mode, press
OPTION.
The option menu screen is displayed.
2
3
Press OPTION.
Use ui to select “All Zone Stereo”, then press ENTER.
Select “Stop”, then press ENTER.
The option menu screen is displayed.
0 The All Zone Stereo mode is canceled even when the power supply of the MAIN
ZONE is turned off.
0 In the All Zone Stereo mode, only the “Multi Ch Stereo” and “Stereo” sound modes
can be selected.
0 When “HDMI Audio Out” is set to “TV”, the All Zone Stereo mode is not available.
(v p. 184)
0 This cannot be set when the input mode is set to “7.1CH IN”.
Use ui to select “All Zone Stereo”, then press ENTER.
Select “Start”, then press ENTER.
0 The input sources for ZONE2 and ZONE3 are switched to the
same input source as for MAIN ZONE, and playback starts in the
All Zone Stereo mode.
0 When you do not want ZONE2 or ZONE3 to participate in All
Zone Stereo, press ENTER to clear the check mark and then
press “Start”.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
130
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Selecting a sound mode
This unit allows you to enjoy various kinds of surround and stereo
playback modes.
Disc formats such as Blu-ray Disc and DVD, as well as being supported by
digital broadcasting, and even by streaming movies and music from
internet-based subscription services.
This unit supports playback of almost all of these multi-channel audio
formats. It also supports surround playback of audio formats other than
multi-channel audio such as 2-channel stereo audio.
For audio formats recorded on a disc, see the disc jacket or label.
ui
PURE
GAME
.
MOVIE
MUSIC
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
131
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
0 Press MOVIE, MUSIC or GAME to display a list of the sound modes
that can be selected. Each time you press MOVIE, MUSIC or GAME,
the sound mode changes.
0 While the list is displayed, you can also use ui to select a sound
mode.
0 Try out various sound modes and enjoy sound mode in your favorite
mode.
GExampleH When MOVIE is pressed
Press MOVIE, MUSIC or GAME to select a sound mode.
MOVIE :
Appendix
o Switching the sound mode
Selecting a sound mode
1
Tips
Switches to the sound mode suitable for enjoying movies
and TV programs.
MUSIC : Switches to the sound mode suitable for enjoying music.
GAME : Switches to the sound mode suitable for enjoying games.
MOVIE SOUND
0 The MOVIE, MUSIC, or GAME button memorizes the last sound mode selected for
its button. Pressing MOVIE, MUSIC, or GAME recalls the same sound mode as
the one selected at the previous playback.
0 If the content played back does not support the previously selected sound mode,
the most appropriate sound mode for the content is automatically selected.
Stereo
Dolby Surround
DTS Neo:X Cinema
Multi Ch Stereo
Wide Screen
.
Mono Movie
This unit provides not only sound modes that conform to the formats
recorded on discs such as Dolby and DTS, but also extended types of
modes that match your speaker configuration and “original sound modes”
that create atmosphere of Rock Arena and Jazz Club, etc.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
132
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Appendix
Pure Direct playback
Direct playback
This mode is for playback with higher sound quality than in Direct playback
mode.
This mode turns off the main unit display and analog video circuit. Doing
so suppresses noise sources that affect sound quality.
Sound recorded in source is played as is.
1
Tips
Press PURE to select “Direct”.
Direct playback begins.
1
While DSD signals are played back, “DSD Direct” is displayed.
Press PURE to select “Pure Direct”.
The display goes dark, and Pure Direct playback begins.
In Direct and Pure Direct sound modes, the following items cannot be adjusted.
0 Dialog Enhancer (v p. 125)
0 Tone (v p. 127)
0 Restorer (v p. 173)
0 MultEQ® XT32 (v p. 175)
0 Dynamic EQ (v p. 176)
0 Dynamic Volume (v p. 177)
0 Graphic EQ (v p. 179)
NOTE
0 Video signals are only output when HDMI signals are played in the Pure Direct
mode.
0 When the Pure Direct mode has been selected, the display turns off after about 5
seconds.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
133
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Auto surround playback
This mode detects the type of input digital signal, and automatically
selects the corresponding mode for playback.
Perform stereo playback when the input signal is PCM. When the input
signal is Dolby Digital or DTS, the music is played back according to the
respective channel number.
1
Press PURE to select “Auto”.
Auto surround playback begins.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
134
Remote
Index
Appendix
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
o Description of sound mode types
Dolby sound mode
Sound mode type
Description
Dolby Surround
This mode uses Dolby Surround Upmixer to extend various sources to natural and realistic multi channels for playback.
Use ceiling speakers such as top middle speakers to realize a three-dimensional sound field.
Dolby Digital
This mode can be selected when playing sources recorded in Dolby Digital.
Dolby TrueHD
This mode can be selected when playing sources recorded in Dolby TrueHD.
Dolby Digital Plus
This mode can be selected when playing sources recorded in Dolby Digital Plus.
Dolby Atmos
This mode can be selected when playing back content encoded with Dolby Atmos.
It decodes Dolby Atmos content and its positioning data in real time and outputs audio from the appropriate speakers,
creating natural audio images regardless of the speaker layout. Use ceiling speakers and Dolby Atmos Enabled speakers
to realize a three-dimensional sound field.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
135
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
DTS sound mode
Sound mode type
DTS Neo:X
Description
This matrix decoding technology uses the DTS Neo:X decoder to playback 2-channel source or 5.1/6.1/7.1-channel
surround sources as a maximum of 11.1-channel surround sound.
The “Music” mode is suitable for playing music, the “Cinema” mode is suitable for playing movies and the “Game” mode is
suitable for playing games.
DTS Surround
This mode can be selected when playing sources recorded in DTS.
DTS ES Dscrt6.1z
This mode is suitable for playing discs recorded in DTS-ES.
The surround back channel added using the discrete method is played as an independent channel.
Since all channels are independent, the 360-degree spacial expressiveness and sound localization are enhanced.
DTS ES Mtrix6.1z
This mode is suitable for playing discs recorded in DTS-ES.
The surround back channel added to the surround-left and surround-right channels by a matrix encoder at software
recording time is decoded by this unit’s matrix decoder and played from each channel (surround left, surround right,
surround back).
DTS 96/24
This mode can be selected when playing sources recorded in DTS 96/24.
DTS-HD
This mode can be selected when playing sources recorded in DTS-HD.
DTS Express
This mode can be selected when playing sources recorded in DTS Express.
z This can be selected when “Speaker Config.” - “Surr. Back” is not set to “None”. (v p. 231)
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
136
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
PCM multi-channel sound mode
Sound mode type
Multi Ch In
Audyssey
Description
This mode can be selected when playing multi-channel PCM/DSD sources.
DSX®
sound mode
Sound mode type
Audyssey
DSX®
(A-DSX)z
Description
This mode creates playback for the new channels (front wide or front height) in 5.1-channel systems. By adding front wide
or front height channels, the surround sound effects sound become more three dimensional and realistic.
z This can be selected when a setting other than “None” is selected for “Front Height” or “Front Wide”, and a setting other than “None” is selected for “Center” in “Speaker
Config.”. (v p. 230)
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
137
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Original sound mode
Sound mode type
Description
Multi Ch Stereo
This mode is for enjoying stereo sound from all speakers.
Stereo audio (2-channel) sources are played back via the front (L/R) speakers, the surround speakers and surround back
speakers (if connected).
Wide Screen
This mode is for enjoying the atmosphere of viewing a movie on a large screen.
Super Stadium
This mode is suited for viewing sports programs.
Rock Arena
This mode simulates the expansive sound of a live concert in an arena.
Jazz Club
This mode simulates the experience of being in an intimate jazz club.
Classic Concert
This mode is for appreciating classical concert programs.
Mono Movie
This mode works with monaural audio sources and delivers a surround sound effect. For optimum channel balance and
surround sound effects, connect the monaural source to both of the front (L/R) audio inputs.
Video Game
This mode provides an exciting, dynamic surround sound effect with your favorite action video games.
Matrix
This mode adds a spacious surround sound effect with stereo music sources.
Virtual
This mode lets you experience an expansive surround sound effect when playing back through just the front (L/R)
speakers only, and when listening with stereo headphones.
Auto sound mode
Sound mode type
Auto
Front panel
Description
In this mode, the type of digital signal input, such as Dolby Digital, Dolby TrueHD, Dolby Digital Plus, Dolby Digital EX,
Dolby Atmos, DTS, DTS-HD, DTS-ES, PCM (multi-channel) is detected, and the playback mode switches automatically to
the corresponding mode.
If the input signal is analog or PCM (2-channel), stereo playback is used. For Dolby Digital or DTS, the music is played
back according to the respective channel number.
Display
Rear panel
138
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Stereo sound mode
Sound mode type
Stereo
Description
This mode plays 2-channel stereo audio with no additional surround sound processing.
0 Sound is output from the front left and right speakers, and subwoofer if connected.
0 When multi-channel signals are inputted, they are mixed down to 2-channel audio and are played back with no
additional surround sound processing.
Direct sound mode
Sound mode type
Description
Direct
This mode plays back audio as recorded in the source.
Pure Direct
This mode plays back an even higher quality sound than the “Direct” mode.
The following circuits are stopped in order to further improve sound quality.
0 Display indicator circuit of the main body (display will go off.)
0 The analog video input/output switcher and processor is disabled.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
139
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
o Sound mode that can be selected for each input signal
0 The following sound modes can be selected using the MOVIE, MUSIC and GAME buttons.
0 Adjust the sound field effect with the menu “Surround Parameter” to enjoy surround sound the way you like it. (v p. 168)
Input signal
Sound mode
Dolby Surround
DTS Neo:X Cinema z2
2-channel z1
Sound mode
MUSIC
S
MOVIE
S
S
GAME
S
DTS Neo:X Music z2
S
DTS Neo:X Game z2
Multi Ch Stereo
Wide Screen
Super Stadium
Mono Movie
Rock Arena
Jazz Club
Classic Concert
Matrix
Video Game
Virtual
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
z1 2-channel also includes analog input.
z2 This mode plays back 2-channel sources in 5.1, 7.1 or 9.1-channel playback. It cannot be selected when headphones are used, or when only front speakers are used.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
140
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Input signal
Multi-channel z3
Dolby Digital
Dolby TrueHD
Playback
Settings
Sound mode
Sound mode
MUSIC
S
S
S
S
MOVIE
S
S
S
S
S
Stereo
Dolby Digital
Dolby Digital + Dolby Surround
Dolby Digital A-DSX z4
Dolby Digital + Neo:X Cinema
Dolby Digital + Neo:X Music
Dolby Digital + Neo:X Game
Dolby TrueHD
Dolby TrueHD + Dolby Surroundz5
Dolby Atmosz6
Dolby TrueHD A-DSX z4
Dolby TrueHD + Neo:X Cinema
Dolby TrueHD + Neo:X Music
Dolby TrueHD + Neo:X Game
Tips
Appendix
GAME
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
z3 Some sound modes cannot be selected depending on the audio format or number of channels of the input signal. For details, see “Types of input signals, and
corresponding sound modes” (v p. 313).
z4 These modes add new channels to 5.1-channel surround using Audyssey DSX® processing. (v p. 178)
z5 This can be selected when the input signal does not contain Dolby Atmos.
z6 This can be selected when the input signal contains Dolby Atmos.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
141
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Input signal
Multi-channel z3
Dolby Digital Plus
Dolby Atmos
DTS
Playback
Settings
Sound mode
Sound mode
MUSIC
S
S
S
S
MOVIE
S
S
S
S
S
Dolby Digital Plus
Dolby Digital Plus + Dolby Surroundz5
Dolby Atmosz6
Dolby Digital Plus A-DSX z4
Dolby Digital Plus + Neo:X Cinema
Dolby Digital Plus + Neo:X Music
Dolby Digital Plus + Neo:X Game
Dolby Atmos
DTS Surround
DTS ES Dscrt 6.1
DTS ES Mtrx 6.1
DTS 96/24
DTS + Dolby Surround
DTS Surround A-DSX z4
DTS + Neo:X Cinema
DTS + Neo:X Music
DTS + Neo:X Game
Tips
Appendix
GAME
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
z3 Some sound modes cannot be selected depending on the audio format or number of channels of the input signal. For details, see “Types of input signals, and
corresponding sound modes” (v p. 313).
z4 These modes add new channels to 5.1-channel surround using Audyssey DSX® processing. (v p. 178)
z5 This can be selected when the input signal does not contain Dolby Atmos.
z6 This can be selected when the input signal contains Dolby Atmos.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
142
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Multi-channel z3
Input signal
DTS-HD /
DTS Express
PCM multi-channel
Playback
Settings
Sound mode
Sound mode
MUSIC
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
MOVIE
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
DTS-HD HI RES
DTS-HD MSTR
DTS-HD MSTR A-DSX z4
DTS Express
DTS Express A-DSX z4
DTS-HD + Dolby Surround
DTS-HD HI RES A-DSX z4
DTS-HD + Neo:X Cinema
DTS-HD + Neo:X Music
DTS-HD + Neo:X Game
Multi Ch In
Multi Ch In 7.1
Multi In + Dolby Surround
Multi In A-DSX z4
Multi In + Neo:X Cinema
Multi In + Neo:X Music
Multi In + Neo:X Game
Tips
S
S
S
S
S
S
Appendix
GAME
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
z3 Some sound modes cannot be selected depending on the audio format or number of channels of the input signal. For details, see “Types of input signals, and
corresponding sound modes” (v p. 313).
z4 These modes add new channels to 5.1-channel surround using Audyssey DSX® processing. (v p. 178)
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
143
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Input signal
Multi-channel z3
Playback
Settings
Sound mode
Sound mode
MUSIC
S
MOVIE
S
S
Multi Ch Stereo
Wide Screen
Super Stadium
Mono Movie
Rock Arena
Jazz Club
Classic Concert
Matrix
Video Game
Virtual
Tips
Appendix
GAME
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
z3 Some sound modes cannot be selected depending on the audio format or number of channels of the input signal. For details, see “Types of input signals, and
corresponding sound modes” (v p. 313).
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
144
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
o Views on the display
.
Blu-ray
Dolby D +
S
q
w
A Shows a decoder to be used.
0 In the case of the Dolby Digital Plus decoder, “Dolby D +” is
displayed.
B Shows a decoder that creates sound output.
0 “k” indicates that the Dolby Surround decoder is being used.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
145
Remote
Index
Appendix
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
HDMI control function
A recent addition to the HDMI standard is CEC (Consumer Electronics Control), which allows control signals from one device to communicate with
another device via the HDMI cable connection.
Setting procedure
1
2
3
5
Enable the HDMI control function of this unit.
Set “HDMI Control” to “On”. (v p. 186)
Turn the power on for all the devices connected by
HDMI cable.
6
Set the HDMI control function for all devices connected
by HDMI cable.
0 Some functions may not operate depending on the connected TV or player. Check
the owner’s manual of each device for details beforehand.
0 The HDMI ZONE2 function is not compatible with the HDMI control function.
0 When the HDMI ZONE2 function is used with “HDMI Control” in the menu set to
“On”, the HDMI ZONE2 function may not fully work.
devices to check the settings.
0 Carry out steps 2 and 3 should any of the devices be unplugged.
Switch the television input to the HDMI input connected
to this unit.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
When you turn the TV’s power to standby, check that
the power of this unit also goes to standby.
NOTE
0 Please consult the operating instructions for the connected
4
Switch the input source of this unit to check that video
from the player connected by HDMI is played back
correctly.
146
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Sleep timer function
You can have the power automatically switched to standby once a set time
has elapsed. This is convenient for viewing and listening while going to
sleep. The sleep timer function can be set for each zone.
ZONE SELECT
.
SLEEP
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
147
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Press SLEEP when the sleep timer is in operation.
The remaining time appears on the display.
Press ZONE SELECT to select the operating zone with
the remote control.
o To cancel the sleep timer
The J, K or L indicator lights.
2
Appendix
o Checking the remaining time
Using the sleep timer
1
Tips
Press SLEEP to select “Off”.
The B indicator on the display turns off.
Press SLEEP and display the time you want to set.
0 The B indicator lights up on the display and the sleep timer
starts.
The sleep timer setting is canceled when the unit switches to standby mode.
0 You can set the sleep timer in the range from 10 to 120 minutes in
NOTE
steps of 10 minutes.
The sleep timer function cannot turn off the power of devices connected to this unit.
To turn off the power of those connected devices, set up sleep timers on the
connected devices themselves.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
148
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Quick select plus function
Settings such as the input source, volume level and sound mode can be
registered to the QUICK SELECT 1 - 4 buttons.
You can simply press one of the registered QUICK SELECT buttons in
subsequent playbacks to switch to the group of saved settings in a batch.
By saving frequently used settings at the QUICK SELECT 1 – 4 buttons,
you will always be able to easily call up the same playback environment.
The Quick Select Plus function can be memorized for each zone.
ZONE SELECT
The QUICK SELECT button on this unit can only be used to operate the MAIN
ZONE.
.
QUICK
SELECT
1–4
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
149
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Calling up the settings
1
2
Press ZONE SELECT to select the operating zone with
the remote control.
The J, K or L indicator lights.
Press QUICK SELECT.
The Quick Select settings registered to the button you pressed are
called up.
0 The default settings for the input source and volume are as shown
below.
GMAIN ZONEH
Button
Input source
Volume
QUICK SELECT 1
CBL/SAT
40
QUICK SELECT 2
Blu-ray
40
QUICK SELECT 3
Media Player
40
QUICK SELECT 4
Online Music
40
GZONE2H / GZONE3H
Button
Input source
Volume
QUICK SELECT 1
CBL/SAT
40
QUICK SELECT 2
Blu-ray
40
QUICK SELECT 3
Media Player
40
QUICK SELECT 4
Online Music
40
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
150
Remote
Index
Appendix
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Changing the settings
1
2
Tips
Press ZONE SELECT to select the operating zone with
the remote control.
The J, K or L indicator lights.
Set the items below to the settings you want to
register.
3
The following settings from A to I can be memorized for MAIN
ZONE, and settings A and B can be memorized for ZONE2 and
ZONE3.
Press and hold the desired QUICK SELECT until
“Quickz Memory”, “Z2 Quickz Memory” or “Z3 Quickz
Memory” appears on the display.
The current settings will be memorized.
z is displayed the number for the QUICK SELECT button you
pressed.
A Input source (v p. 78)
B Volume (v p. 79)
C Sound mode (v p. 131)
D Audyssey (Audyssey MultEQ® XT32, Audyssey Dynamic EQ®,
Audyssey Dynamic Volume®, Audyssey LFC™) (v p. 175 177)
E “Restorer” (v p. 173)
F “Adjusting the volume of each channel to match the input source
(Channel Level Adjust)” (v p. 126)
G “Displaying your desired video during audio playback (Video
Select)” (v p. 128)
H “Adjusting the picture quality for your viewing environment
(Picture Mode)” (v p. 129)
I “Video Output” (v p. 184)
o Changing the Quick Select Name
The MAIN ZONE Quick Select name displayed on the TV screen or
display of this unit can be changed to a different name.
For the name change method, see “Quick Select Names”.
(v p. 252)
Press and hold QUICK SELECT while a radio station is being received or a
track is being played back with any of the following sources, the current radio
station or track is memorized.
0 Tuner / Internet Radio / Media Server / Favorites / iPod/USB
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
Appendix
151
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Web control function
You can control this unit from a web control screen on a web browser.
.
Controlling the unit from a web control
1
PC
This unit
2
Router
Switch the “IP Control” setting to “Always On”.
(v p. 245)
Check the IP address of this unit with “Information”.
(v p. 241)
Network/Information
Friendly name
DHCP
Connection
IP Address
MAC Address
Denon AVR-X7200W
On
Wired (Ethernet)
192.168.100.19
zzzzzz-000000
Checking the IP address.
Displays the current network settings of the AVR
.
Tablet
3
0 This unit and the PC or tablet need to be connected correctly to the network in
order to use the web control function. (“Connecting to a home network
(LAN)” (v p. 72))
0 Depending on the settings of your security-related software, you may not be able
to access this unit from your PC. If this is the case, then change the settings of the
security-related software.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
152
Start up the web browser.
Remote
Index
Contents
Playback
Settings
5
Enter the IP address of this unit in browser’s address
box.
For example, if the IP address of this unit is “192.168.100.19”, enter
“http://192.168.100.19”.
Tips
AVR-X7200W
Setup Menu
MAIN ZONE
CBL/SAT
Audio
http://192.168.100.19
File
Edit View
Appendix
When the top menu is displayed, click on the menu
item you want to operate.
Video
Favorites Tools Help
ZONE2
Online Music
Inputs
ZONE3
CBL/SAT
.
Speakers
Network
General
AVR-X7200W
Save
Load
.
4
Connections
0 You can use the “Save” and “Load” functions to store or recall various function
settings using web control from a PC.
0 To memorize settings, click “Save” on the Setup Menu screen.
0 To call up settings, click “Load” on the Setup Menu screen.
0 We recommend using one of the following web browsers.
Internet Explorer 10 and above
Mozilla Firefox 24 and above
Google Chrome 29 and above
Safari 5.x and above
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
153
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Playback in ZONE2/ZONE3 (Separate room)
You can operate this unit to enjoy video and audio in a room (ZONE2 and ZONE3) that is different from the room where this unit is placed (MAIN ZONE).
You can simultaneously play back the same source in both the MAIN ZONE, ZONE2 and ZONE3. You can also play back separate sources in the MAIN
ZONE, ZONE2 and ZONE3.
Connecting ZONE
You can use the following three methods to play back video and audio in
ZONE2 and ZONE3.
0 Connection through the HDMI ZONE2 connector (v p. 154)
0 Connection through the video output connector and speaker output
connector (v p. 155)
0 Connection through the video output connector and external power
amplifiers (v p. 157)
o Connection 1 : Connection through the HDMI
ZONE2 connector
When a TV is connected to the HDMI ZONE2 OUT connector, you can
play back a video or audio from the device connected to the HDMI 1 –
7 IN connector in ZONE2 (HDMI ZONE2 function).
ZONE2
MAIN ZONE
HDMI
ZONE2
.
HDMI
When a TV is connected to the HDMI ZONE2 OUT connector, and the MAIN ZONE
and ZONE2 are set to the same input source, the MAIN ZONE audio may be mixed
down to 2-channel audio.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
154
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
o Connection 2 : Connection through the video output connector and speaker output connector
When “Assign Mode” in the menu is set to any of the following audio is output from speakers in ZONE2 or ZONE3. (v p. 211)
n Assign Mode: 7.1ch + ZONE2
n Assign Mode: 7.1ch + ZONE3
MAIN ZONE
MAIN ZONE
ZONE2
This unit
ZONE3
This unit
VIDEO
MONITOR/ZONE3
VIDEO
IN
MONITOR/ZONE3 ZONE2
Y
PB/
CB
VIDEO
COMPONENT VIDEO
IN
Y
PB PR
MONITOR/ZONE3
VIDEO
IN
MONITOR/ZONE3 ZONE2
Y
PB/
CB
ZONE2
COMPONENT VIDEO
IN
Y
PB PR
ZONE2
PR/
CR
VIDEO
PR/
CR
VIDEO
COMPONENT VIDEO
COMPONENT VIDEO
or
SURROUND BACK
or
SURROUND BACK
SURROUND BACK
(L)
ASSIGNABLE
w
(R)
w
ASSIGNABLE
q
w
SPEAKERS
.
q
(L)
.
SPEAKERS
SURROUND BACK
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
155
Remote
Index
(R)
q
w
q
Connections
Contents
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
n Assign Mode: 7.1ch + ZONE2/3-MONO
MAIN ZONE
This unit
ZONE2
ZONE3
VIDEO
MONITOR/ZONE3
Y
VIDEO
COMPONENT VIDEO
IN
Y
PB PR
VIDEO
IN
MONITOR/ZONE3 ZONE2
COMPONENT VIDEO
IN
Y
PB PR
VIDEO
IN
PB/
CB
ZONE2
VIDEO
PR/
CR
COMPONENT VIDEO
or
or
SURROUND BACK
SURROUND BACK
FRONT
w
q
w
ASSIGNABLE
.
SPEAKERS
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
156
Remote
Index
q
Connections
Contents
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
o Connection 3 : Connection through the video output connector and external power amplifiers
The audio signals of this unit’s ZONE2 and ZONE3 audio output connectors are played on the ZONE2 and ZONE3 power amplifiers.
MAIN ZONE
This unit
ZONE2
ZONE3
VIDEO
MONITOR/ZONE3
VIDEO
IN
MONITOR/ZONE3 ZONE2
Y
VIDEO
COMPONENT VIDEO
IN
Y
PB PR
VIDEO
IN
COMPONENT VIDEO
IN
Y
PB PR
PB/
CB
ZONE2
VIDEO
PR/
CR
COMPONENT VIDEO
or
or
ZONE2
R
L
ZONE3
PRE OUT
R
Power amplifier
Power amplifier
L
AUX IN
.
AUX IN
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
157
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
0 The analog audio signal and the 2-channel PCM signal input from HDMI connector or digital connectors (OPTICAL/COAXIAL) can be played back in ZONE2.
0 If you want to play back HDMI signals other than 2-channel PCM in ZONE2, set “HDMI Audio” to “PCM”. (v p. 250) 2-channel PCM signals are output from a device
connected to the input source selected for ZONE2 and can be played back in ZONE2.
In this case, the MAIN ZONE audio will also be converted to 2-channel PCM signals if the MAIN ZONE and ZONE2 are set to the same input source. However, depending on
the playback device, the playback signal may not be converted to PCM even if this setting is configured.
0 The analog audio signal and the 2-channel PCM signal input from digital connectors (OPTICAL/COAXIAL) can be played back in ZONE3.
0 When “Analog Video Out” in the menu is set to “ZONE3”, the component video and video output connector outputs the ZONE3 video. (v p. 192)
0 The menu screen is not output in ZONE2.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
158
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Playback in ZONE2/ZONE3
1
2
POWER X
ZONE SELECT
3
Input source
select buttons
Press ZONE SELECT to switch the zone mode.
The K or L indicator lights.
Press POWER X to turn on the ZONE2 or ZONE3 power.
The j indicator on the display lights.
0 Power in ZONE2 or ZONE3 can be turned on or off by pressing
ZONE2 ON/OFF or ZONE3 ON/OFF on the main unit.
Press the input source select button to select the input
source to be played.
.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
Appendix
The audio signal of the selected source is output to ZONE2 or
ZONE3.
0 To perform an operation with the main unit, press ZONE2
SOURCE or ZONE3 SOURCE. Each time you press ZONE2
SOURCE or ZONE3 SOURCE, the input source changes.
VOLUME df
MUTE :
Tips
159
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
o Adjusting the volume
Use VOLUME df to adjust the volume.
0 At time of purchase, “Volume Limit” is set to “70 (–10 dB)”.
(v p. 251)
Turn MASTER VOLUME after pressing ZONE2 SOURCE or ZONE3 SOURCE
on the main unit to adjust the volume.
o Turning off the sound temporarily (Muting)
Press MUTE :.
The sound is reduced to the level set at “Mute Level” in the menu.
(v p. 251)
0 To cancel mute, either adjust the sound volume or press MUTE :
again.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
160
Remote
Index
Appendix
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Menu map
When using menu operations, connect this unit to a TV and operate this unit while viewing the TV.
The recommended settings are configured for this unit by default. You can customize this unit based on your existing system and your preferences.
.
Setting items
Audio
.
Video
Front panel
Detailed items
Description
Page
Subwoofer Level Adjust
This setting adjusts the volume level for the subwoofer.
167
Bass Sync
Adjusts the phase shift when there is a delay in the bass (LFE) recorded on a disc.
167
Surround Parameter
Adjusts surround sound parameters.
168
Restorer
Expands the low and high frequency components of compressed audio content such as
MP3 files to enable richer audio playback.
173
Audio Delay
Compensates for incorrect timing between video and audio.
174
Volume
Sets the MAIN ZONE (room where the unit is located) volume setting.
174
Audyssey
Set Audyssey MultEQ® XT32, Audyssey Dynamic EQ®, Audyssey Dynamic Volume®,
Audyssey LFCTM and Audyssey DSX®.
175
Graphic EQ
Uses the graphic equalizer to adjust the tone of each speaker.
179
Picture Adjust
Adjusts picture quality.
181
HDMI Setup
Makes settings for HDMI video/audio output.
183
Output Settings
Makes settings for video output.
188
Analog Video Out
Assigns the zone that uses the COMPONENT VIDEO MONITOR OUT and the VIDEO
MONITOR OUT connectors.
192
On Screen Display
Configures the on-screen display settings.
193
TV Format
Sets the video signal format to be output for the TV you are using.
194
Display
Rear panel
161
Remote
Index
Contents
.
Setting items
Inputs
Connections
Playback
Settings
Detailed items
Tips
Appendix
Description
Page
Input Assign
Changes input connector assignment.
195
Source Rename
Changes the display name for input source.
197
Hide Sources
Removes from the display input sources that are not used.
197
Source Level
Adjusts the playback level of the audio input.
197
Input Select
Sets the audio input mode and decode mode.
198
Audyssey® Setup
The acoustic characteristics of the connected speakers and listening room are
measured and the optimum settings are made automatically.
200
Manual Setup
Sets up the speakers manually or changes the Audyssey® Setup settings.
211
Information
Displays network information.
241
Connection
Selects whether to connect the home network to a wireless LAN or a wired LAN.
241
Settings
Used for manually setting the IP address or when using a proxy server.
244
IP Control
Enables network communication in standby power mode.
245
Friendly Name
The “Friendly Name” is the name of this unit displayed on the network. You can change
the Friendly Name according to your preferences.
246
Diagnostics
Used to check the network connection.
246
Maintenance Mode
Used when receiving maintenance from a Denon service engineer or custom installer.
This mode is not designed for use by the end user, and should only be used by a trained
service technician or custom installation professional.
247
.
Speakers
.
Network
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
162
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Setting items
Playback
Settings
Detailed items
Tips
Appendix
Description
Page
Changes the language of the display on the TV screen.
248
ECO
Configures the ECO Mode and Auto Standby energy-saving functions.
248
ZONE2 Setup/
ZONE3 Setup
Makes settings for audio playback with ZONE2 and ZONE3.
250
Zone Rename
Changes the display title of each zone to one you prefer.
252
Quick Select Names
Changes the Quick Select Name display title to one you prefer.
252
Remote ID
Specifies with remote control code set this AVR will respond to.
252
Trigger Out 1/
Trigger Out 2
Select the conditions for activating trigger out function.
253
Front Display
Makes settings related to the display on this unit.
253
Information
Shows information about this unit settings, input signals, etc.
254
Usage Data
Selects whether or not to send anonymous usage data to Denon.
255
Firmware
Checks for the latest firmware information about updates and upgrades, updates the
firmware, and sets up the notification message display.
256
Setup Lock
Protects settings from inadvertent changes.
258
Begin Setup...
Performs basic installation/connections/settings from the beginning according to the
guidance indicated on the TV screen.
Language Select
Sets individual setting items according to the guidance displayed on the TV screen.
.
Language
General
Speaker Setup
.
Setup Assistant Speaker Calibration
Network Setup
Input Setup
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
163
Remote
Index
Page 9 of
the separate
manual
“Quick Start
Guide”
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Menu operations
ZONE SELECT
1
Press ZONE SELECT on the remote control unit to set
the operating zone to the MAIN ZONE.
The J indicator lights.
2
3
4
5
uio p
ENTER
Use ui p to select the menu to be set or operated,
then press ENTER.
Use o p to change to desired setting.
Press ENTER to enter the setting.
0 To return to the previous item, press BACK.
0 Exiting the Menu, press SETUP while the menu is displayed. The
SETUP
BACK
Press SETUP.
The menu is displayed on the TV screen.
menu display disappears.
.
0–9
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
164
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Inputting characters
0 On this unit, you can change the name displayed on the following screens to the names that you prefer.
0 Preset Name (v p. 101)
Text Search (v p. 123)
Source Rename (v p. 197)
Friendly Name (v p. 246)
Zone Rename (v p. 252)
Quick Select Names (v p. 252)
Character input for the network functions
0 The following two methods can be used for inputting characters.
0
0
0
0
0
0
0 Using the keyboard screen (v p. 166)
0 Using the number buttons (v p. 166)
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
165
Remote
Index
Appendix
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Using the keyboard screen
1
1
GExampleH “Source Rename” screen
2
Inputs/Source Rename
CBL/SAT
Clear
Insert
Delete
A B C D E
F G H
N O P Q R
S
I
J
K
L M
T U V W X Y
!
$ % &
< = >
a/A
‘
(
)
* +
Space
,
;
Cancel
When the keyboard screen is displayed, press 0 – 9.
The 10 key input screen is displayed.
Place the cursor at the character to be changed with
o p and press the number button (0 – 9) until the
desired character is displayed.
0 The types of characters that can be input are as shown below.
Z
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
“
#
OK
.
Changes the display name for this source
4
5
6
Use uio p to select , or ..
Press ENTER to move the cursor to the character that
you wish to change.
0 Each time ENTER is pressed, the cursor moves by one
character.
1.@-_/:˜
MNOmno6
ABCabc2
PQRSpqrs7
DEFdef3
TUVtuv8
GHIghi4
WXYZwxyz9
JKLjkl5
0 (Space) ! “ # $ % & ‘ ( ) z + ,
;<=>?[\]^`{|}
.
2
3
3
Select a character to be input with uio p then press
ENTER.
Repeat step 2 to change the name then press ENTER to
register it.
Repeat steps 2 - 4 to change the name.
Use uio p to select “OK”, then press ENTER.
Front panel
Display
Appendix
Using the number buttons
Display the screen for inputting characters.
CBL/SAT
Tips
Rear panel
166
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Audio
Make audio-related settings.
Subwoofer Level Adjust
Bass Sync
This setting adjusts the volume level for the subwoofer.
For contents recorded in multi-channel such as Blu-ray discs, the
recorded low frequency effects (LFE) may be out of synch and delayed.
This function corrects such a delay of low frequency effects (LFE).
o Subwoofer Level Adjust
Set whether to adjust the subwoofer level.
On:
Enables the adjustment of the subwoofer
level.
Off
(Default):
Disables the adjustment of the subwoofer
level.
0 ms – 16 ms (Default : 0 ms)
0 How low frequency effects (LFE) are delayed differ according to the disc. Set this
to the desired value.
0 “Bass Sync” settings are stored for each input source.
0 This can be set when the LFE signal is included in the input signal.
0 This cannot be set when the sound mode is “Direct” or “Pure Direct”.
0 This cannot be set when the input mode is “7.1CH IN”.
o Subwoofer 1 Level /Subwoofer 2 Level
These settings adjust the volume level for Subwoofer 1 and Subwoofer
2.
–12.0 dB – +12.0 dB (Default : 0.0 dB)
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
167
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
o Loudness Management
Surround Parameter
This sets whether to output as specified in “Dynamic Compression” or
output directly without compressing the dynamic range of audio
recorded in the disc.
You can adjust the surround audio sound field effects to match your
preferences.
The items (parameters) that can be adjusted depend on the signal being
input and the currently set sound mode. For details on the adjustable
parameters, see “Sound modes and surround parameters” (v p. 310).
0 Some setting items cannot be set while playback is stopped. Make the settings
during playback.
0 “Surround Parameter” settings are stored for each sound mode.
On
(Default):
Outputs are given based on enabling the
settings made in “Dynamic Compression”
and “Dialog normalization function”
(v p. 254).
Off:
“Dynamic Compression” settings and
“Dialogue Normalization” are disabled,
and the signals on the disc are output as
is.
o Cinema EQ
Gently softens the upper treble range of movie soundtracks to reduce
possible harshness and improve clarity.
On:
“Cinema EQ” is used.
Off
(Default):
“Cinema EQ” is not used.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
“Loudness Management” can be set when Dolby Digital, Dolby Digital Plus or
Dolby TrueHD signal is input.
168
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
o Dynamic Compression
Tips
Appendix
o Low Frequency Effects
Compress dynamic range (difference between loud and soft sounds).
Auto:
Automatic dynamic range compression
on/off control according to source.
Low / Medium / High:
These set the compression level.
Off:
Dynamic range compression is always off.
Adjust the low frequency effects level (LFE).
n When “Input Mode” is set other than to “7.1CH IN”
-10 dB – 0 dB (Default : 0 dB)
n When “Input Mode” is set to “7.1CH IN”
0 dB / +5 dB / +10 dB / +15 dB (Default: +15 dB)
0 “Dynamic Compression” can be set when Dolby Digital, Dolby Digital Plus or
Dolby TrueHD signal is input.
0 The default setting is “Off”. When the input signal is the Dolby TrueHD or
Dolby Atmos source, the default setting is “Auto”.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
For proper playback of the different sources, we recommend setting to the
values below.
0 Dolby Digital sources : 0 dB
0 DTS movie sources : 0 dB
0 DTS music sources: -10 dB
169
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
o Center Gain
Tips
Appendix
o Delay Time
Distributes the dialogue output from the center channel to the front left
and right channels and widens the sound image in the front.
Adjust the audio delay time against video to extend the sound field
image.
0.0 – 1.0
0 ms – 300 ms (Default : 30 ms)
0 You can set this when the sound mode is set to DTS Neo:X.
0 The smaller the value, the more dialogue is concentrated on the center
channel. The larger the value, the more dialogue is distributed to front left and
right channels, and the more the sound image widens in the front.
You can set this when the sound mode is “Matrix”.
o Effect Level
Adjust the sound effect level of the current sound mode.
o Center Spread
1 – 15 (Default : 10)
Center spread expands the center channel signal to left and right front
speakers to create a wider frontal audio image for the listener. It is
optimized and designed primary for playback of stereo music content.
On:
Use “Center Spread”.
Off
(Default):
Do no use “Center Spread”.
Set to a lower level if the positioning and sense of phase of the surround signals
seems unnatural.
You can set this when sound mode is Dolby Surround.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
170
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
o Subwoofer
o Room Size
Determine size of acoustic environment.
Turn subwoofer output on and off.
Small:
Simulate acoustics of a small room.
On
(Default):
The subwoofer is used.
Medium small:
Simulate acoustics of a medium-small
room.
Off:
The subwoofer is not used.
Medium
(Default):
Simulate acoustics of a medium room.
Medium large:
Simulate acoustics of a medium-large
room.
Large:
Simulate acoustics of a large room.
You can set this when the sound mode is “Direct” or “Stereo” and in the menu
“Subwoofer Mode” is set to “LFE+Main”. (v p. 237)
“Room Size” does not indicate the size of the room in which sources are played.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
171
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
o Speaker Select
Tips
Appendix
n You can set this when the sound mode is original sound
mode.
Makes settings for the speakers outputting sound.
n You can set this when the sound mode is set to “DTS Neo:X”.
Floor
(Default):
Plays back without height speakers.
Surround Back: Sound is output from the surround back speakers.
Floor & Height:
Plays back with height speakers.
Front:
Plays back only with speakers in front of the
surround speaker.
Height:
Sound is output from the front height speakers.
Wide:
Sound is output from the front wide speakers.
Back/Height:
Sound is output from the surround back and front
height speakers.
Back/Wide:
Sound is output from the surround back and front
wide speakers.
Height/Wide:
Sound is output from the front height and front wide
speakers.
o Set Defaults
The “Surround Parameter” settings are returned to the default settings.
This can be selected when using any of the surround back, front wide or front
height speakers.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
172
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Restorer
0 This item can be set with analog signals or PCM signal (Sample Rate =
44.1/48 kHz) is input.
0 This item default setting for “Online Music”, “iPod/USB” and “Bluetooth” is
“Low”. All others are set to “Off”.
0 This cannot be set when the sound mode is set to “Direct” or “Pure Direct”.
0 This cannot be set when the input mode is set to “7.1CH IN”.
0 “Restorer” settings are stored for each input source.
Compressed audio formats such as MP3, WMA (Windows Media Audio)
and MPEG-4 AAC reduce the amount of data by eliminating signal
components that are hard for the human ear to hear. The “Restorer”
function generates the signals eliminated upon compression, restoring the
sound to conditions near those of the original sound before compression.
It also restores the original bass characteristics for a rich and expanded
tonal range.
o Mode
High:
Optimized mode for compressed sources with very weak
highs (64 kbps and under).
Medium:
Apply suitable bass and treble boost for all compressed
sources (96 kbps and under).
Low:
Optimized mode for compressed sources with normal highs
(96 kbps and over).
Off:
Do no use “Restorer”.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
173
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
o Limit
Audio Delay
Make a setting for maximum volume.
Compensates for incorrect timing between video and audio.
60 (–20 dB) / 70 (–10 dB) / 80 (0 dB)
0 ms – 200 ms (Default : 0 ms)
Off (Default)
o Power On Level
0 Audio Delay for game mode can be set when “Video Mode” is set to “Auto” or
“Game”. (v p. 188)
0 This cannot be set when the input mode is set to “7.1CH IN”.
0 “Audio Delay” settings are stored for each input source.
Define the volume setting that is active when the power is turned on.
Volume
Set the MAIN ZONE (room where the unit is located) volume setting.
o Scale
Last
(Default):
Use the memorized setting from the last
session.
Mute:
Always use the muting on condition when
power is turned on.
1 – 98 (–79 dB – 18 dB) :
The volume is adjusted to the set level.
o Mute Level
Set how volume is displayed.
Set the amount of attenuation when muting is on.
0 - 98
(Default):
Display in the range 0 (Min) to 98.
–79.5 dB – 18.0 dB:
Display ---dB (Min), in the range –79.5 dB
to 18.0 dB.
Full
(Default):
The sound is muted entirely.
–40 dB :
The sound is attenuated by 40 dB down.
–20 dB :
The sound is attenuated by 20 dB down.
“Scale” settings are reflected in all the zones.
Front panel
Appendix
Display
Rear panel
174
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
o MultEQ® XT32
Audyssey
MultEQ® XT32 compensates for both time and frequency
characteristics of the listening area based on Audyssey® Setup
measurement results. Selection is done from three types of
compensation curves. It is recommended that “Reference” is selected.
Set Audyssey MultEQ® XT32, Audyssey Dynamic EQ®, Audyssey
Dynamic Volume® and Audyssey LFC™. These can be selected after
Audyssey® Setup has been performed.
For additional information on Audyssey technology, please see
“Explanation of terms” (v p. 316).
0 “MultEQ® XT32”, “Dynamic EQ”, “Reference Level Offset”, “Dynamic Volume”,
“Audyssey LFC™”, “Containment Amount” and “Audyssey DSX®” settings are
stored for each input source.
0 When the sound mode is in the “Direct” or “Pure Direct” mode, “MultEQ® XT32”,
“Dynamic EQ” and “Dynamic Volume” settings cannot be configured.
0 This cannot be set when the input mode is set to “7.1CH IN”.
Reference
(Default):
Selects the default calibrated setting with
a slight roll off at high frequencies, which
is optimized for movies.
L/R Bypass:
Selects the reference setting, but
bypasses MultEQ® XT32 on the front left
and right speakers.
Flat:
Selects the calibrated setting which is
optimized for small rooms where your
listening position is closer to the
speakers.
Off :
Turn “MultEQ® XT32” equalizer off.
When the headphones are used, “MultEQ® XT32” is automatically set to “Off”.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
175
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
o Dynamic EQ
Tips
Appendix
o Reference Level Offset
Solves the problem of deteriorating sound quality as volume is
decreased by taking into account human perception and room
acoustics.
Works with MultEQ® XT32.
On
(Default):
Use Dynamic EQ.
Off:
Do not use Dynamic EQ.
Audyssey Dynamic EQ® is referenced to the standard film mix level. It
makes adjustments to maintain the reference response and surround
envelopment when the volume is turned down from 0 dB. However,
film reference level is not always used in music or other non-film
content. Dynamic EQ Reference Level Offset provides three offsets
from the film level reference (5 dB, 10 dB, and 15 dB) that can be
selected when the mix level of the content is not within the standard.
Recommended setting levels for content are shown below.
0 dB (Film Reference)
(Default):
When the menu “Dynamic EQ” setting is “On”, it is not possible to do “Tone
Control” adjustment. (v p. 127)
5 dB :
10 dB :
15 dB :
Optimized for content such as
movies.
Select this setting for content that has
a very wide dynamic range, such as
classical music.
Select this setting for jazz or other
music that has a wider dynamic
range. This setting should also be
selected for TV content as that is
usually mixed at 10 dB below film
reference.
Select this setting for pop/rock music
or other program material that is
mixed at very high listening levels
and has a compressed dynamic
range.
Setting is enabled when “Dynamic EQ” is “On”. (v p. 176)
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
176
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
o Dynamic Volume
Tips
Appendix
o Audyssey LFC™
Solves the problem of large variations in volume level between TV,
movies and other content (between quiet passages and loud
passages, etc.) by automatically adjusting to the user’s preferred
volume setting.
Heavy:
Most adjustment to softest and loudest
sounds.
Medium:
Medium adjustment to loudest and
softest sound.
Light:
Least adjustment to loudest and softest
sounds.
Off
(Default):
Do not use Dynamic Volume.
Adjusts the low frequency band to prevent bass and vibration from
being conveyed to neighboring rooms.
On:
Use “Audyssey LFC™”.
Off
(Default):
Do not use “Audyssey LFC™”.
o Containment Amount
Adjusts the amount of low frequency containment. Use higher settings
if you have close neighbors.
1 – 7 (Default : 4)
This can be set when “Audyssey LFC™” in the menu is set to “On”.
If “Dynamic Volume” is set to “Yes” in “Audyssey® Setup”, the setting is
automatically changed to “Medium”. (v p. 200)
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
177
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
o Stage Width
o Audyssey DSX®
Adjust sound stage width when using front wide speakers.
Provides more immersive surround sound by adding the new
channels.
Wide:
Turn on Audyssey DSX® processing for front wide
channel expansion.
Height:
Turn on Audyssey DSX® processing for front height
channel expansion.
Wides/Heights:
Turns on Audyssey DSX® processing for front wide
and front height channel expansion.
Off
(Default):
Do not set “Audyssey DSX®”.
–10 – +10 (Default : 0)
o Stage Height
Adjust sound stage height when using front height speakers.
–10 – +10 (Default : 0)
0 “Audyssey DSX®” can be set when you are using front height speakers or front
wide speakers.
0 “Audyssey DSX®” is only valid when using a center speaker.
0 When 2-channel signals are being played back, “Audyssey DSX®” cannot be
used.
0 “Audyssey DSX®” cannot be configured if the HD Audio source being played
includes Front height and Front wide channels. In this case, the respective
channels are played back using the input signals.
Front panel
Appendix
Display
Rear panel
178
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
o Speaker Selection
Graphic EQ
Select whether to adjust tones for individual speakers or for all
speakers.
Uses the graphic equalizer to adjust the tone of each speaker.
0 Speakers for which “Graphic EQ” can be set differ according to the sound mode.
0 This can be set when the “MultEQ® XT32” is set to “Off”. (v p. 175)
0 This cannot be set when the sound mode is set to “Direct” or “Pure Direct”.
0 This cannot be set when the input mode is set to “7.1CH IN”.
All:
Adjust all speaker tones together.
Left/Right
(Default):
Adjust the left and right speaker tones
together.
Each:
Adjust the tone for each speaker.
o Adjust EQ
o Graphic EQ
Adjust tonal balance for each frequency band. Adjust the speaker
selected in “Speaker Selection”.
Set whether to use the graphic equalizer or not.
On:
Use the graphic equalizer.
Off
(Default):
Do not use the graphic equalizer.
1. Select the speaker.
2. Select the adjustment frequency band.
63 Hz / 125 Hz / 250 Hz / 500 Hz / 1 kHz / 2 kHz / 4 kHz / 8 kHz /
16 kHz
3. Adjust the level.
–20.0 dB – +6.0 dB (Default : 0.0 dB)
Front Dolby, Surround Dolby and Back Dolby speakers can only be set when 63
Hz/125 Hz/250 Hz/500 Hz/1 kHz.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
179
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
o Curve Copy
Copy the Flat correction curve created in the Audyssey® Setup.
“Curve Copy” is displayed after Audyssey® Setup has been performed.
o Set Defaults
The “Graphic EQ” settings are returned to the default settings.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
180
Remote
Index
Appendix
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Video
Make video-related settings.
o Picture Mode
Picture Adjust
Select the desired picture mode according to the video content and
your viewing environment.
Picture quality can be adjusted.
0 Can be set when the “Video Conversion” setting is “On”. (v p. 189)
0 Can be set when “HDMI”, “COMP” or “VIDEO” is assigned for each input source.
(v p. 196)
0 “Contrast”, “Brightness”, “Saturation”, “Noise Reduction” and “Enhancer” can be
set when “Picture Mode” is set to “Custom”.
0 “Picture Adjust” settings are stored for each input source.
0 “Picture Adjust” cannot be set when 4K signals are input.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
Standard:
The standard mode suited for most living room viewing
environments.
Movie:
A mode suited for watching movies in a dark room such
as a theater room.
Vivid:
A mode that makes graphic images for games, etc.
brighter and more vivid.
Streaming: A mode suited for low bit rate video sources.
181
ISF Day:
A mode suited for watching movies in a bright room
during the day.
ISF Night:
A mode suited for watching movies in a dark room at
night.
Custom:
Adjusts the picture quality manually.
Off:
No picture quality adjustment is done with this unit.
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
o Contrast
Adjust picture contrast.
0 The two special adjustment modes, ISF Day and ISF Night, should be used by
a certified technician to adjust the color calibration to match the installation
conditions.
We recommend that the settings and adjustments be carried out by an ISFcertified technician.
0 These settings can also be configured using “Picture Mode” in the option
menu. (v p. 129)
0 The default settings are as follows.
0 For “Online Music” and “iPod/USB” input sources: Streaming
0 For input sources other than “Online Music” and “iPod/USB”: Off
-50 – +50 (Default : 0)
o Brightness
Adjust picture brightness.
-50 – +50 (Default : 0)
o Saturation
Adjust picture chroma level (color saturation).
-50 – +50 (Default : 0)
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
182
Remote
Index
Appendix
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
o Noise Reduction
Tips
Appendix
HDMI Setup
Reduce overall video noise.
Make settings for HDMI video/audio output.
Low / Medium / High / Off (Default : Off)
NOTE
o Enhancer
When “HDMI Pass Through” and “HDMI Control” is set to “On”, it consumes more
standby power. If you are not using this unit for an extended period, it is
recommended that you unplug the power cord from the power outlet.
Emphasize picture sharpness.
0 – +12 (Default : 0)
o Auto Lip Sync
Make automatic compensation for timing shift in audio and video
output.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
183
On
(Default):
Correct automatically.
Off:
Do not correct automatically.
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
o HDMI Audio Out
Tips
Appendix
o Video Output
Select HDMI audio output device.
Select the HDMI monitor connector to be used.
AVR
(Default):
Play back through speakers connected to
the unit.
TV:
Play back through TV connected to the
unit.
0 When the HDMI control function is activated, priority is given to the TV audio
setting. (“HDMI control function” (v p. 146))
0 When the power of this unit is on and “HDMI Audio Out” is set to “TV”, audio is
output as 2-channel from the HDMI OUT connector.
Auto(Dual)
(Default):
The presence of a TV connected to the
HDMI MONITOR 1 or HDMI MONITOR 2
connector is detected automatically, and
that TV connection is used.
Monitor 1:
A TV connected to the HDMI MONITOR
1 connector is always used.
Monitor 2:
A TV connected to the HDMI MONITOR
2 connector is always used.
0 If both the HDMI MONITOR1 and HDMI MONITOR2 connectors are
connected and “Resolution” is set to “Auto”, the signals are output with a
resolution that is compatible with both TVs. When “Resolution” is not set to
“Auto”, video may not be output. In this case, set a resolution that is
compatible with both TVs. (v p. 190)
0 You can check which resolutions are compatible with your TV in “HDMI
Monitor 1” and “HDMI Monitor 2”. (v p. 254)
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
184
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
o Vertical Stretch
Appendix
o HDMI Pass Through
Sets whether video signals are vertically stretched or not.
On:
Stretches video signals vertically.
Off
(Default) :
Does not stretch video signals vertically.
Selects how this unit will transmit HDMI signals to the HDMI output in
standby power mode.
NOTE
On:
Transmits the selected HDMI input
through the AV receiver’s HDMI output
when this unit is in standby power mode.
Off
(Default):
No HDMI signals are transmitted through
this unit’s HDMI output in standby power
mode.
“Vertical Stretch” can be set when “i/p Scaler” is set to anything other than “Off”.
(v p. 189)
Front panel
Tips
Display
Rear panel
185
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
o HDMI Control
Appendix
o Pass Through Source
You can link operations with devices connected to HDMI and
compatible with HDMI Control.
On:
Use HDMI control function.
Off
(Default):
Do not use HDMI control function.
Sets the HDMI connector that inputs HDMI signals when in standby.
NOTE
Rear panel
The most recently used input source will
go into standby mode.
CBL/SAT / DVD /
Blu-ray / Game /
AUX1 / AUX2 /
Media Player / CDz:
Pass through the selected input source.
“Pass Through Source” can be set when “HDMI Control” is set to “On” or “HDMI
Pass Through” is set to “On”.
If the “HDMI Control” settings have been changed, always reset the power to
connected devices after the change.
Display
Last
(Default):
z“Pass Through Source” can be set when any of the HDMI
connectors is assigned to “CD” for the input source in the “Input
Assign” setting. (v p. 195)
0 Please consult the operating instructions for each connected device to check
the settings.
0 Refer to “HDMI control function” for more information about the HDMI control
function. (v p. 146)
Front panel
Tips
186
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
o TV Audio Switching
Tips
Appendix
o Power Off Control
Sets automatic switching to the “TV Audio” input when a TV connected
via HDMI sends an appropriate CEC control command to the AVR.
On
(Default):
Select the “TV Audio” input automatically
when receiving a command from the TV.
Off:
Do not select the “TV Audio” input
automatically when receiving a command
from the TV.
Links the power standby of this unit to external devices.
“TV Audio Switching” can be set when “HDMI Control” is set to “On”.
All
(Default):
If power to a connected TV is turned off
independently of the input source, power
to this unit is automatically set to standby.
Video:
With an input source being selected that
is assigned either “HDMI”, “COMP” or
“VIDEO”, when you turn the power of the
TV off, power to this unit is automatically
set to standby. (v p. 196)
Off:
This unit does not link with power to a TV.
“Power Off Control” can be set when “HDMI Control” is set to “On”.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
187
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
o Video Mode
Output Settings
Configure the video processing method to match the type of video
content.
Makes settings for video output.
0 Can be set when “HDMI”, “COMP” or “VIDEO” (v p. 196) is assigned for each
input source.
0 “Resolution”, “Progressive Mode” and “Aspect Ratio” can be set when “i/p Scaler”
is set to anything other than “Off”.
0 “Output Settings” cannot be set when 4K signals are input.
0 “Video Conversion”, “i/p Scaler”, “Resolution”, “Progressive Mode” and “Aspect
Ratio” settings are stored for each input source.
Auto
(Default):
Process video automatically based on
the HDMI content information.
Game:
Always process video for game content.
Minimize the video delay when the video
is delayed compared to the button
operations on the controller of the game
console.
Movie:
Perform image processing that is suitable
for contents other than games.
If “Video Mode” is set to “Auto”, the mode is switched according to the input
contents.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
188
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
o Video Conversion
Appendix
o i/p Scaler
The input video signal is converted automatically in conjunction with
the connected TV. (“Video conversion function” (v p. 302))
On
(Default):
The input video signal is converted.
Off:
The input video signal is not converted.
Front panel
Tips
Display
Rear panel
Set the video input signal to be subjected to i/p scaler processing.
i/p Scaler will convert the resolution of the input video signal to the
value set in “Resolution”. (v p. 190)
n When the input source is set other than to “iPod/
USB” and “Online Music”
189
Analog
(Default):
Use i/p (interlace-to-progressive) scaler
function for analog video signals.
Analog & HDMI:
Use i/p scaler function for analog and
HDMI video signal.
HDMI:
Use i/p scaler function for HDMI video
signals.
Off:
Do not use i/p scaler function.
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Use i/p scaler function.
Off:
Do not use i/p scaler function.
Set the output resolution. You can set “Resolution” separately for
HDMI output of the analog video input and HDMI input.
0 “Analog & HDMI” can be set for input sources for which an HDMI input
connector is assigned.
0 Which items can be set depend on the input source assigned to each input
connector.
0 This function is not effective when the input signal is “x.v.Color”, 3D, sYCC601
color, Adobe RGB color, Adobe YCC601 color or computer resolutions.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
Appendix
o Resolution
n When the input source is set to “iPod/USB” and
“Online Music”
On
(Default):
Tips
Auto
(Default):
The resolution supported by the TV
connected to the HDMI MONITOR OUT
connector is detected automatically and
the appropriate output resolution is set.
480p/576p / 1080i /
720p / 1080p /
1080p:24Hz /
4K / 4K(60/50) :
Set the output resolution.
0 When “i/p Scaler” is set to “Analog & HDMI”, the resolution of both the analog
video input signal and HDMI input signal can be set. (v p. 189)
0 When set to “1080p:24Hz”, you can enjoy film-like pictures for film sources (in
24 Hz). For video sources and mixed sources, we recommend setting the
resolution to “1080p”.
0 It is not possible to convert a 50 Hz signal into 1080p/24Hz. It is output at a
resolution of 1080p/50Hz.
190
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
o Progressive Mode
Tips
Appendix
o Aspect Ratio
Set an appropriate progressive conversion mode for the source video
signal.
Auto
(Default):
The video signal is automatically
detected and the appropriate mode is
set.
Video:
Select mode suitable for video playback.
Video and Film:
Select mode suitable for video and 30frame film material playback.
Set the aspect ratio for the video signals output to the HDMI.
16:9
(Default):
Output at 16:9 aspect ratio.
4:3 :
Output at 4:3 aspect ratio with black bars
on the sides of a 16:9 TV screen. (except
for 480p/576p output)
This item can be set when “i/p Scaler” is set to anything other than “Off”.
(v p. 189)
This item can be set when “i/p Scaler” is set to anything other than “Off”.
(v p. 189)
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
191
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Analog Video Out
Assigns the zone that uses the COMPONENT VIDEO MONITOR OUT
and the VIDEO MONITOR OUT connectors.
o ZONE
Assigns the COMPONENT VIDEO
MAIN ZONE (Default) : MONITOR OUT and the VIDEO MONITOR
OUT connector to MAIN ZONE.
ZONE3 :
Front panel
Assigns the COMPONENT VIDEO
MONITOR OUT and the VIDEO MONITOR
OUT connector to ZONE3.
Display
Rear panel
192
Remote
Index
Appendix
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
o Now Playing
On Screen Display
Select the on-screen display user interface preferences.
Sets the display time for the playback display when the input source is
“Online Music”, “iPod/USB”, “Bluetooth” or “Tuner”.
o Volume
Always On
(Default):
Show display continuously.
Auto Off:
Show display for 30 seconds after
operation.
Sets where to display the volume level.
Bottom
(Default):
Top:
Off:
Display at the bottom.
Display at the top.
Turn display off.
When the master volume display is hard to see when superimposed text (closed
captioning) or movie subtitles are present, set to “Top”.
o Info
Displays status of operation temporarily when the sound mode is
changed, or input source is switched.
On
(Default):
Off:
Front panel
Shows the volume display.
Does not show the volume display.
Display
Rear panel
193
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
TV Format
Set the video signal format to be output for the TV you are using.
o Format
PAL
(Default):
Select PAL output.
NTSC:
Select NTSC output.
“Format” can also be set by the following procedure. However, the menu screen
is not displayed. Following the display content to make the setting.
1. Press and hold the main unit’s o and p at the same time for at least 3
seconds.
“zVideo Format <PAL>” appears on the display.
2. Use the main unit’s o or p and set the video signal format.
3. Press the main unit’s ENTER to complete the setting.
NOTE
When a format other than the video format of the connected TV is set, the picture
will not be displayed properly.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
194
Remote
Index
Appendix
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Inputs
Perform settings related to input source playback.
You do not have to change the settings to use the unit. Make settings when needed.
Input Assign
By default, each item is set as follows.
By making connections as indicated by the input sources printed on the
audio/video input connectors of this unit, you can just press one of the
input source select buttons to easily play back audio or video from a
connected device.
Please change the assignment of the HDMI input connector, digital audio
input connector, analog audio input connector, component video input
connector and video input connector when connecting an input source
that differs from that printed to the audio/video input connectors of this
unit.
Input source
Inputs/Input Assign
Set Defaults
CBL/SAT
DVD
Blu-ray
Game
Media Player
TV Audio
AUX1
AUX2
CD
HDMI
DIGITAL
ANALOG
COMP
VIDEO
1
2
3
4
5
Front
6
-
COAX1
COAX2
OPT1
OPT2
1
2
3
4
6
Front
5
1
2
3
-
1
2
3
4
Front
-
Rear panel
ANALOG
COMP
CBL/SAT
1
COAX1
1
1
VIDEO
1
DVD
2
COAX2
2
2
2
Blu-ray
3
–
3
3
3
Game
4
–
4
–
4
Media Player
5
–
6
–
–
TV Audio
–
OPT1
–
–
–
AUX1
Front
–
Front
–
Front
AUX2
6
–
–
–
–
CD
–
OPT2
5
–
–
When using the digital audio output on a TV/satellite box:
To play the video signal assigned to “HDMI” combined with the audio
signal assigned at “Input Assign” - “DIGITAL”, you will also need to
select “Digital” in the “Input Mode”. (v p. 198)
.
Display
DIGITAL
n TV set top box/satellite users please note
Changes HDMI input assignments
Front panel
Input connector
HDMI
195
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
o HDMI
Tips
Appendix
o ANALOG
Set this to change the HDMI input connectors assigned to the input
sources.
Set this to change the analog audio input connectors assigned to the
input sources.
1 / 2 / 3 / 4 / 5 / 6 / Assign an HDMI input connector to the selected
7 / Front:
input source.
1 / 2 / 3 / 4 / 5 / 6 / Front:
–:
Do not assign an HDMI input connector to the
selected input source.
–:
Assign a analog audio input connector to
the selected input source.
Do not assign a analog audio input
connector to the selected input source.
o COMP (Component video)
Set this to change the component video input connectors assigned to
the input sources.
When “HDMI Control” is set to “On” in the menu, “HDMI” cannot be assigned to
“TV Audio”. (v p. 186)
1 / 2 / 3:
o DIGITAL
Set this to change the digital audio input connectors assigned to the
input sources.
COAX1 (Coaxial) /
COAX2 /
OPT1 (Optical) /
OPT2:
Assign a digital audio input connector to the
selected input source.
–:
Do not assign a digital audio input connector
to the selected input source.
–:
Assign the component video input connector to the
selected input source.
Do not assign a component video input connector to the
selected input source.
o VIDEO
Set this to change the composite video input connectors assigned to
the input sources.
1/2/3/4/
Front:
–:
Assign the video input connector to the selected
input source.
Do not assign a video input connector to the
selected input source.
o Set Defaults
The “Input Assign” settings are returned to the default settings.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
196
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Source Rename
Appendix
Source Level
Change the display name for input source.
This is convenient when the name of your device and the input source
name of this unit are different. You can change the name to suit your
needs. When the renaming is completed, the name is displayed on this
unit’s display and on the menu screen.
This function corrects the playback level of the selected input source’s
audio input.
Make this setting if there are differences in the input volume levels
between the different sources.
o Source Level
CBL/SAT / DVD / Blu-ray / Game /
Change the display name for input
AUX1 / AUX2 / Media Player / CD /
source.
TV Audio / Phono:
n When the input source is set to “iPod/USB”,
“Online Music”, “Bluetooth” or “Tuner”
The Source Rename settings are
returned to the default settings.
Set Defaults:
Tips
-12 dB – +12 dB (Default : 0 dB)
o Analog Inputs / Digital Inputs
Up to 12 characters can be input. For character input, see “Using the keyboard
screen” (v p. 166).
n When the input source is set other than to “iPod/
USB”, “Online Music”, “Bluetooth” or “Tuner”
Hide Sources
-12dB – +12dB (Default : 0dB)
Remove from the display input sources that are not used.
Show
(Default):
Use this source.
Hide:
Do not use this source.
Front panel
Display
0 The analog input level can be adjusted independently for input sources for which
“ANALOG” is assigned at “Input Assign”. (v p. 195)
0 The digital input level can be adjusted independently for input sources for which
“DIGITAL” is assigned at “Input Assign”. (v p. 195)
0 “Source Level” settings are stored for each input source.
Rear panel
197
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Input Select
Set the audio input mode and decode mode of each input source.
The input modes available for selection may vary depending on the input
source.
0 When digital signals are properly input, the ~ indicator lights on the display.
If the ~ indicator does not light, check “Input Assign” and the connections.
(v p. 195)
0 If “HDMI Control” is set to “On” and a TV compatible with the ARC is
connected via the HDMI MONITOR 1 connectors, the input mode whose input
source is “TV Audio” is fixed to ARC.
0 The sound mode cannot be set if the input mode is set to “7.1CH IN”.
“Input Select” settings are stored for each input source.
o Input Mode
Set the audio input modes for the different input sources.
It is normally recommended to set the audio input mode to “Auto”.
Auto
(Default):
Automatically detect input signal and
perform playback.
HDMI:
Play only signals from HDMI input.
Digital:
Play only signals from digital audio input.
Analog:
Play only signals from analog audio input.
7.1CH IN:
Only signals input from the 7.1CH IN
connector will be played back.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
198
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
o Decode Mode
Set the audio decode mode for input source.
It is normally recommended to set the audio input mode to “Auto”. But
we recommend changing it to “PCM” or “DTS” if the start of the source
is clipped or noise occurs.
Auto
(Default):
Detect type of digital audio input signal
and decode and play automatically.
PCM:
Decode and play only PCM input signals.
DTS:
Decode and play only DTS input signals.
This item can be set for input sources for which “HDMI” or “DIGITAL” is assigned
at “Input Assign” (v p. 195).
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
199
Remote
Index
Appendix
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Speakers
The acoustic characteristics of the connected speakers and listening room are measured and the optimum settings are made automatically. This is called
“Audyssey® Setup”.
You do not have to perform Audyssey® Setup when you have already performed “Speaker Calibration” in “Setup Assistant”.
To set up the speakers manually, use “Manual Setup” on the menu. (v p. 230)
Audyssey® Setup
To perform measurement, place the Sound calibration microphone in
multiple locations all around the listening area. For best results, we
recommend you measure in six or more positions, as shown in the
illustration (up to eight positions).
When measuring the second and subsequent positions, install the Sound
calibration microphone within 60 cm of the first measurement position
(main listening position).
FL SW C
(
If you perform the Audyssey® setup, the Audyssey MultEQ® XT32, Audyssey
Dynamic EQ®, Audyssey Dynamic Volume® and Audyssey LFC™ functions are
enabled. (v p. 175 - 177)
FL Front speaker (L)
FR Front speaker (R)
C Center speaker
SW Subwoofer
SL Surround speaker (L)
SR Surround speaker (R)
:Measuring positions)
Listening position
SR
.
SL
FR
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
200
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
o About the main listening position
0 Make the room as quiet as possible. Background noise can disrupt the room
measurements. Close windows and turn off the power on electronic devices
(radios, air conditioners, fluorescent lights, etc.). The measurements could be
affected by the sounds emitted by such devices.
0 During the measurement process, place cell phones outside the listening room.
Cell phone signals could disrupt the measurements.
0 Do not stand between the speakers and Sound calibration microphone or allow
obstacles in the path while the measurements are being made. Also, install the
Sound calibration microphone at least 50 cm away from the wall. Failure to do so
will result in inaccurate readings.
0 During the measurement process, audible test tones will come from the speakers
and subwoofer(s), but this is part of normal operation. If there is background noise
in the room, these test signals will increase in volume.
0 Operating VOLUME d f on the remote control unit or MASTER VOLUME on the
main unit during the measurements will cancel the measurements.
0 Measurement cannot be performed when headphones are connected. Unplug the
headphones before performing Audyssey® Setup.
o About Audyssey Sub EQ HT™
Audyssey Sub EQ HT™ makes the integration of dual subwoofers
seamless by first compensating for any level and delay differences
between the two subwoofers and then applying Audyssey MultEQ®
XT32 to both subwoofers together.
To run Audyssey Sub EQ HT™ you must select “Measure (2 spkrs)” in
“Channel Select”. (v p. 203).
Display
Appendix
NOTE
The main listening position is the position where listeners would
normally sit or where one would normally sit alone within the listening
environment. Before starting Audyssey® Setup, place the Sound
calibration microphone in the main listening position.
Audyssey MultEQ® XT32 uses the measurements from this position to
calculate speaker distance, level, polarity, and the optimum crossover
value for the subwoofer.
Front panel
Tips
Rear panel
201
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Procedure for speaker settings
(Audyssey® Setup)
1
Tips
Appendix
Attach the Sound calibration microphone to the
supplied microphone stand or own tripod and install it
at the main listening position.
When installing the Sound calibration microphone, point the tip of
the microphone toward the ceiling and adjust the height to match the
height of the ears of a listener in a seated position.
Preparation
2
Measurement
If using a subwoofer capable of the following
adjustments, set up the subwoofer as shown below.
n When using a subwoofer with a direct mode
Set the direct mode to “On” and disable the volume adjustment
and crossover frequency setting.
Calculation & Store
n When using a subwoofer without a direct mode
Make the following settings:
0 Volume : 12 o’clock position
0 Crossover frequency : Maximum/Highest Frequency
0 Low pass filter : Off
0 Standby mode : Off
Check
.
Finish
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
202
Remote
Index
Contents
Playback
Settings
4
Connect the Sound calibration microphone to the
SETUP MIC jack of this unit.
When the Sound calibration microphone is
connected, the following screen is displayed.
.
5
Audyssey Setup
Your AV receiver can automatically measure the acoustics of
your room then optimize your speakers using the included
microphone and microphone stand.
Set the following items
if necessary.
Tips
Select “Start”, then press ENTER.
Follow the instructions on the screen display and press
“Next” to proceed further.
Amp Assign
Channel Select
Check Results
Restore...
Start
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
203
Appendix
Audyssey® Setup can also make the following settings.
0 Amp Assign
The signals output from the SURROUND BACK, FRONT WIDE/
HEIGHT2 and HEIGHT1 speaker terminals can be switched in
accordance with your speaker environment. (Amp
Assign (v p. 211))
0 Channel Select
If channels that are not to be used are set in advance,
measurement for the set channels is skipped, and measuring
time can be reduced. You can also change the number of
surround back speakers and subwoofer.
.
3
Connections
Remote
Index
Contents
Playback
Settings
7
When the following screen is displayed, select “Begin
Test” and then press ENTER.
Start the measurement of the first position.
Tips
Appendix
When the detected speaker is displayed, select “Next”
and then press ENTER.
Audyssey Setup
Speaker Detection
Audyssey Setup
Select “Begin Test” to start the calibration.
NOTE: You will hear a series of loud chirps starting and stopping
during the tests.
Front
Center
Subwoofer
Surround
Surr. Back
Front Wide
Front Height
Ear Height
:Yes
:Yes
:1spkr
:Yes
:None
:None
:None
Next
.
Repeat Last Test
Back
Begin Test
.
6
Connections
0 Measurement requires several minutes.
NOTE
If “Caution!” is displayed on TV screen:
0 Go to “Error messages” (v p. 208). Check any related items, and
perform the necessary procedures.
0 If the volume level for the subwoofer is not appropriate, an error message is
displayed. See “Subwoofer level error message and how to adjust”
(v p. 209).
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
204
Remote
Index
Contents
Playback
Settings
9
10
Move the Sound calibration microphone to position 2,
select “Continue”, then press ENTER.
The measurement of the second position starts.
Measurements can be made in up to eight positions.
Tips
Appendix
Repeat step 8, measuring positions 3 to 8.
Select “Continue”, then press ENTER.
Audyssey Setup
Measurements complete.
Select Continue to analyze the data...
Audyssey Setup
Place the microphone ear level at the 2nd listening position,
which should be no more than 60cm away from the 1st
position, then select “Continue”...
Ear Height
Repeat Last Test
Continue
.
Back
Complete
Continue
Start the analysis and storage of the measurement results.
0 Analysis takes several minutes to complete.
The more speakers and measurement positions that there are,
the more time it takes to perform the analysis.
.
8
Connections
To skip measuring the second and subsequent listening position, press o to
select “Complete” and press ENTER to proceed to step 11.
NOTE
n Stopping Audyssey® Setup
When the measurement results are being saved, make sure the power is not
turned off.
A Press BACK to display the popup screen.
B Press o to select “Yes”, then press ENTER.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
205
Remote
Index
Contents
11
Connections
Playback
Settings
12
Perform the settings for Audyssey Dynamic EQ® and
Audyssey Dynamic Volume®.
The following screen is displayed during the analysis. Configure the
settings as preferred.
Tips
Appendix
When the analysis and storage ends, unplug the Sound
calibration microphone from the SETUP MIC jack on the
main unit and then press “Next”.
Audyssey Setup
Now Analyzing and correcting the your room data.
Please disconnect the microphone from your AV receiver.
Audyssey Setup
Audyssey Dynamic EQ maintains bass, clarity and surround
sound at low volumes letting you enjoy late-night movies
and television.
Turn on the Dynamic EQ?
Yes
No
Applying room corrections
100%
Analyzing room data
Back
Next
.
.
50%
0 Dynamic EQ corrects the frequency response in consideration of
the audio characteristics of the room and human hearing ability so
that sound can be heard even at low volume.
This is recommended when using the unit with the volume turned
down, e.g. when enjoying a movie or TV program in the middle of
the night.
0 Dynamic Volume adjusts the output volume to the optimal level
while constantly monitoring the level of the audio input to the unit.
Optimal volume control is performed automatically without any
loss in the dynamism and clarity of the sound when, for example,
the volume suddenly increases for commercials shown during
television programs.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
206
Remote
Index
Contents
13
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Select “Details” and press ENTER to verify the
measurement results.
0 Subwoofers may measure a greater reported distance than the
actual distance due to added electrical delay common in
subwoofers.
NOTE
Do not change the speaker connection or subwoofer volume after Audyssey® Setup.
If these are changed, run Audyssey® Setup again in order to configure the optimum
equalizer settings.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
207
Remote
Index
Appendix
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Error messages
An error message is displayed if Audyssey® Setup could not be completed due to speaker placement, the measurement environment, etc. If an error
message is displayed, check the relevant items and perform the necessary measures. Be sure to turn off the power before checking speaker connections.
Examples
Error details
No speakers found.
Measures
0 Sound calibration microphone is not
0 Connect the included Sound calibration microphone to the
0 Not all speakers could be detected.
0 Check the speaker connections.
detected.
Ambient noise is too high or level is too 0 There is too much noise in the room.
low
0 Speaker or subwoofer sound is too low.
SETUP MIC jack of this unit.
0 Either turn off any device generating noise or move it away.
0 Perform again when the surroundings are quieter.
0 Check the speaker installation and the direction in which the
speakers are facing.
0 Adjust the subwoofer’s volume.
Front R : None
0 The displayed speaker could not be
Front R : Phase
0 The displayed speaker is connected with the
detected.
polarity reversed.
0 Check the connections of the displayed speaker.
0 Check the polarity of the displayed speaker.
0 For some speakers, this error message may be displayed
even if the speaker is properly connected. If you are sure the
connection is correct, press p to select “Ignore”, then press
ENTER.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
208
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
o Subwoofer level error message and how to
adjust
1
2
The optimal level of each subwoofer channel for Audyssey® Setup
measurement is 75 dB.
During subwoofer level measurement, an error message is displayed
when one level of subwoofers is outside the 72 – 78 dB range.
When using a subwoofer with built-in amplifier (active type), adjust the
subwoofer volume so that the subwoofer level is within the 72 to 78 dB
range.
3
Tips
Select “SW Level Matching” and then press ENTER.
Adjust the volume control on your subwoofer so that
the measured level is within the 72 to 78 dB range.
When the measured level is within the 72 to 78 dB
range, select “Next” and then press ENTER.
0 If you use two subwoofers, the second subwoofer’s adjustment
will be started. Repeat the operation from step 2, 3.
G Error message H
Audyssey Setup
Your Subwoofer 1’s level is too high.
If your subwoofer has a volume control on it,
select “SW Level Matching” to interactively adjust the level of
your subwoofer.
If your subwoofer does not have a volume control,
or if you do not want to use a subwoofer, select “Skip”.
Skip
SW Level Matching
.
Back
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
Appendix
209
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Retrieving Audyssey® Setup settings
If you set “Restore...” to “Restore”, you can return to Audyssey® Setup
measurement result (value calculated at the start by MultEQ® XT32) even
when you have changed each setting manually.
Audyssey Setup
Your AV receiver can automatically measure the acoustics of
your room then optimize your speakers using the included
microphone and microphone stand.
Set the following items
if necessary.
Amp Assign
Channel Select
Check Results
Restore...
.
Start
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
210
Remote
Index
Appendix
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Manual Setup
Tips
Appendix
Amp Assign
Select the power amplifier usage method to match your speaker system.
Perform when setting the speakers manually or when changing settings
made in Audyssey® Setup.
0 If you change the speaker settings after performing Audyssey® Setup,
you will no longer be able to select Audyssey MultEQ® XT32, Audyssey
Dynamic EQ® or Audyssey Dynamic Volume®. (v p. 175 - 176)
0 This unit can be used without changing “Manual Setup” settings. Please
set if necessary.
o Assign Mode
Select how to use the power amp.
You need to configure the detailed settings for the speaker
configuration in accordance with the selected mode. Select Assign
Mode configure the corresponding detailed settings.
0 Setting to use the 9-channel power amplifier in this unit
and an external power amplifier connected to PRE OUT
to play back up to 11.1 channels.
0 You can connect speakers for up to 13.1 channels for
11.1ch:
MAIN ZONE.
Speakers to output audio are automatically switched for
playing back up to 11.1-channels in accordance with the
input signal and sound mode. (v p. 214)
0 Settings to assign all power amplifier within this unit to
MAIN ZONE to play back up to 9.1 channels.
9.1ch
(Default):
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
211
0 You can connect speakers for up to 11.1 channels for
MAIN ZONE.
Speakers to output audio are automatically switched for
playing back up to 9.1-channels in accordance with the
input signal and sound mode. (v p. 218)
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
0 Setting to assign the power amplifiers in this unit for
7.1ch +
ZONE2:
5.1ch +
ZONE2/3:
Front panel
7.1ch +
ZONE2/3MONO:
MAIN ZONE.
Speakers to output audio are automatically switched
for playing back up to 7.1-channels in accordance with
the input signal and sound mode. (v p. 221)
front speaker bi-amp connection to 2-channels.
7.1ch (BiAmp):
0 Setting to assign the power amplifiers within this unit
5.1ch (BiAmp) +
ZONE2:
for ZONE2 and ZONE3 each to two different
channel.
Rear panel
ZONE2 and ZONE3 each to a different channel.
0 You can connect speakers for up to 9.1 channels for
0 Setting to assign the power amplifiers in this unit for
ZONE3 to 2-channels
0 You can connect speakers for up to 9.1 channels for
MAIN ZONE.
Speakers to output audio are automatically switched
for playing back up to 7.1-channels in accordance with
the input signal and sound mode. (v p. 220)
Display
Appendix
0 Setting to assign the power amplifiers in this unit for
ZONE2 to 2-channels.
0 You can connect speakers for up to 9.1 channels for
MAIN ZONE.
Speakers to output audio are automatically switched
for playing back up to 7.1-channels in accordance with
the input signal and sound mode. (v p. 219)
0 Setting to assign the power amplifiers in this unit for
7.1ch +
ZONE3:
Tips
212
Remote
0 You can connect speakers for up to 9.1 channels for
MAIN ZONE.
Speakers to output audio are automatically switched
for playing back up to 7.1-channels in accordance with
the input signal and sound mode. (v p. 222)
0 Setting to assign the power amplifiers in this unit for
front speaker bi-amp connection to 2-channels.
0 Setting to assign the power amplifiers in this unit for
ZONE2 to 2-channels.
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
0 Setting to assign the power amplifiers in this unit for
9.1ch/
2ch
Front:
0 Setting to assign the power amplifiers within this unit
connecting 2-channel playback speakers to 2 channels.
0 You can switch the front speakers when using 2-channel
playback in direct mode or stereo mode, or when using
multi-channel surround playback. (v p. 223)
When setting speakers for 2-channel playback, also
perform the “2ch Playback” setting. (v p. 238)
7.1ch +
Front B:
for connecting the second set of front speakers.
0 You can switch between the desired combination of
front speakers A and front speakers B. (v p. 224)
Switch the front speaker using the “Front Speaker”
setting. (v p. 238)
0 Setting to assign the power amplifiers within this unit
Dolby
Atmos :
0 Setting to assign the power amplifiers in this unit for the
7.1ch/
2ch
Front
(BiAmp):
Appendix
bi-amp connection of the 2-channel playback speakers
to 4 channels.
0 You can switch the front speakers when using 2-channel
playback in direct mode or stereo mode, or when using
multi-channel surround playback.
When setting speakers for 2-channel playback, also
perform the “2ch Playback” setting. (v p. 238)
for the speaker layout suitable for Dolby Atmos
playback. (v p. 225)
0 All of the speakers are connected using an external
Pre
Amplifier:
power amplifier and this unit is used as an integrated
amplifier.
0 You can connect speakers for up to 13.1 channels for
MAIN ZONE.
Speakers to output audio are automatically switched for
playing back up to 11.1 channels in accordance with the
input signal and sound mode. (v p. 226)
0 The internal amplifier of this unit is assigned as
desired.
Custom:
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
213
0 You can connect speakers for up to 13.1 channels for
MAIN ZONE.
Speakers to output audio are automatically switched for
playing back up to 11.1 channels in accordance with the
input signal and sound mode. (v p. 228)
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
n Height Layout
o Detailed settings when “Assign Mode” is set to
“11.1ch”
Select the type of the height speakers used.
When “Assign Mode” is set to “11.1ch”, set the following items.
GWhen “Height Speakers” is set to “2 Height Speakers”H
Select the height channel used.
n Height Speakers
Select the number of the height speakers used in MAIN ZONE.
Select items
2 Height Speakers
(Default):
Uses a set of (two) height speakers.
Front Height (Default)
4 Height Speakers :
Uses two sets of (four) height speakers.
Top Front
Using Dolby Speakers :
Select when the Dolby Atmos Enabled
speakers are connected.
Top Rear
AUDIO OUT connectors
Display
Rear panel
Top Front
Top Middle
214
Remote
HEIGHT1
Front Height
Top Middle
Top Rear
Rear Height
Front panel
Appendix
Rear Height
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
GWhen “Height Speakers” is set to “4 Height Speakers”H
Select the height channels used for the two pair.
AUDIO OUT connectors
Tips
Appendix
GWhen “Height Speakers” is set to “Using Dolby Speakers”H
Select the height channels used for the two pair.
AUDIO OUT connectors
Select items
HEIGHT1
HEIGHT2
Front Height & Top Middle
Front Height
Top Middle
Front Height & Top Rear
Front Height
Top Rear
Front Height & Rear Height
Front Height
Rear Height
Top Front
Top Rear
Top Front
Rear Height
Front Dolby & Rear Height
Front Dolby
Rear Height
Top Middle
Rear Height
Front Height & Surr. Dolby
Front Height
Surround Dolby
Front Height & Back Dolby
Front Height
Back Dolby
Top Front
Surround Dolby
Select items
Top Front & Top Rear
(Default)
Top Front & Rear Height
Top Middle & Rear Height
Front Dolby
(Default)
Surround Dolby
Rear panel
215
Front Dolby
Not assigned.
Surround Dolby
Not assigned.
Back Dolby
Not assigned.
Front Dolby & Top Rear
Front Dolby
Top Rear
Top Front & Back Dolby
Display
HEIGHT2
Back Dolby
Top Front & Surr. Dolby
Front panel
HEIGHT1
Top Front
Back Dolby
Front Dolby & Surr. Dolby
Front Dolby
Surround Dolby
Front Dolby & Back Dolby
Front Dolby
Back Dolby
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
n Wide/Height2
n Pre-out
Select the channel that is output from the FRONT WIDE/HEIGHT2
speaker terminals.
Selects the PRE OUT connectors that connect the external power
amplifier used in MAIN ZONE.
GWhen “Height Speakers” is set to “2 Height Speakers”H
Front Wide Outputs the front wide channel from the FRONT WIDE/
(Default):
HEIGHT2 speaker terminals.
Outputs the channel assigned for HEIGHT2 from the
FRONT WIDE/HEIGHT2 speaker terminals.
Top Rearz:
For the front wide channel, use the PRE OUT
connectors.
Front:
The front left and right pre-amp outputs are connected
to an external amplifier.
Front
Heightz:
The HEIGHT1 left and right pre-amp outputs are
connected to an external amplifier.
z The displayed selection shows the speaker name assigned for the HEIGHT1
speaker terminal in the “Height Layout” setting.
z The displayed selection shows the channel name assigned for HEIGHT2 in the
“Height Layout” setting.
In some settings, “Wide/Height2” may not be available.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
216
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
GWhen “Height Speakers” is set to “4 Height Speakers” and “Wide/
Height2” is set to “Front Wide”H
Top Rearz:
The HEIGHT2 left and right pre-amp outputs are
connected to an external amplifier.
The front/HEIGHT2 left and right pre-amp outputs
are connected to an external amplifier.
z The speaker name selected using “Height Layout” is displayed.
When one set of pre-amp outputs are used, a maximum 11.1-channel audio can
be output when Dolby Atmos or Dolby Surround are played back. Furthermore,
when two sets of pre-amp outputs are used, a maximum 11.1-channel audio can
be output when Audyssey DSX® or Neo:X are played back in addition to when
Dolby Atmos or Dolby Surround are played back.
GWhen “Height Speakers” is set to “4 Height Speakers” and “Wide/
Height2” is set other than to “Front Wide”H
Front Wide:
Front:
The front left and right pre-amp outputs are
connected to an external amplifier.
Front Dolbyz:
The HEIGHT1 left and right pre-amp outputs are
connected to an external amplifier.
Surround
Dolbyz:
The HEIGHT2 left and right pre-amp outputs are
connected to an external amplifier.
Front Dolby &
Surr. Dolbyz:
The HEIGHT1/HEIGHT2 left and right pre-amp
outputs are connected to an external amplifier.
Front & Surr.
Dolbyz:
The front/HEIGHT2 left and right pre-amp outputs
are connected to an external amplifier.
Front Wide:
The front wide left and right pre-amp outputs are
connected to an external amplifier.
Front & Front
Wide:
The front/front wide left and right pre-amp outputs
are connected to an external amplifier.
z The speaker name selected using “Height Layout” is displayed.
The front wide left and right pre-amp outputs are
connected to an external amplifier.
Front & Front The front/front wide left and right pre-amp outputs are
Wide:
connected to an external amplifier.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
Appendix
GWhen “Height Speakers” is set to “Using Dolby Speakers”H
Available settings differ depending on the “Height Layout” and “Wide/
Height2” settings.
Top Front & Top The HEIGHT1/HEIGHT2 left and right pre-amp
outputs are connected to an external amplifier.
Rearz:
Front & Top
Rearz:
Tips
217
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Select the type of the height speakers used.
This can be selected when the “Height Speakers” setting is “2 Height
Speakers”, “4 Height Speakers” or “Using Dolby Speakers”.
When “Assign Mode” is set to “9.1ch”, set the following items.
n Height Speakers
GWhen “Height Speakers” is set to “2 Height Speakers”H
Select the height channel used.
Select the number of the height speakers used in MAIN ZONE.
Uses no height speakers.
2 Height Speakers
(Default):
Uses a set of (two) height speakers.
4 Height Speakers:
Uses two sets of (four) height speakers.
Using Dolby Speakers:
Select when the Dolby Atmos Enabled
speakers are connected.
Appendix
n Height Layout
o Detailed settings when “Assign Mode” is set to
“9.1ch”
None:
Tips
AUDIO OUT connectors
Select items
Front Height (Default)
HEIGHT1
Front Height
Top Front
Top Front
Top Middle
Top Middle
Top Rear
Top Rear
Rear Height
Rear Height
GWhen “Height Speakers” is set to “4 Height Speakers”H
Select the height channels used for the two pairs of speakers.
Select items
AUDIO OUT connectors
Display
Rear panel
218
HEIGHT2
Top Middle
Front Height & Top Middle
Front Height
Front Height & Top Rear
Front Height
Top Rear
Front Height & Rear Height
Front Height
Rear Height
Top Front & Top Rear
(Default)
Top Front
Top Rear
Top Front & Rear Height
Top Front
Rear Height
Top Middle
Rear Height
Top Middle & Rear Height
Front panel
HEIGHT1
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Front Dolby
(Default)
Surround Dolby
HEIGHT2
Front Dolby
Not assigned.
n Speakers for ZONE2
Select speaker terminals that output audio in ZONE2.
The channels of speaker terminals selected for ZONE2 cannot be
output in MAIN ZONE.
Surround Dolby
Not assigned.
Back Dolby
Not assigned.
Front Dolby & Top Rear
Front Dolby
Top Rear
Front Dolby & Rear Height
Front Dolby
Rear Height
Front Height & Surr. Dolby
Front Height
Surround Dolby
Top Front
Surround Dolby
Front Dolby
Surround Dolby
Top Front & Surr. Dolby
Front panel
Display
When “Assign Mode” is set to “7.1ch + ZONE2”, set the following
items.
HEIGHT1
Back Dolby
Front Dolby & Surr. Dolby
Appendix
o Detailed settings when “Assign Mode” is set to
“7.1ch + ZONE2”
GWhen “Height Speakers” is set to “Using Dolby Speakers”H
Select the height channels used for the two pair.
AUDIO OUT connectors
Select items
Tips
Rear panel
219
FRONT WIDE/
HEIGHT2
(Default):
Outputs audio in ZONE2 from FRONT WIDE/
HEIGHT2 speaker terminals.
HEIGHT1:
Outputs audio in ZONE2 from HEIGHT1
speaker terminals.
SURROUND BACK:
Outputs audio in ZONE2 from SURROUND
BACK speaker terminals.
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
n Height Layout
None
n Speakers for ZONE3
Select speaker terminals that output audio in ZONE3.
The channels of speaker terminals selected for ZONE3 cannot be
output in MAIN ZONE.
No height channels are used.
Front Height
Top Front
Top Front
Top Middle
Top Middle
Top Rear
Top Rear
Rear Height
Rear Height
Front Dolby
Front Dolby
Surround Dolby
Front panel
When “Assign Mode” is set to “7.1ch + ZONE3”, set the following
items.
HEIGHT1
Front Height
(Default)
Surround Dolby
Display
Rear panel
Appendix
o Detailed settings when “Assign Mode” is set to
“7.1ch + ZONE3”
Select the height channel used.
This can be selected when the “Speakers for ZONE2” setting is
“FRONT WIDE/HEIGHT2” or “SURROUND BACK”.
AUDIO OUT connectors
Select items
Tips
220
FRONT WIDE/
HEIGHT2
(Default):
Outputs audio in ZONE3 from FRONT WIDE/
HEIGHT2 speaker terminals.
HEIGHT1:
Outputs audio in ZONE3 from HEIGHT1
speaker terminals.
SURROUND BACK:
Outputs audio in ZONE3 from SURROUND
BACK speaker terminals.
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
n Height Layout
None
n Speakers for ZONE2/3
Select speaker terminals that output audio in ZONE2 and ZONE3.
The channels of speaker terminals selected for ZONE2/ZONE3 cannot
be output in MAIN ZONE.
No height channels are used.
Front Height
Top Front
Top Front
Top Middle
Top Middle
Top Rear
Top Rear
Rear Height
Rear Height
Front Dolby
Front Dolby
Surround Dolby
Front panel
When “Assign Mode” is set to “7.1ch + ZONE2/3-MONO”, set the
following items.
HEIGHT1
Front Height
(Default)
Surround Dolby
Display
Rear panel
Appendix
o Detailed settings when “Assign Mode” is set to
“7.1ch + ZONE2/3-MONO”
Select the height channel used.
This can be selected when the “Speakers for ZONE3” setting is
“FRONT WIDE/HEIGHT2” or “SURROUND BACK”.
AUDIO OUT connectors
Select items
Tips
221
FRONT WIDE/
HEIGHT2
(Default):
Outputs audio in ZONE2 from the L channel of
FRONT WIDE/HEIGHT2 speaker terminals and
audio in ZONE3 from the R channel.
HEIGHT1:
Outputs audio in ZONE2 from the L channel of
HEIGHT1 speaker terminals and audio in ZONE3
from the R channel.
SURROUND
BACK:
Outputs audio in ZONE2 from the L channel of
SURROUND BACK speaker terminals and audio in
ZONE3 from the R channel.
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
n Height Layout
None
n Speakers for Bi-Amp
Select the speaker terminals used for the bi-amp connection of front
speakers.
The channels of speaker terminals selected for the bi-amp cannot be
output in MAIN ZONE.
No height channels are used.
Front Height
Top Front
Top Front
Top Middle
Top Middle
Top Rear
Top Rear
Rear Height
Rear Height
Front Dolby
Front Dolby
Surround Dolby
Front panel
When “Assign Mode” is set to “7.1ch (Bi-Amp)”, set the following items.
HEIGHT1
Front Height
(Default)
Surround Dolby
Display
Rear panel
Appendix
o Detailed settings when “Assign Mode” is set to
“7.1ch (Bi-Amp)”
Select the height channel used.
This can be selected when the “Speakers for ZONE2/3” setting is
“FRONT WIDE/HEIGHT2” or “SURROUND BACK”.
AUDIO OUT connectors
Select items
Tips
222
FRONT WIDE/
HEIGHT2
(Default):
Make the bi-amp connection by using the FRONT
speaker terminals and FRONT WIDE/HEIGHT2
speaker terminals.
HEIGHT1:
Make the bi-amp connection by using the FRONT
speaker terminals and HEIGHT1 speaker
terminals.
SURROUND
BACK:
Make the bi-amp connection by using the FRONT
speaker terminals and SURROUND BACK
speaker terminals.
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
n Height Layout
None
n Speakers for 2ch
Select the speaker terminals that connect the front speakers
exclusively used for 2-channel playback.
No height channels are used.
Front Height
Top Front
Top Front
Top Middle
Top Middle
Top Rear
Top Rear
Rear Height
Rear Height
Front Dolby
Front Dolby
Surround Dolby
Front panel
When “Assign Mode” is set to “9.1ch/2ch Front”, set the following
items.
HEIGHT1
Front Height
(Default)
Surround Dolby
Display
Rear panel
Appendix
o Detailed settings when “Assign Mode” is set to
“9.1ch/2ch Front”
Select the height channel used.
This can be selected when the “Speakers for Bi-Amp” setting is
“FRONT WIDE/HEIGHT2” or “SURROUND BACK”.
AUDIO OUT connectors
Select items
Tips
223
FRONT WIDE/
HEIGHT2
(Default):
Connect the front speakers exclusively used for 2channel playback to the “FRONT WIDE/
HEIGHT2” speaker terminals.
HEIGHT1:
Connect the front speakers exclusively used for 2channel playback to the HEIGHT1 speaker
terminals.
SURROUND
BACK:
Connect the front speakers exclusively used for 2channel playback to the SURROUND BACK
speaker terminals.
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
n Height Layout
None
n Speakers for Front B
Select the speaker terminals used for the front speakers of the second
unit.
No height channels are used.
Front Height
Top Front
Top Front
Top Middle
Top Middle
Top Rear
Top Rear
Rear Height
Rear Height
Front Dolby
Front Dolby
Surround Dolby
Front panel
When “Assign Mode” is set to “7.1ch + Front B”, set the following
items.
HEIGHT1
Front Height
(Default)
Surround Dolby
Display
Rear panel
Appendix
o Detailed settings when “Assign Mode” is set to
“7.1ch + Front B”
Select the height channel used.
This can be selected when the “Speakers for 2ch” setting is “FRONT
WIDE/HEIGHT2” or “SURROUND BACK”.
AUDIO OUT connectors
Select items
Tips
224
FRONT WIDE/
HEIGHT2
(Default):
Connect the front speakers of the second unit to
the FRONT WIDE/HEIGHT2 speaker terminals.
HEIGHT1:
Connect the front speakers of the second unit to
the HEIGHT1 speaker terminals.
SURROUND
BACK:
Connect the front speakers of the second unit to
the SURROUND BACK speaker terminals.
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
n Height Layout
None
n Layout
Select the speaker layout for Dolby Atmos playback.
No height channels are used.
7.1ch + 4 Height:
This is a layout that adds the top front and
top rear speakers to the 7.1 channel layout
which includes the surround back channel.
Connect the top front speakers to the
HEIGHT1 speaker terminals and connect the
top rear speakers to the HEIGHT2 PRE OUT
connectors through an external power
amplifier.
7.1ch + 2 Height
(Default):
This is a layout that adds the top middle
speakers to the 7.1 channel layout including
the surround back channel. Connect the top
middle speakers to the HEIGHT1 speaker
terminals.
5.1ch + 4 Height:
This is a layout that adds the top front and
top rear speakers to the basic 5.1 channel
layout. Connect the top front speakers to the
HEIGHT1 speaker terminals and the top rear
speakers to the FRONT WIDE/HEIGHT2
speaker terminals.
5.1ch + 2 Height:
This is a layout that adds the top middle
speakers to the basic 5.1 channel layout.
Connect the top middle speakers to the
HEIGHT1 speaker terminals.
Front Height
Top Front
Top Front
Top Middle
Top Middle
Top Rear
Top Rear
Rear Height
Rear Height
Front Dolby
Front Dolby
Surround Dolby
Front panel
When “Assign Mode” is set to “Dolby Atmos”, set the following items.
HEIGHT1
Front Height
(Default)
Surround Dolby
Display
Rear panel
Appendix
o Detailed settings when “Assign Mode” is set to
“Dolby Atmos”
Select the height channel used.
This can be selected when the “Speakers for Front B” setting is
“FRONT WIDE/HEIGHT2” or “SURROUND BACK”.
AUDIO OUT connectors
Select items
Tips
225
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Select the type of the height speakers used.
When “Assign Mode” is set to “Pre Amplifier”, set the following items.
GWhen “Height Speakers” is set to “2 Height Speakers”H
Select the height channel used.
n Height Speakers
Select the number of the height speakers used in MAIN ZONE.
None:
Uses no height speakers.
Uses a set of (two) height speakers.
4 Height Speakers :
Uses two sets of (four) height speakers.
Select items
Display
Rear panel
AUDIO OUT connectors
Front Height (Default)
Top Front
Top Middle
Top Middle
Top Rear
Top Rear
Rear Height
226
Remote
HEIGHT1
Front Height
Top Front
Select when the Dolby Atmos Enabled
Using Dolby Speakers :
speakers are connected.
Front panel
Appendix
n Height Layout
o Detailed settings when “Assign Mode” is set to
“Pre Amplifier”
2 Height Speakers
(Default):
Tips
Rear Height
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
GWhen “Height Speakers” is set to “Using Dolby Speakers”H
Select the height channels used for the two pair.
AUDIO OUT connectors
Tips
Appendix
GWhen “Height Speakers” is set to “Using Dolby Speakers”H
Select the height channels used for the two pair.
AUDIO OUT connectors
Select items
HEIGHT1
HEIGHT2
Front Height & Top Middle
Front Height
Top Middle
Front Height & Top Rear
Front Height
Top Rear
Front Height & Rear Height
Front Height
Rear Height
Top Front
Top Rear
Top Front
Rear Height
Front Dolby & Rear Height
Front Dolby
Rear Height
Top Middle
Rear Height
Front Height & Surr. Dolby
Front Height
Surround Dolby
Front Height & Back Dolby
Front Height
Back Dolby
Top Front
Surround Dolby
Select items
Top Front & Top Rear
(Default)
Top Front & Rear Height
Top Middle & Rear Height
Front Dolby
(Default)
Surround Dolby
Rear panel
227
Front Dolby
Not assigned.
Surround Dolby
Not assigned.
Back Dolby
Not assigned.
Front Dolby & Top Rear
Front Dolby
Top Rear
Top Front & Back Dolby
Display
HEIGHT2
Back Dolby
Top Front & Surr. Dolby
Front panel
HEIGHT1
Top Front
Back Dolby
Front Dolby & Surr. Dolby
Front Dolby
Surround Dolby
Front Dolby & Back Dolby
Front Dolby
Back Dolby
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Select the type of the height speakers used.
When “Assign Mode” is set to “Custom”, set the following items.
GWhen “Height Speakers” is set to “2 Height Speakers”H
Select the height channel used.
n Height Speakers
Select the number of the height speakers used in MAIN ZONE.
None:
Uses no height speakers.
Uses a set of (two) height speakers.
4 Height Speakers :
Uses two sets of (four) height speakers.
Select items
Display
Rear panel
AUDIO OUT connectors
Front Height (Default)
Top Front
Top Middle
Top Middle
Top Rear
Top Rear
Rear Height
228
Remote
HEIGHT1
Front Height
Top Front
Select when the Dolby Atmos Enabled
Using Dolby Speakers :
speakers are connected.
Front panel
Appendix
n Height Layout
o Detailed settings when “Assign Mode” is set to
“Custom”
2 Height Speakers
(Default):
Tips
Rear Height
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
GWhen “Height Speakers” is set to “Using Dolby Speakers”H
Select the height channels used for the two pair.
AUDIO OUT connectors
Tips
Appendix
GWhen “Height Speakers” is set to “Using Dolby Speakers”H
Select the height channels used for the two pair.
AUDIO OUT connectors
Select items
HEIGHT1
HEIGHT2
Front Height & Top Middle
Front Height
Top Middle
Front Height & Top Rear
Front Height
Top Rear
Front Height & Rear Height
Front Height
Rear Height
Top Front
Top Rear
Top Front
Rear Height
Front Dolby & Rear Height
Front Dolby
Rear Height
Top Middle
Rear Height
Front Height & Surr. Dolby
Front Height
Surround Dolby
Front Height & Back Dolby
Front Height
Back Dolby
Top Front
Surround Dolby
Select items
Top Front & Top Rear
(Default)
Top Front & Rear Height
Top Middle & Rear Height
Front Dolby
(Default)
Surround Dolby
Rear panel
229
Front Dolby
Not assigned.
Surround Dolby
Not assigned.
Back Dolby
Not assigned.
Front Dolby & Top Rear
Front Dolby
Top Rear
Top Front & Back Dolby
Display
HEIGHT2
Back Dolby
Top Front & Surr. Dolby
Front panel
HEIGHT1
Top Front
Back Dolby
Front Dolby & Surr. Dolby
Front Dolby
Surround Dolby
Front Dolby & Back Dolby
Front Dolby
Back Dolby
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
n Setting
Tips
Appendix
Speaker Config.
Select the signal to be output from the selected speaker terminal.
0 Only “Center” and “None” can be set for the CENTER speaker
terminal.
0 Only “Surround” and “None” can be set for the SURROUND speaker
terminal.
0 The HEIGHT1 speaker terminal is not used.
Select whether or not speakers are present, playback capacity for low
bass frequencies and speaker size.
o Front
Set the front speaker size.
o View Terminal Config.
This shows how to connect the speaker terminals and PRE OUT
connectors for your “Amp Assign” setting on the menu screen.
Large
(Default):
Use a large speaker that can adequately
play back very low bass frequencies.
Small:
Use a small speaker that has inadequate
playback capacity for very low bass
frequencies.
0 When “Subwoofer” is set to “No”, “Front” is automatically set to “Large”.
0 When “Front” is set to “Small”, you cannot set speakers other than “Front” to
“Large”.
o Center
Set the presence and size of the center speaker.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
230
Large:
Use a large speaker that can adequately
play back very low bass frequencies.
Small
(Default):
Use a small speaker that has inadequate
playback capacity for very low bass
frequencies.
None:
Select when a center speaker is not
connected.
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
o Surr. Back
o Subwoofer
Set the presence, size and number of surround back speakers.
Set the presence of a subwoofer.
2 spkrs:
Use two subwoofers.
1 spkr
(Default):
Use only one subwoofer.
None:
Select when a subwoofer is not
connected.
When “Subwoofer” is set to “None” and you set “Front” to “Small”, “Subwoofer” is
automatically set to “1 spkr”.
o Surround
Set the presence and size of the surround speakers.
Large:
Use a large speaker that can adequately
play back very low bass frequencies.
Small
(Default):
Use a small speaker that has inadequate
playback capacity for very low bass
frequencies.
None:
Select when the surround speakers are
not connected.
Large:
Use a large speaker that can adequately
play back very low bass frequencies.
Small
(Default):
Use a small speaker that has inadequate
playback capacity for very low bass
frequencies.
None:
Select when the surround back speakers
are not connected.
2 spkrs
(Default):
Use two surround back speakers.
1 spkr:
Use only one surround back speaker.
Connect to the L terminal to SURROUND
BACK when this setting is selected.
If “Surr. Back” is “None” or “1 spkr”, “Back Dolby” is automatically “None”.
When “Surround” is set to “None”, “Surr. Back”, “Front Wide”, “Surround Dolby”
and “Back Dolby” are automatically set to “None”.
Front panel
Appendix
Display
Rear panel
231
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
o Front Wide
Tips
Appendix
o Top Front
Set the presence and size of the front wide speakers.
Set the presence and size of the top front speakers.
Large:
Use a large speaker that can adequately
play back very low bass frequencies.
Large:
Use a large speaker that can adequately
play back very low bass frequencies.
Small
(Default):
Use a small speaker that has inadequate
playback capacity for very low bass
frequencies.
Small
(Default):
Use a small speaker that has inadequate
playback capacity for very low bass
frequencies.
None:
Select when the front wide speakers are
not connected.
None:
Select when the top front speakers are
not connected.
o Front Height
o Top Middle
Set the presence and size of the front height speakers.
Set the presence and size of the top middle speakers.
Large:
Use a large speaker that can adequately
play back very low bass frequencies.
Large:
Use a large speaker that can adequately
play back very low bass frequencies.
Small
(Default):
Use a small speaker that has inadequate
playback capacity for very low bass
frequencies.
Small
(Default):
Use a small speaker that has inadequate
playback capacity for very low bass
frequencies.
None:
Select when the front height speakers are
not connected.
None:
Select when the top middle speakers are
not connected.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
232
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
o Top Rear
Tips
Appendix
o Front Dolby
Set the presence and size of the top rear speakers.
Set the presence and size of the front Dolby speakers.
Large:
Use a large speaker that can adequately
play back very low bass frequencies.
Large:
Use a large speaker that can adequately
play back very low bass frequencies.
Small
(Default):
Use a small speaker that has inadequate
playback capacity for very low bass
frequencies.
Small
(Default):
Use a small speaker that has inadequate
playback capacity for very low bass
frequencies.
None:
Select when the top rear speakers are
not connected.
None:
Select when the front Dolby speakers are
not connected.
o Rear Height
o Surround Dolby
Set the presence and size of the rear height speakers.
Set the presence and size of the surround Dolby speakers.
Large:
Use a large speaker that can adequately
play back very low bass frequencies.
Large:
Use a large speaker that can adequately
play back very low bass frequencies.
Small
(Default):
Use a small speaker that has inadequate
playback capacity for very low bass
frequencies.
Small
(Default):
Use a small speaker that has inadequate
playback capacity for very low bass
frequencies.
None:
Select when the rear height speakers are
not connected.
None:
Select when the surround Dolby
speakers are not connected.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
233
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
o Back Dolby
Use a large speaker that can adequately
play back very low bass frequencies.
Small
(Default):
Use a small speaker that has inadequate
playback capacity for very low bass
frequencies.
None:
Select when the back Dolby speakers are
not connected.
Appendix
Distances
Set the presence and size of the back Dolby speakers.
Large:
Tips
Set distance from listening position to speakers.
Measure beforehand the distance from the listening position to each
speaker.
o Unit
Set the unit of distance.
Meters (Default)
Feet
o Step
When speakers for which you assigned Height1 in “Amp Assign” are set to
“None”, “None” is automatically set for Height2.
Set the minimum variable width of the distance.
0.1 m (Default) / 0.01 m
1 ft / 0.1 ft
o Set Defaults
The “Distances” settings are returned to the default settings.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
234
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
o Set the distance
Tips
Appendix
Levels
0.00 m – 18.00 m / 0.0 ft – 60.0 ft
Set the volume of the test tone to be the same at the listening position
when it is output from each speaker.
o Test Tone Start
0 The speakers that can be selected differ depending on the “Amp Assign” and
“Speaker Config.” settings. (v p. 211, 230)
0 Default settings:
Front L / Front R / F. Height L / F. Height R / F. Wide L / F. Wide R / Center /
Subwoofer 1 / Subwoofer 2: 3.60 m (12.0 ft)
Speakers other than the above: 3.00 m (10.0 ft)
0 Set the difference in the distance between the speakers to less than 6.00 m
(20.0 ft).
A test tone is output from the selected speaker.
While listening to the test tone, adjust the volume output from the
selected speaker.
–12.0 dB – +12.0 dB (Default : 0.0 dB)
0 The set “Levels” are reflected in all sound modes.
0 If you wish to adjust the channel level for each input source, carry out the
settings in “Channel Level Adjust”. (v p. 126)
0 When headphones are connected to the PHONES connector on this unit, you
cannot set “Levels”.
o Set Defaults
The “Levels” settings are returned to the default settings.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
235
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
o Set the crossover frequency
Crossovers
40 Hz / 60 Hz / 80 Hz / 90 Hz / 100 Hz / 110 Hz / 120 Hz / 150 Hz /
200 Hz / 250 Hz (Default : 80 Hz)
Set in accordance with the lower limit frequency of the base frequencies
that can be played back through each speaker. See the speaker manual
for information concerning speaker crossover frequency.
o Speaker Selection
0 “Crossovers” can be set when the “Subwoofer Mode” setting is “LFE+Main”, or
when you have a speaker that is set to “Small”. (v p. 237)
0 The default crossover frequency is “80 Hz”, which will work best with the
widest variety of speakers. We recommend setting to a higher frequency that
the crossover frequency when small speakers are used. For example, set to
“250 Hz” when the frequency range of the speakers is 250 Hz – 20 kHz.
0 Sound below the crossover frequency is cut off from the output of the
speakers set in “Small”. This cut off bass frequency is output from the
subwoofer or front speakers.
0 The speakers that can be set when “Individual” is selected differ depending on
to the “Subwoofer Mode” setting. (v p. 237)
Selects how to set the crossover frequency.
All
(Default):
Sets the same crossover frequency for all
speakers.
Individual:
Selects the crossover points for each
speaker individually.
0 When “LFE” is selected, speakers set to “Small” at “Speaker Config.” can be
set. If the speakers are set to (v p. 230)“Large”, “Full Band” is displayed
and the setting cannot be made.
0 When “LFE+Main” is selected, speakers can be set regardless of the
“Speaker Config.” setting. (v p. 230)
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
236
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
o LPF for LFE
Bass
Set LFE signal playback range. Set this when you want to change the
playback frequency (low pass filter point) of the subwoofer.
Set subwoofer and LFE signal range playback.
80 Hz / 90 Hz / 100 Hz / 110 Hz / 120 Hz / 150 Hz /
200 Hz / 250 Hz (Default : 120 Hz)
o Subwoofer Mode
Select low range signals to be reproduced by subwoofer.
LFE
(Default):
The low range signal of the channel set to
“Small” speaker size is added to the LFE
signal output from the subwoofer.
LFE+Main:
The low range signal of all channels is
added to the LFE signal output from the
subwoofer.
0 “Subwoofer Mode” can be set when “Speaker Config.” - “Subwoofer” in the
menu is set to other than “None”. (v p. 231)
0 Play music or a movie source and select the mode offering the strongest bass.
0 If “Speaker Config.” - “Front” and “Center” are set to “Large”, and “Subwoofer
Mode” is set to “LFE”, no sound may be output from the subwoofers,
depending on the input signal or selected sound mode. Select “LFE+Main” if
you want the bass signals to always be produced from the subwoofer.
(v p. 230)
Front panel
Appendix
Display
Rear panel
237
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Front Speaker
Appendix
2ch Playback
Set the front speaker A/B to use for every sound mode.
A
(Default):
Front speaker A is used.
B:
Front speaker B is used.
A+B :
Both front speakers A and B are used.
Select the method for setting the speakers used in the 2-channel direct
and stereo playback modes.
o Setting
Select the method for setting the speakers used in the 2-channel direct
and stereo playback modes.
This can be set when “Assign Mode” is set to “Front B”. (v p. 211)
Front panel
Tips
Display
Rear panel
238
Auto
(Default):
The settings in “Speakers” are applied. (v p. 200)
Manual:
Set the speakers for 2-channel playback. Make the
following settings:
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
o Front
Tips
Appendix
o SW Mode
Set the size of the front speakers for 2-channel playback.
Large
(Default):
Use a large speaker that can adequately play back
very low bass frequencies.
Small:
Use a small speaker that has inadequate playback
capacity for very low bass frequencies.
Select low range signals to be reproduced by subwoofer.
LFE
(Default):
When “2ch Playback”-“Front” is set to “Large”, only
LFE signals are output from the subwoofer. Also,
when “2ch Playback” - “Front” is set to “Small”, the
front channel low range signals are added to the
LFE signals and output from the subwoofer.
LFE+Main:
The front channel low range signal is added to the
LFE signal output from the subwoofer.
When “Speaker Config.”-“Subwoofer” in the menu is set to “None”, “Large” is
automatically set. (v p. 231)
This can be set when “2ch Playback”-“Subwoofer” is set to “Yes”.
o Subwoofer
Set the presence of a subwoofer.
Yes
(Default):
Use a subwoofer.
No:
Select when a subwoofer is not connected.
When “Speaker Config.”-“Subwoofer” in the menu is set to “None”, No is
automatically set. (v p. 231) If the “Front” setting is “Small”, the setting is
automatically “Yes”.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
239
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
o Crossover
Tips
o Distance FL/Distance FR
Set the maximum frequency of the bass signal output from each
channel to the subwoofer.
Set distance from main listening position to speaker.
0.00 m – 18.00 m (Default : 3.60 m) /
0.0 ft – 60.0 ft (Default : 12.0 ft)
40 Hz / 60 Hz / 80 Hz / 90 Hz / 100 Hz / 110 Hz / 120 Hz / 150 Hz /
200 Hz / 250 Hz (Default : 80 Hz)
Set the difference in the distance between the speakers to less than 6.00 m (20.0
ft).
0 This can be set when “2ch Playback”-“Subwoofer” is set to “Yes”.
0 When “2ch Playback”-“Front” is set to “Large” and “SW Mode” is set to LFE,
“Full Band” is displayed and this cannot be set.
o Level FL/Level FR
Adjust the level of each channel.
-12.0dB – +12.0dB (Default : 0.0dB)
Front panel
Appendix
Display
Rear panel
240
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Network
To use this unit by connecting it to a home network (LAN), you must configure network settings.
If you set up your home network (LAN) via DHCP, set “DHCP” to “On”. (Use the default setting.) This allows this unit to use your home network (LAN).
When assigning an IP address to each device manually, you need to assign an IP address to this unit using the “IP Address” settings, and enter
information about your home network (LAN) such as the gateway address and subnet mask, etc.
o Connect Using
Information
Select the method for connecting to the home network (LAN).
Display network information.
Wired (Ethernet): Use a LAN cable to connect to a network.
Friendly Name / Connection / SSID / DHCP / IP Address / MAC
Address
Wireless (Wi-Fi):
MAC Address is required to create a vTuner account.
You can disable the Wi-Fi function of this unit by configuring the following
settings.
Connection
1. Press and hold the main unit’s o and p at the same time for at least
3 seconds.
“zVideo Format <NTSC>” appears on the display.
2. Use the main unit’s i to display “zWired LAN <Unlock>”.
3. Use the main unit’s o or p to select “<Lock>”.
4. Press the main unit’s ENTER to complete the setting.
Choose whether to connect the home network to a wireless LAN or a
wired LAN.
When connecting to the network using wired LAN, select “Wired
(Ethernet)” after connecting a LAN cable,
When connecting to the network using wireless LAN, select “Wireless (WiFi)” and configure the “Wi-Fi Setup”.
Front panel
Display
Use the wireless LAN (Wi-Fi) function to connect
to a network.
Rear panel
241
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Appendix
n When connecting using Wi-Fi
Wi-Fi Setup
1. Select “Wireless connection” on the TV screen.
2. Check that your iOS device is connected to the wireless LAN
(Wi-Fi) router and select “Denon AVR-X7200W” from “SET UP
NEW AIRPLAY SPEAKER...” at the bottom of the Wi-Fi
configuration screen of your iOS device.
3. Tap “Next” on the screen of the iOS device.
Connect to a wireless LAN (Wi-Fi) router.
The router can be connected in the following ways. Select the connection
method to suit your home environment.
o Scan Networks
Select the network you wish to connect to from the list of possible
networks shown on the TV screen.
The iOS device firmware version needs to support iOS7 or later.
1. Select the network you wish to connect to from the list of wireless
networks.
Select “Rescan” if the network cannot be found.
2. Enter your password and select “OK”.
n When using a USB cable
1. Select “USB cable” on the TV screen.
2. Check that your iOS device is connected to the wireless LAN
(Wi-Fi) and connect it to the USB port on the front panel using a
USB cable.
3. Select “Connect” on the TV screen.
4. Tap “Allow” when the connection message appears on the
screen of your iOS device.
o Use iOS Device
Use your iOS device (iPhone/iPod/iPad) to connect to the network. By
connecting your iOS device to this unit, the unit can be automatically
connected to the same network as your device.
This unit can be connected to your iOS device in two ways, using a
USB cable and using Wi-Fi.
Front panel
Tips
Display
Rear panel
The iOS device firmware version needs to support iOS5 or later.
242
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
o WPS Router
Tips
Appendix
o Manual
Use a WPS-compatible router to connect.
There are two ways to connect, using the push button method or the
PIN code method. Select the connection method to match your router.
Enter the name (SSID) and password of the network you wish to
connect to.
1. Set the following items.
n When connecting using the push button method
1. Select “Push Button” on the TV screen.
2. Switch to the WPS mode by pressing the WPS button of the
router you wish to connect to.
0 The time for pressing the button varies depending on the
router.
3. Select “Connect” on the TV screen within 2 minutes.
SSID:
Input the name of the wireless network (SSID).
Security:
Select the encryption method according to the
encryption setting of the access point you are using.
Password:
Input the password.
Select the Default Key.
Default Key: When connecting to a “WEP” encrypted network,
“Default Key” menu is displayed.
n When connecting using the PIN code method
2. Select “Connect” at the end of the setting.
1. Select “PIN” on the TV screen.
2. Register the PIN code of the unit in the router.
The wireless LAN (Wi-Fi) settings of this unit can also be configured from a PC or
tablet that supports wireless LAN connection.
When using a device that has a firmware version of iOS7 or later, “When connecting
using Wi-Fi” (v p. 242) in “Use iOS Device”.
1. Press and hold the DIMMER and STATUS buttons on the main unit for at least 3
seconds when the power of the unit is on.
2. Connect the wireless LAN of the PC or tablet used to “Denon AVR-X7200W” when
the message “Connect your Wi-Fi device to Wi-Fi network called “Denon AVRX7200W”” appears in the display.
3. Start up the browser and enter “192.168.1.16” in the URL.
4. Use the browser to enter the settings, select “Connect” and then exit the settings.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
243
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
o IP Address
Settings
Set the IP address within the ranges shown below.
Configure the proxy settings and IP address.
0 If you are using a broadband router (DHCP function), the information
required for network connection such as the IP address will be
automatically configured since the DHCP function is set to “On” in the
default settings of this unit.
0 Set up the IP Address, Subnet Mask, Default Gateway and DNS server
information only when assigning a fixed IP address or when connecting
to a network without DHCP function.
0 Configure the proxy settings when using a proxy server to connect to
the Internet.
0 The Network Audio function cannot be used if other IP addresses
are set.
CLASS A:10.0.0.1 - 10.255.255.254
CLASS B:172.16.0.1 - 172.31.255.254
CLASS C:192.168.0.1 - 192.168.255.254
o Subnet Mask
When connecting an xDSL modem or connector adapter directly to
this unit, input the subnet mask indicated in the documentation
supplied by your provider. Normally input 255.255.255.0.
o Default Gateway
Network/Settings
When connected to a gateway (router), input its IP address.
DHCP
Off
-IP Address
192.168.001.002
255.255.255.000
-Subnet Mask
-Default Gateway
192.168.001.001
-Primary DNS
192.168.001.001
-Secondary DNS
000.000.000.000
Proxy
On(Address)
-Address
000.000.000.000
-Port
00000
Save
Cancel
Configures the network settings manually
o Primary DNS, Secondary DNS
.
If there is only one DNS address indicated in the documentation
supplied by your provider, input it at “Primary DNS”. If two or more
DNS are provided by your provider, enter both “Primary DNS” and
“Secondary DNS”.
o DHCP
Selects how to connect to the network.
On
(Default):
Configure the network settings
automatically from your router.
Off:
Configure the network settings manually.
Front panel
Appendix
Display
Rear panel
244
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
o Proxy
On(Address):
Select when inputting by address.
Select when inputting by domain name.
Off
(Default):
Disables the proxy server.
Appendix
IP Control
Make this setting when connecting to the Internet via a proxy server.
Make the proxy settings only when you connect to the Internet via a
proxy server that is on your internal network or provided by your
provider, etc.
On(Name):
Tips
Enables network communication in standby power mode.
o Port
Off In Standby
(Default):
Suspend network function during standby.
Always On:
Network is on during standby. Main unit
operable with a network compatible
controller.
When using the web control function or Denon Remote App, use with the “IP Control”
setting set to “Always On”.
Enter port number.
NOTE
When “IP Control” is set to “Always On”, it consumes more standby power.
0 If you cannot connect to the Internet, recheck the connections and settings.
(v p. 72)
0 If you do not understand about Internet connection, contact your ISP (Internet
Service Provider) or the store from which you purchased your computer.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
245
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Friendly Name
Tips
Appendix
Diagnostics
The Friendly Name is the name of this unit displayed on the network. You
can change the Friendly Name according to your preferences.
Used to check the network connection.
o Physical Connection
o Friendly Name
Checks the physical LAN port connection.
Selects Friendly Name from the list.
When you select “Other”, you can change the Friendly Name
according to your preferences.
OK
Error: The LAN cable is not connected. Check the connection.
Home Theater / Living Room / Family Room / Guest Room /
Kitchen / Dining Room / Master Bedroom / Bedroom / Den /
Office / Other
When connected using a wireless LAN, “Connection
displayed.
Wireless (Wi-Fi)” will be
o Router Access
Checks the connection from this unit to the router.
0 Up to 63 characters can be input.
For character input, see “Using the keyboard screen” (v p. 166).
0 The default Friendly Name on first use is “Denon AVR-X7200W”.
OK
o Set Defaults
Error:
Restores Friendly Name, which you had changed, to the default
setting.
Failed to communicate with the router. Check the router
settings.
o Internet Access
Checks whether this unit has access to the Internet (WAN).
OK
Error:
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
246
Failed to connect to the Internet. Check the Internet connection
environment or router settings.
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Maintenance Mode
Use when receiving maintenance from a Denon service engineer or
custom installer. Ordinarily, this mode isn’t suitable for use by the end
user, only by a trained service technician or custom installation
professional.
NOTE
Only use this function if so instructed by a Denon serviceperson or installer.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
247
Remote
Index
Appendix
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
General
Make various other settings.
ECO
Language
Set the language for display the menu on the TV screen.
Configure the settings of the ECO Mode and auto standby mode.
English / Deutsch / Français / Italiano / Español / Nederlands /
Svenska / Pусский / Polski
(Default : English)
o ECO Mode
This mode can reduce the power consumption when the power of the
unit is on.
“Language” can also be set up by the following operation. However, the menu screen
is not displayed. Watch the display while configuring the settings.
1. Press and hold the main unit’s o and p at the same time for at least 3
seconds.
“zVideo Format <PAL>” appears on the display.
2. Press the main unit’s i.
“zGUI Language <ENGLISH>” appears on the display.
3. Use the main unit’s o or p and set the language.
4. Press the main unit’s ENTER to complete the setting.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
On:
Reduce the power consumption.
Auto:
The power consumption is automatically
reduced to match the volume.
Off
(Default):
Do not reduce the power consumption.
0 When you want to output audio at a high volume level, it is recommended to
set “ECO Mode” to “Off”.
0 Eco mode can also be switched by pressing ECO G on the remote control
unit.
248
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
o Power On Default
Tips
Appendix
o Auto Standby
Set the mode to ECO when the power is on.
Set so the unit power automatically switches to standby.
Last
(Default):
The ECO Mode will be set to the previous
setting before the power was switched off.
n MAIN ZONE
On:
When power is turned on, the mode will
always be switched to the ECO Mode in
“On”.
Auto:
When power is turned on, the mode will
always be switched to the ECO Mode in
“Auto”.
Off:
Sets the time for switching to auto standby when there are no audio or
video signals input into this unit.
Before the unit enters standby mode, “Auto Standby” is displayed on
the unit display and the menu screen.
When power is turned on, the mode will
always be switched to the ECO Mode in
“Off”.
o On Screen Display
60 min:
The unit goes into standby after 60 minutes.
30 min:
The unit goes into standby after 30 minutes.
15 min
(Default):
The unit goes into standby after 15 minutes.
Off:
The unit does not go into standby
automatically.
n ZONE2 / ZONE3
Display the power consumption of this unit using a meter on the TV
screen.
When there are no operations for a certain period of time as set here,
the power is automatically shut off even if there is audio or video input.
Always On:
Always display the meter on the TV screen.
Auto
(Default):
Display the meter when changing the mode
or volume.
8 hours:
Switches ZONE2/ZONE3 the standby state
after about 8 hours.
Off:
Do not display the meter.
4 hours:
Switches ZONE2/ZONE3 to the standby
state after about 4 hours.
2 hours:
Switches ZONE2/ZONE3 to the standby
state after about 2 hours.
Off
(Default):
Does not automatically switch ZONE2/
ZONE3 to the standby state.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
249
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Appendix
o Lch Level
ZONE2 Setup / ZONE3 Setup
Adjust the left channel output level.
Makes settings for audio playback with ZONE2 and ZONE3.
-12 dB – +12 dB (Default : 0 dB)
o Rch Level
Values set for “Volume Limit” and “Power On Volume” are displayed according to the
setting specified for the volume “Scale”. (v p. 174)
Adjust the right channel output level.
-12 dB – +12 dB (Default : 0 dB)
o Bass
o Channel
Adjust bass.
-10 dB – +10 dB (Default : 0 dB)
Set whether to playback in stereo or monaural.
o Treble
Adjust treble.
-10 dB – +10 dB (Default : 0 dB)
Stereo
(Default):
Stereo playback.
Mono:
Monaural playback.
o HDMI Audio (ZONE2 only)
o High Pass Filter
Selects the audio signal format for playing an HDMI source in ZONE2.
Make settings for cutting the low range to reduce distortion in the bass.
On:
The low range is attenuated.
Off
(Default):
The low range is not attenuated.
Front panel
Tips
Display
Through The HDMI audio signal is passed through this unit to the
(Default): device in ZONE2.
PCM:
Rear panel
250
The HDMI audio signal input into this unit is converted to a
PCM signal that can be output from the ZONE2 PRE OUT
terminals or speaker terminals.
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
o Volume Level
Tips
Appendix
o Power On Volume
Set the volume output level.
Define the volume setting that is active when the power is turned on.
Variable
(Default):
Last
(Default):
Use the memorized setting from the last
session.
Mute:
Always use the muting on condition.
Volume can be adjusted.
Volume is fixed at the desired level. The
1 – 98
volume cannot be adjusting using the remote
(–79.5 dB – 18.0 dB):
control unit.
1 – 98
The volume is adjusted to the set level.
(–79.5 dB – 18.0 dB):
o Volume Limit
Make a setting for maximum volume.
This can be set when “Volume Level” is set to “Variable”. (v p. 251)
60 (-20 dB) / 70 (-10 dB) / 80 (0 dB)
(Default : 70 (-10 dB))
Off:
o Mute Level
Do not set a maximum volume.
Set the amount of attenuation when muting is on.
This can be set when “Volume Level” is set to “Variable”. (v p. 251)
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
251
Full
(Default):
The sound is muted entirely.
–40 dB :
The sound is attenuated by 40 dB down.
–20 dB :
The sound is attenuated by 20 dB down.
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Zone Rename
Set when you operate another Denon AV amplifier with the remote control
unit of this unit. Match the remote control unit you are using with the
remote ID of this unit.
MAIN ZONE / ZONE2 / ZONE3
Set Defaults: The default setting is restored for the edited zone name.
o Settings
1
Up to 10 characters can be input.
For character input, see “Using the keyboard screen” (v p. 166).
2
Quick Select Names
Change the quick select name that appears on the TV screen to one you
prefer.
3
4
5
6
Quick Select 1 / Quick Select 2 / Quick Select 3 / Quick Select 4
The default setting is restored for the edited quick select
name.
Up to 16 characters can be input.
For character input, see “Using the keyboard screen” (v p. 166).
Front panel
Appendix
Remote ID
Change the display title of each zone to one you prefer.
Set Defaults:
Tips
Display
Rear panel
252
Press ZONE SELECT to switch the zone mode.
The J indicator lights.
Press SETUP.
The menu is displayed on the TV screen.
Use ui to select “General”, then press ENTER.
Use ui to select “Remote ID”, then press ENTER.
Change the ID for the remote control unit. (v p. 275)
Press ENTER.
The Remote ID for this unit is set to the same ID as the one for the
remote control unit.
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Trigger Out 1 / Trigger Out 2
Tips
Appendix
Front Display
Select the conditions for activating trigger out.
For details about how to connect the TRIGGER OUT jacks, see
“TRIGGER OUT jacks” (v p. 75).
Makes settings related to the display on this unit.
o Dimmer
Adjust the display brightness of this unit.
n When setting for zone (MAIN ZONE / ZONE2 /
ZONE3)
Trigger out is activated through linkage to the power of the zone set to
“On”.
n When setting for input source
Activates trigger out when the input source set to “On” is selected.
Bright
(Default):
Normal display brightness.
Dim:
Reduced display brightness.
Dark:
Very low display brightness.
Off:
Turns the display off.
n When setting for HDMI monitor
Activates trigger out when the HDMI monitor set to “On” is selected.
On:
Activate trigger on this mode.
– – –:
Do not activate trigger on this mode.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
You can also adjust the display by pressing DIMMER on the main unit.
o Channel Indicators
Sets whether to use the input signal display or output signal display for
the channel indication on the display.
253
Input:
Uses the input signal display for the channel
indication on the display.
Output
(Default):
Uses the output signal display for the
channel indication on the display.
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
o Video
Information
Show information about this unit settings, input signals, etc.
Show the HDMI input/output signals and HDMI monitor information for
MAIN ZONE.
o Audio
HDMI Signal Info.
Show the audio information for MAIN ZONE.
Resolution / Color Space / Pixel Depth
Sound Mode: The currently set sound mode.
HDMI Monitor 1 / HDMI Monitor 2
Input Signal: The input signal type.
Interface / Resolutions
Format:
The number of input signal channels (presence of
front, surround, LFE).
o ZONE
Sample Rate: The input signal’s sampling frequency.
Offset:
The dialogue normalization correction value.
Flag:
This is displayed when inputting signals including a
surround back channel. “MATRIX” is displayed with
DTS-ES Matrix input signals, “DISCRETE” with DTSES Discrete signals.
Show information about current settings.
MAIN ZONE:
This item shows information about settings for
MAIN ZONE. The information displayed differs
according to the input source.
ZONE2:
This item shows information about settings for
ZONE2.
ZONE3:
This item shows information about settings for
ZONE3.
o Firmware
Version:
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
254
Displays information for the current firmware.
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
o Notifications
To help us improve our products and customer service, Denon collects
anonymous information about how you use your AV receiver (such as
frequently used input sources and sound modes and speaker settings).
Denon will never provide any information we collect to third parties.
Notification Alerts
Notification messages are displayed.
Off:
Notification messages are not displayed.
Yes: Provide information on the operating status of this unit.
No:
Do not provide information on the operating status of this unit.
Press INFO on the remote control unit to display current source name, volume,
sound mode name, and other information at the bottom of the screen.
SOURCE
SOUND
SIGNAL
AUDYSSEY
Blu-ray
Dolby TrueHD
Dolby TrueHD
MultEQ XT32 : Reference
Dynamic EQ : On
Dynamic Volume : Medium
INPUT SIGNAL
FWL
SL
FHL
EXT
FHR
FL
C
LFE
FR
SB
SBR
SBL
ACTIVE SPEAKERS
FWR
SR
FL
SL
SBL
C
SW1
FR
SR
SBR
.
50.0
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
Appendix
Usage Data
Displays and sets notifications.
Also, sets whether or not to display the notification when the power is
turned on.
On
(Default):
Tips
255
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
o Notifications
Firmware
Checks for the latest firmware information about updates and upgrades,
updates the firmware, and sets up the notification message display for
updates and upgrades.
When the latest firmware is available, a notification message is
displayed on the TV screen at power on.
The notification message is displayed for about 40 seconds when the
power is turned on.
o Update
Update
Updates the firmware of this unit.
Check for
Update:
Checks to see if the firmware is the latest version. You
can also check approximately how long it will take to
complete an update.
Update
Start:
Execute the update process. When the update starts,
the menu screen is shut down. During the update, the
progress is shown on the display.
On
(Default):
Display update message.
Off:
Do not display update message.
Upgrade
On
(Default):
Display upgrade message.
Off:
Do not display upgrade message.
This unit automatically retries updating if updating fails. If the update still fails,
either one of the following messages will appear on the screen. If the display
reads as shown below, check the settings and network environment, then update
again.
Display
Description
Updating fail
Updating failed.
Login failed
Failure to log into server.
Server is busy
Server is busy. Wait a while then try again.
Connection fail
Failure in connecting to server.
Download fail
Downloading of the firmware has failed.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
256
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
o Add New Feature
Appendix
Notes concerning use of “Update” and “Add New Feature”
Display new features that can be downloaded to this unit and perform
an upgrade.
Upgrade
Package:
Display the items to be upgraded.
Upgrade
Status:
Display a list of the additional functions provided by
the upgrade.
Upgrade Start:
Execute the upgrade process.
When the upgrade starts, the menu screen is shut
down. During the upgrade, the amount of upgrade
time which has elapsed is displayed.
0 In order to use these functions, you must have the correct system
requirements and settings for an Internet connection. (v p. 72)
0 Do not turn off the power until updating or upgrading is completed.
0 Approximately 1 hour is required for the updating/upgrading procedure
to be completed.
0 Once updating/upgrade starts, normal operations on this unit cannot
be performed until updating/upgrading is completed. Furthermore,
there may be cases where backup data is reset for the parameters,
etc., set on this unit.
0 If the update or upgrade fails, press and hold the X on the main unit for
more than 5 seconds, or remove and re-insert the power cord. “Update
Retry” appears on the display and update restarts from the point at
which update failed. If the error continues despite this, check the
network environment.
0 See the Denon website for details about upgrades.
0 When the procedure is complete, “Registered” is displayed in this menu and
upgrades can be carried out. If the procedure has not been carried out, “Not
Registered” is displayed.
The ID number shown on this screen is needed when carrying out the
procedure.
The ID number can also be displayed by pressing and holding the main unit’s
u and INFO for at least 3 seconds.
0 If the upgrade is not successful, an error message identical to those in
“Firmware” - “Update” will appear on the display. Check the settings and
network environment and then perform the upgrade again.
Front panel
Tips
Display
Rear panel
Information regarding the “Update” function and “Add New Feature” will be
announced on the Denon website each time related plans are defined.
257
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Setup Lock
Protect settings from inadvertent changes.
o Lock
On:
Turn protection on.
Off
(Default):
Turn protection off.
When cancelling the setting, set “Lock” to “Off”.
NOTE
When “Lock” is set to “On”, no setting items are displayed except for “Setup
Lock”.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
258
Remote
Index
Appendix
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Operating external devices with the remote control unit
When preset codes are registered in the included remote control unit, it
can then be used to operate any devices you have, such as DVD players
or TVs made by different manufacturers.
Display
TV AUDIO
CBL/SAT
DVD
Blu-ray
AUX1
GAME
AUX2
MEDIA PLAYER
CD
QUICK
SELECT
1–4
OPTION
ui
ENTER
0–9
RC SETUP
.
MACRO
A–D
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
259
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
n Registering DVD Players
Registering preset codes
1
Press and hold down DVD and OPTION until “OK”
indicator on the remote control display is flashing, then
release.
There are two methods for registering preset codes; the simple method for
registering preset codes of Denon players, and the method for registering
the preset numbers of other manufacturers’ devices.
● “Registering Denon Players”(v p. 260)
● “Registering by entering preset numbers”(v p. 262)
n Registering CD Players
o Registering Denon Players
1
Use the following simple method to register the preset codes of Denon
Blu-ray Disc players, DVD players and CD players.
Press and hold down CD and OPTION until “OK”
indicator on the remote control display is flashing, then
release.
n Registering Blu-ray Disc Players
1
Press and hold down Blu-ray and OPTION until “OK”
indicator on the remote control display is flashing, then
release.
Front panel
Display
Appendix
Rear panel
260
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
n Registering multiple players at the same time
1
Press and hold down QUICK SELECT 1 – 4 and OPTION
until the DEV, TV and AVR indicators on the remote are
flashing green, then release.
Devices to be registered at the
same time
Blu-ray Disc DVD player CD player
player
P
QUICK SELECT 1 and
OPTION
P
P
QUICK SELECT 2 and
OPTION
P
P
QUICK SELECT 3 and
OPTION
P
P
QUICK SELECT 4 and
OPTION
P
P
Press and hold down
the buttons
NOTE
Depending on the model and year of manufacture of your device, some buttons may
not operate. In this case, try “Registering by entering preset numbers” (v p. 262).
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
261
Remote
Index
Appendix
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
o Registering by entering preset numbers
1
The following table shows the device groups that can be registered for
each of the input source select buttons. Check the preset number of
the device you want to register beforehand in the “Remote Control
preset codes” file.
Button
2
Device groups that can be registered
3
CBL/SAT group
VCR/PVR group, BD/DVD group
CBL/SAT group, VCR/PVR group,
BD/DVD group, Audio group
4
CBL/SAT group
VCR/PVR group, BD/DVD group
Tips
Press and hold RC SETUP for more than 3 seconds.
“SETUP” and p indicator flashes twice on the remote control unit.
When “PRSET” appears on the remote control unit,
press ENTER.
When “DEVIC” appears on the remote control unit,
press the input source select button of the AV
equipment (CBL/SAT, Blu-ray, GAME, MEDIA PLAYER,
DVD, AUX1, AUX2 or CD) that you want to program for
the preset setting.
When “– – – – –” appears on the remote control unit,
press the number buttons 0 – 9 to enter a 5-digit code.
Press the buttons with an interval less than 30 seconds.
0 When the code is registered, “OK” flashes four times on the
remote control unit.
0 When the code is not registered correctly, “FAIL” or “CANCL”
flashes four times on the remote control unit. Perform from step 1
again.
CBL/SAT group, VCR/PVR group,
BD/DVD group, Audio group
CBL/SAT group, VCR/PVR group,
BD/DVD group, Audio group
Audio group
TV group
Front panel
Display
Appendix
Rear panel
262
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
0 Some manufacturers use more than one type of preset code. Preset codes to
change the number and verify correct operation.
0 To unregister the device from a button and reset to the default setting, set the AVR
code “73347” to the button.
NOTE
Depending on the model and year of manufacture of your device, some buttons may
not operate.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
263
Remote
Index
Appendix
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
n CBL/SAT group
(Set top box for satellite (SAT)/cable TV (CBL)/
Media player/IP TV) operation
Operating devices
To operate an external device, press the input source button registered
with the preset code, followed by one of the buttons in the following tables.
Operation buttons
0 The input source name is displayed on the remote control unit when an external
device is being operated.
0 The “TV” is displayed on the remote control unit when the TV is being operated.
0 To operate the menu of this unit, press AVR before operating the unit. The “AVR”
is displayed on the remote control unit when this unit is being operated.
Function
DEVICE X
Power on/off
DEVICE MENU
Menu
CH/PAGE df
Switch channels (up/down)
INFO
Information
OPTION
Sub menu, Option
uiop
Cursor operation
ENTER(Cursor)
Enter
BACK
Back
SETUP
Home menu
89
Skip chapter
1
Playback
67
Fast-reverse / Fast-forward
3
Pause
2
Stop
0 – 9, +10
Channel selection
ENTER(Number)
3 digit entry
Depending on the device, the DEVICE X button only performs
the power-on operation.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
264
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
n VCR/PVR group
(Video cassette recorder (VCR)/personal video
recorder (PVR)) operation
n TV group
(TV) operation
Operation buttons
Function
TV X
TV power on/off
TV INPUT
Switch TV input
TV MENU
TV menu
CH/PAGE df
Switch channels (up/down)
INFO
Information
OPTION
Sub menu, Option
uiop
Cursor operation
ENTER(Cursor)
Enter
BACK
Back
SETUP
Setup
Operation buttons
Function
DEVICE X
Power on/off
DEVICE MENU
Menu
CH/PAGE df
Switch channels (up/down)
INFO
Information
OPTION
Sub menu, Option
uiop
Cursor operation
ENTER
Enter
BACK
Back
SETUP
Setup
89
Skip chapter
1
Playback
67
Fast-reverse / Fast-forward
3
Pause
Stop
Select title, chapter or channel
selection
89
Skip chapter
1
Playback
67
Fast-reverse / Fast-forward
3
Pause
2
Stop
2
0 – 9, +10
Channel selection
0 – 9, +10
ENTER(Number)
3 digit entry
0 Depending on the device, the power may not be turned off for the DEVICE X and TV X buttons.
0 TV X and TV INPUT buttons can be operated at any time without pressing the TV button.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
265
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
n BD/DVD group
(Blu-ray Disc player/HD-DVD player/DVD
player/DVD recorder) operation
Operation buttons
Tips
Appendix
n Audio group
(CD player/CD recorder) operation
Function
Operation buttons
Function
DEVICE X
Power on/off
DEVICE X
Power on/off
DEVICE MENU
(Popup) Menu
INFO
Information
CH/PAGE df
Switch channels (up/down)
uiop
Cursor operation
INFO
Information
ENTER
Enter
OPTION
Top menu
89
Skip track
uiop
Cursor operation
1
Playback
ENTER
Enter
67
Fast-reverse / Fast-forward
BACK
Back
3
Pause
SETUP
Setup, Home menu
2
Stop
89
Skip chapter
0 – 9, +10
Track selection
1
Playback
67
Fast-reverse / Fast-forward
3
Pause
2
Stop
0 – 9, +10
Select title, chapter or channel
selection
Depending on the device, the DEVICE X button only performs the power-on operation. (Depending on the device, some Denon models can only be operated with the power
turned on.)
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
266
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Operating learning function
4
If the device does not operate even when the preset code is registered,
use the learning function. Remote codes for different devices can be
remembered for use by the Denon remote control included with this
device.
5
o Remembering remote control codes from
other devices
2
3
Press and hold RC SETUP for more than 3 seconds.
Appendix
When “KEY” appears on the remote control unit, press
the button that you want to store.
When “READY” appears on the remote control unit,
place the remote control unit of the AV equipment face
to face with main remote control unit (of this unit).
Next, press and hold down the desired button (that you
want to store) of the remote control unit of the AV
equipment.
“SETUP” and p indicator flashes twice on the remote control unit.
Use ui to display “LEARN” on the remote control unit
and press ENTER.
When “DEVIC” appears on the remote control unit,
press the input source select button of the AV
equipment that you want to store.
0 You cannot store the remote control code in the AVR button.
0 Before using the learning function, register a preset code for a
mode other than AVR preset to each input source switch button.
(“Registering preset codes” (v p. 260))
.
1
Tips
0 When the button is correctly stored, “OK” flashes four times on
the remote control unit.
0 If the button is not correctly stored, “FAIL” flashes four times on
the remote control unit. If this happens, perform step 4 again.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
267
Remote
Index
Contents
6
7
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
To store another button, repeat steps 4 and 5.
0 There are some remote control units that cannot be programmed, or even if they
can be programmed, they may not operate correctly. If this happens, use the
remote control unit supplied with the AV equipment to operate it.
0 The operations of the programmed buttons override the preset memory. If you do
not require the programmed buttons, erase the stored remote control codes to
return to the initial settings. (v p. 269)
0 The number of buttons that can be stored varies depending on the remote control
unit used. If you have stored the maximum number of buttons allowed for the
remote control unit, “FAIL” appears on its display.
When you have finished storing the remote control
codes, press RC SETUP.
“OK” flashes four times on the remote control unit and the normal
operation mode is restored.
NOTE
You cannot store the remote control code in the ZONE SELECT, RC SETUP,
POWER X, QUICK SELECT 1 – 4, ECO, SOUND MODE, SLEEP, MACRO A – D
and input source select button.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
268
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
o Erasing stored remote control codes
n Erasing the code by each equipment input source
n Erasing the code by each button
1
1
2
3
4
5
6
Press and hold RC SETUP for more than 3 seconds.
2
“SETUP” and p indicator flashes twice on the remote control unit.
Use ui to display “RESET” on the remote control unit
and press ENTER.
3
When “LEARN” appears on the remote control unit,
press ENTER.
4
When “DEVIC” appears on the remote control unit,
press the input source select button of the AV
equipment that you want to erase.
5
Use ui to display “ONE” on the remote control unit
and press ENTER.
Press and hold RC SETUP for more than 3 seconds.
“SETUP” and p indicator flashes twice on the remote control unit.
Use ui to display “RESET” on the remote control unit
and press ENTER.
When “LEARN” appears on the remote control unit,
press ENTER.
When “DEVIC” appears on the remote control unit,
press the input source select button of the AV
equipment that you want to erase.
When “ALL” appears, press ENTER.
“RESET” flashes four times on the remote control unit and the
normal operation mode is restored.
When “KEY” appears on the remote control unit, press
the button that you want to erase.
“RESET” flashes four times on the remote control unit and the
normal operation mode is restored.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
269
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
You can automatically set the macro for your scene.
0 When the macro function is used, operations that usually require a
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
complicated series of multiple button operations can be performed
easily just by pressing the MACRO button.
0 This device can remember up to 4 macro functions.
0 Each macro can record a maximum of 18 steps.
G Example H
When the following set of operations has been registered to the MACRO
button, you can simply press the MACRO button to turn on the TV and this
unit and start playing back Blu-ray Disc player.
Rear panel
Watch movies (MOVIE)
Listen to music (MUSIC)
Watch TV (CBL/SAT) (WATCH)
Turn on all devices (ON)
Turn off all devices (OFF)
NOTE
0 Register preset codes for the remote control unit before setting Auto macro.
(v p. 260)
0 Depending on the type or model of your device, macro may not work properly
even if it is set.
A Turn the TV’s power on.
$
B Turn this unit’s power on.
$
C Switch this unit’s input source to “Blu-ray”.
$
D Turn the Blu-ray Disc player’s power on.
$
E Play the Blu-ray Disc player.
Display
Appendix
o Recording automatic macro operations
Operating macro function
Front panel
Tips
270
Remote
Index
Contents
1
2
3
4
5
Connections
Playback
Settings
Remote control
unit display
Press and hold RC SETUP for more than 3 seconds.
“SETUP” and p indicator flashes twice on the remote control unit.
MOVIE
Tips
Appendix
Auto MACRO
Automatically turns on the devices and starts playback
when you watch movies.
Use ui to display “MACRO” on the remote control unit
and press ENTER.
TV power ON
Blu-ray power ON
AVR Power ON
Source Change “Blu-ray”
Playback Blu-ray Disc
Use ui to display “AUTO” on the remote control unit
and press ENTER.
MUSIC
When “MCNo” appears on the remote control unit,
press the MACRO A – D button that you want to set.
Automatically turns on the devices and starts playback
when you listen to music.
CD power ON
AVR Power ON
Source Change “CD”
Playback CD
Use ui to set the auto macro operation and press
ENTER.
“OK” flashes four times on the remote control unit and the normal
operation mode is restored.
WATCH
Automatically turns on the devices and starts playback
when you watch TV (CBL/SAT).
TV power ON
CBL/SAT Power ON
AVR Power ON
Source Change “CBL/SAT”
ON
Turns on all the devices set for PRESET.
OFF
Turns off all the devices set for PRESET.
All device power on
All device power off
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
271
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
o Recording custom macro operations
1
2
3
4
5
Press and hold RC SETUP for more than 3 seconds.
“SETUP” and p indicator flashes twice on the remote control unit.
6
When “MCNo” appears on the remote control unit,
press the MACRO A – D button that you want to set.
Rear panel
Press the buttons to be stored one by one.
The step number for the storing procedure and mode are alternately
displayed on the remote control unit.
You cannot store the macros for the ZONE SELECT button.
Use ui to display “MAN” on the remote control unit
and press ENTER.
Display
Appendix
NOTE
Use ui to display “MACRO” on the remote control unit
and press ENTER.
Front panel
Tips
272
Press MACRO to exit the macro function.
“OK” flashes four times on the remote control unit and the normal
operation mode is restored.
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
o Adjusting the interval time of macro
operations transmitting
5
6
The macro operation transmission interval can be adjusted.
0 The default setting is “0.50”.
1
2
3
4
“SETUP” and p indicator flashes twice on the remote control unit.
Use ui to display “MACRO” on the remote control unit
and press ENTER.
Press RC SETUP.
Use ui to set the macro operation transmission
interval and press ENTER.
Remote control unit
display
Time values that you can set
0.25
0.25 sec
0.50
0.5 sec
0.75
0.75 sec
Use ui to display “MAN” on the remote control unit
and press ENTER.
When “MCNo” appears on the remote control unit,
press the MACRO A – D button that you want to set.
Display
Rear panel
Appendix
“OK” flashes four times on the remote control unit and the normal
operation mode is restored.
Press and hold RC SETUP for more than 3 seconds.
Front panel
Tips
273
Remote
1.00
1 sec
1.25
1.25 sec
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
o Using the macro function
When the ZONE SELECT button is pressed, only the set zone can be
operated with the remote control unit.
0 The default setting is “M23”.
o Resetting the macro function
2
3
4
Press and hold RC SETUP for more than 3 seconds.
1
“SETUP” and p indicator flashes twice on the remote control unit.
Use ui to display “RESET” on the remote control unit
and press ENTER.
2
Use ui to display “MACRO” on the remote control unit
and press ENTER.
3
When “MCNo” appears on the remote control unit,
press the MACRO A – D button that you want to reset.
Display
Rear panel
Press and hold RC SETUP for more than 3 seconds.
“SETUP” and p indicator flashes twice on the remote control unit.
Use ui to display “ZLOCK” on the remote control unit
and press ENTER.
Use ui to set the zone to be used and press ENTER.
“OK” flashes four times on the remote control unit and the normal
operation mode is restored.
Remote control unit
display
“RESET” flashes four times on the remote control unit and the
normal operation mode is restored.
Front panel
Appendix
Specifying the zone used with the
remote control unit
Press the MACRO A – D button you used to store the
macro function.
1
Tips
M
274
Zone to be used
MAIN ZONE only
M2
MAIN ZONE / ZONE2
M23
MAIN ZONE / ZONE2 / ZONE3
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Setting the Remote ID
2
3
Use the following procedure to set the length of time for which to display
data such as zone and mode on the display panel of the remote control
unit.
0 The default setting is “05SEC”.
Press and hold RC SETUP for more than 3 seconds.
“SETUP” and p indicator flashes twice on the remote control unit.
1
Use ui to display “RC-ID” on the remote control unit
and press ENTER.
2
Use ui to set the remote ID and press ENTER.
“OK” flashes four times on the remote control unit and the normal
operation mode is restored.
Remote control unit display
Remote ID
ID-1
1
ID-2
2
ID-3
3
ID-4
4
3
Press and hold RC SETUP for more than 3 seconds.
“SETUP” and p indicator flashes twice on the remote control unit.
Use ui to display “DISPL” on the remote control unit
and press ENTER.
Use ui to set the display time length and press
ENTER.
“OK” flashes four times on the remote control unit and the normal
operation mode is restored.
Remote control unit display
NOTE
Display
Rear panel
275
Remote
Display time
05SEC
5 sec
10SEC
10 sec
15SEC
15 sec
When you change the remote ID, make sure that the remote control unit and the
remote ID of the main unit are exactly the same. (v p. 252)
Front panel
Appendix
Setting the display time length of the
remote control unit display
When using multiple Denon AV receivers in the same room, make this
setting so that only the desired AV receiver operates.
0 The default setting is “ID-1”.
1
Tips
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Setting the back light
2
3
All the settings are restored to their defaults.
1
Press and hold RC SETUP for more than 3 seconds.
“SETUP” and p indicator flashes twice on the remote control unit.
2
Use ui to display “LIGHT” on the remote control unit
and press ENTER.
3
Use ui to set the back light and press ENTER.
Remote control unit display
Back light
ON
Back light on
OFF
Back light off
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
Appendix
Restoring all settings of the remote
control unit to default
You can set the back light on the remote control unit to off to prolong the
life of the dry cell batteries.
0 The default setting is “ON”.
1
Tips
4
Press and hold RC SETUP for more than 3 seconds.
“SETUP” and p indicator flashes twice on the remote control unit.
Use ui to display “RESET” on the remote control unit
and press ENTER.
Use ui to display “ALL” on the remote control unit
and press ENTER.
Use ui to display “YES” on the remote control unit
and press ENTER.
“RESET” flashes four times on the remote control unit and the
normal operation mode is restored.
276
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
o Contents
Troubleshooting
Tips
Power does not turn on / Power is turned off
281
Operations cannot be performed through the remote control unit
282
Display on this unit shows nothing
282
No sound comes out
283
Desired sound does not come out
284
Sound is interrupted or noise occurs
286
287
I want the volume not to become too loud by mistake
278
I want to keep the volume at the same level when I turn the power on
278
I want to have the subwoofer always output audio
278
I want to make human voices in the movies clearer
278
I want to keep bass and clarity during playback at a lower volume
level
278
No video is shown on the TV
I want to automatically adjust the volume level difference in content
such as TV and movies
The menu screen is not displayed on the TV
289
278
iPod cannot be played back
290
USB memory devices cannot be played back
291
File names on the iPod/USB memory device are not displayed
properly
292
Bluetooth cannot be played back
292
I want to set the optimized listening environment after changing the
configuration/position of the speakers or changing a speaker to a new
one
279
I want to combine a desired video with the current music
279
I want to play back photos from Flickr at the same time while listening
to the Internet radio
279
I want to delete unused input sources
279
I want to enjoy the same music in all zones at the home party, etc.
279
I want to minimize the delay in video signals when I’m playing a game
on my game console
279
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
277
The Internet radio cannot be played back
293
Music files on PC or NAS cannot be played back
294
Various online services cannot be played
294
The HDMI control function does not work
295
When it is not possible to connect to a wireless LAN network
296
When using HDMI ZONE2, the devices does not function properly
297
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Tips
I want the volume not to become too loud by mistake
0 Set the volume upper limit for “Volume Limit” in the menu beforehand. This prevents children or others from increasing the volume too much by mistake.
You can set this for each zone. (v p. 174, 251)
I want to keep the volume at the same level when I turn the power on
0 By default, the volume setting when power was previously set to standby on this unit is applied at next power on with no change. To use a fixed volume
level, set the volume level at power on for “Power On Volume” in the menu. You can set this for each zone. (v p. 174, 251)
I want to have the subwoofer always output audio
0 Depending on the input signals and sound mode, the subwoofer may not output audio. When “Subwoofer Mode” in the menu is set to “LFE+Main”, you
can have the subwoofer always output audio. (v p. 237)
I want to make human voices in the movies clearer
0 Select a setting that makes the dialog easier to hear in the option menu “Dialog Enhancer”. (v p. 125)
I want to keep bass and clarity during playback at a lower volume level
0 Set “Dynamic EQ” in the menu to “On”. This setting corrects the frequency characteristics to allow you to enjoy clear sound without the bass being lost
even during playback at a lower volume level. (v p. 176)
I want to automatically adjust the volume level difference in content such as TV and movies
0 Set “Dynamic Volume” in the menu. Volume level changes (between quiet scenes and loud scenes) in TV shows or movies are automatically adjusted
to your desired level. (v p. 177)
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
278
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
I want to set the optimized listening environment after changing the configuration/position of the speakers or changing a speaker to a new
one.
0 Perform Audyssey® Setup. This automatically makes the optimized speaker settings for the new listening environment. (v p. 200)
I want to combine a desired video with the current music
0 Set “Video Select” in the option menu to “On”. You can combine the current music with your desired video source from a Set-top Box or DVD, etc. while
listening to music from the Tuner, CD, Phono, Internet radio or Bluetooth. (v p. 128)
I want to play back photos from Flickr at the same time while listening to the Internet radio
0 After playing back photos from Flickr, start the slide show on the Internet radio playback screen. (v p. 124)
I want to delete unused input sources
0 Set unused input sources for “Hide Sources” in the menu. This allows you to skip unused input sources when turning the SOURCE SELECT knob on
this unit. (v p. 197)
I want to enjoy the same music in all zones at the home party, etc.
0 Set “All Zone Stereo” in the option menu to “Start”. You can simultaneously play back music in another room (ZONE2, ZONE3) that is played back in
MAIN ZONE. (v p. 130)
I want to minimize the delay in video signals when I’m playing a game on my game console
0 When the video is delayed against button operations with the controller on the game console, set “Video Mode” in the menu to “Game”. (v p. 188)
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
279
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Troubleshooting
If a problem should arise, first check the following:
1. Are the connections correct?
2. Is the set being operated as described in the owner’s manual?
3. Are the other devices operating properly?
If this unit does not operate properly, check the corresponding symptoms in this section.
If the symptoms do not match any of those described here, consult your dealer as it could be due to a fault in this unit. In this case, disconnect the power
immediately and contact the store where you purchased this unit.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
280
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
o Power does not turn on / Power is turned off
Symptom
Cause / Solution
Page
Power does not turn on.
0 Check whether the power plug is correctly inserted into the power outlet.
76
Power automatically turns
off.
0 The sleep timer is set. Turn on the power again.
147
0 “Auto Standby” is set. “Auto Standby” is triggered when there is no operation for a set amount of time. To
249
Power turns off and the
power indicator flashes in
red approx. every 2
seconds.
0 The protection circuit has been activated due to a rise in temperature within this unit. Turn the power off,
327
0 Please re-install this unit in a place having good ventilation.
-
Power turns off and the
power indicator flashes in
red approx. every 0.5
seconds.
0 Check the speaker connections. The protection circuit may have been activated because speaker cable
36
0 Turn down the volume and turn on the power again.
78
0 This unit’s amplifier circuit has failed. Unplug the power cord and contact our customer service center.
-
The power to this unit does 0 Power in either ZONE2 or ZONE3 is on. To turn off the power of the device (standby), press either the
not turn off when you press
ZONE2 ON/OFF or ZONE3 ON/OFF button on the main unit, or press the POWER X button after
the Power operation
pressing the Z2 or Z3 button on the remote control to turn off the power of ZONE2 or ZONE3.
button. “ZONE2 On” or
“ZONE3 On” appears on
the display.
-
disable “Auto Standby”, set “Auto Standby” on the menu to “Off”.
Front panel
wait about an hour until this unit cools down sufficiently, and then turn the power on again.
core wires came in contact with each other or a core wire was disconnected from the connector and
came in contact with the rear panel of this unit. After unplugging the power cord, take corrective action
such as firmly re-twisting the core wire or taking care of the connector, and then reconnect the wire.
Display
Rear panel
281
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
o Operations cannot be performed through the remote control unit
Symptom
Operations cannot be
performed through the
remote control unit.
Cause / Solution
Page
0 Batteries are worn out. Replace with new batteries.
9
0 Operate the remote control unit within a distance of about 7 m from this unit and at an angle of within 30°.
9
0 Remove any obstacle between this unit and the remote control unit.
-
0 Insert the batteries in the proper direction, checking the q and w marks.
9
0 The set’s remote control sensor is exposed to strong light (direct sunlight, inverter type fluorescent bulb
-
0 The operation target zone does not correspond to the zone setting specified on the remote control unit.
164
0 The remote control unit operating mode is used to operate other devices. Press AVR to set the operating
264
light, etc.). Move the set to a place in which the remote control sensor will not be exposed to strong light.
Press ZONE SELECT to select the zone to operate.
mode to AVR.
0 When using a 3D video device, the remote control unit of this unit may not function due to effects of
infrared communications between units (such as TV and glasses for 3D viewing). In this case, adjust the
direction of units with the 3D communications function and their distance to ensure they do not affect
operations from the remote control unit of this unit.
-
o Display on this unit shows nothing
Symptom
Display is off.
Front panel
Cause / Solution
Page
0 Set “Dimmer” on the menu to something other than “Off”.
253
0 When the sound mode is set to “Pure Direct”, the display is off.
133
Display
Rear panel
282
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
o No sound comes out
Symptom
No sound comes out of
speakers.
Cause / Solution
Page
0 Check the connections for all devices.
36
0 Insert connection cables all the way in.
-
0 Check that input connectors and output connectors are not reversely connected.
-
0 Check cables for damage.
-
0 Check that speaker cables are properly connected. Check that cable core wires come in contact with the
36
0 Securely tighten the speaker terminals. Check speaker terminals for looseness.
36
0 Check that a proper input source is selected.
78
0 Adjust the volume.
79
metal part on speaker terminals.
0 Cancel the mute mode.
79
0 Check the digital audio input connector setting.
195
0 Check the digital audio output setting on the connected device. On some devices, the digital audio output
-
0 When a headphone is plugged into the PHONES jack on the main unit, sound is not output from the
18
No sound comes out when
using the DVI-D
connection.
0 When this unit is connected to a device equipped with a DVI-D connector, no sound is output. Make a
-
No sound comes out of a
TV that is connected via
HDMI.
0 Audio signals input to 7.1CH IN connectors on this unit cannot be output to the TV.
-
is set to off by default.
speaker terminal and PRE OUT connector.
Front panel
separate audio connection.
Display
Rear panel
283
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
o Desired sound does not come out
Symptom
The volume does not
increase.
Cause / Solution
Page
0 The maximum volume is set too low. Set the maximum volume using “Limit” on the menu.
0 Appropriate volume correction processing is performed according to the input audio format and settings,
so the volume may not reach the upper limit.
No sound comes out with
the HDMI connection.
0 Check the connection of the HDMI connectors.
57
184
0 When using the HDMI control function, check that the audio output is set to the AV amplifier on the TV.
146
0 Check that speaker cables are properly connected.
36
0 Check that a selection other than “None” is set for the “Speaker Config.” setting in menu.
230
0 Check the “Assign Mode” setting in the menu.
211
0 When the sound mode is “Stereo” and “Virtual”, audio is only output from the front speakers and subwoofer.
No sound is produced from 0 Check the subwoofer connections.
subwoofer.
0 Turn on the subwoofer’s power.
-
0 Set “Speaker Config.” - “Subwoofer” in the menu to “1 spkr” or “2 spkrs”.
231
0 When “Speaker Config.” - “Front” in the menu is set to “Large”, depending on the input signal and the
230
0 When no subwoofer audio signal (LFE) is included in the input signals, no sound may be output from the
237
0 You can make the subwoofer always output sound by setting the “Subwoofer Mode” to “LFE+Main”.
237
subwoofer.
0 Check that the digital audio output setting on the connected device is set to “DTS”.
-
0 Set “Decode Mode” on the menu to “Auto” or “DTS”.
Dolby Atmos, Dolby
TrueHD, DTS-HD, Dolby
Digital Plus audio is not
output.
Front panel
-
37
sound mode, no sound may be output from the subwoofer.
DTS sound is not output.
-
0 When outputting HDMI audio from the speakers, set “HDMI Audio Out” on the menu to “AVR”. To output
from the TV, set “TV”.
No sound comes out of a
specific speaker.
174
199
0 Make HDMI connections.
61
0 Check the digital audio output setting on the connected device. On some devices, “PCM” is set by
-
default.
Display
Rear panel
284
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Symptom
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Cause / Solution
Page
DTS Neo:X mode cannot
be selected.
0 It cannot be selected when “Speaker Config.” - “Surround” is set for “None”.
0 DTS Neo:X cannot be selected when using the headphones.
230
-
Dolby Surround mode
cannot be selected.
0 Dolby Surround cannot be selected when using the headphones.
-
Audyssey MultEQ® XT32, 0 These cannot be selected when you have not performed Audyssey® Setup.
Audyssey Dynamic EQ®,
0 Switch to a sound mode other than “Direct” or “Pure Direct”.
Audyssey Dynamic
0 These cannot be selected when using the headphones.
®
Volume and Audyssey
LFC™ cannot be selected.
200
Audyssey DSX® cannot be 0 It can be selected when using the front height or front wide speakers.
selected.
0 It can be selected when using the center speaker.
232
133
-
230
0 Switch the sound mode to Dolby sound mode or DTS sound mode.
132
0 This cannot be selected when using the headphones.
-
0 This cannot be set when the input signal is a 2-channel source.
-
“Restorer” cannot be
selected.
0 Check that an analog signal or PCM signal (Sample Rate = 44.1/48 kHz) is input. For playback of
173
0 Switch to a sound mode other than “Direct” or “Pure Direct”.
133
No audio is output from
PRE OUT or speakers for
ZONE2/ZONE3.
0 In ZONE2/ZONE3, the audio can be played back when signals input from digital connectors (OPTICAL/
multichannel signals such as Dolby Digital or DTS surround, “Restorer” cannot be used.
COAXIAL) are in 2ch PCM format.
0 In ZONE2, the audio can be played back when signals input from the HDMI connector are in 2ch PCM
format. To play back the audio in ZONE2 irrespective of the input signal format, set “HDMI Audio” in the
menu to “PCM”. Depending on the played back device, the audio may not be played back even with this
setting. In that case, set the audio format to “PCM (2ch)” on the played back device.
0 When listening to audio from a Bluetooth device in ZONE2/ZONE3, remove any obstructions between the
Bluetooth device and this unit and use it within a range of about 10 m.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
285
Remote
Index
-
250
-
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
o Sound is interrupted or noise occurs
Symptom
During playback from the
Internet radio or USB
memory device, sound is
occasionally interrupted.
Cause / Solution
Page
0 When the transfer speed of the USB memory device is slow, sound may occasionally be interrupted.
-
0 The network communication speed is slow or the radio station is busy.
-
When making a call on
iPhone, noise occurs in
audio output on this unit.
0 When making a call, keep a distance of 20 cm or longer between iPhone and this unit.
-
Noise often occurs in
FM/AM broadcasting.
0 Change the antenna orientation or position.
70
The sounds appear to be
distorted.
0 Separate the AM loop antenna from the unit.
-
0 Use an FM outdoor antenna.
70
0 Separate the antenna from other connection cables.
70
0 Lower the volume.
79
0 Set “Off” to the ECO Mode. When “On” or “Auto” is in the ECO Mode, the audio may by distorted when
the playback volume is high.
Sound cuts out when using 0 If nearby devices cause playback to cut out due to electronic interference, switch to a wired LAN
Wi-Fi connection.
connection.
0 Particularly when you play back large music files, depending on your wireless LAN environment, the
playback sound may be interrupted. In this case, make the wired LAN connection.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
286
Remote
Index
248
72
242
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
o No video is shown on the TV
Symptom
No picture appears.
Cause / Solution
Page
0 Check the connections for all devices.
57
0 Insert connection cables all the way in.
-
0 Check that input connectors and output connectors are not reversely connected.
-
0 Check cables for damage.
-
195
0 Match the input settings to the input connector of the TV connected to this unit.
78
0 Check that the proper input source is selected.
0 Check the video input connector setting.
195
0 Check that the resolution of the player corresponds to that of the TV.
254
0 Check whether the TV is compatible with copyright protection (HDCP). If connected to a device not
301
compatible with HDCP, video will not be output correctly.
0 The HDMI signal cannot be converted to an analog signal. Use analog connections.
0 Use an “High Speed HDMI cable with Ethernet” or “High speed cable” that comes with the HDMI logo if
302
-
you wish to playback 4K (60/50 Hz) video.
No video is shown on the
TV with the DVI-D
connection.
0 With the DVI-D connection, on some device combinations, devices may not function properly due to the
No video from an input
source such as a game
console is shown on the
TV.
0 When special video signals are input from a game console, etc., the video conversion function may not
Front panel
301
copy guard copyright protection (HDCP).
function. Connect the input connector to the monitor output connector of the same type.
Display
Rear panel
287
Remote
Index
-
Contents
Connections
Playback
Symptom
While the menu is being
displayed, no video is
shown on the TV.
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Cause / Solution
Page
0 The video being played will not appear in the background of the menu when the menu is operated during
-
playback of the following video signals.
- Some images of 3D video contents
- Computer resolution images (example: VGA)
- Video with an aspect ratio other than 16:9 or 4:3
- 4K video
When using HDMI ZONE2, 0 When ZONE2 is operated with the same input source selected for MAIN ZONE and ZONE2, video in
the video output in MAIN
MAIN ZONE may be interrupted.
ZONE is interrupted.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
288
Remote
Index
-
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
o The menu screen is not displayed on the TV
Symptom
The menu screen or status
information screen is not
displayed on the TV.
Cause / Solution
Page
0 The menu screen is only displayed on this unit and a TV connected with an HDMI cable. If this unit is
connected to a TV using a different video output connector, operate while watching the display on this
unit.
0 The status information will not appear on the TV when the following video signals are being played.
132
0 When a 2D video is converted to a 3D video on the TV, the menu screen or status information screen is
132
0 In the pure direct playback mode, the menu screen or status information is not displayed. Switch to a
132
0 Set the “TV Format” setting in the menu to a selection that is appropriate for the TV.
194
- Some images of 3D video content
- Computer resolution images (example: VGA)
- Video with an aspect ratio other than 16:9 or 4:3
not displayed properly.
sound mode other than the pure direct mode.
Front panel
-
Display
Rear panel
289
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
o iPod cannot be played back
Symptom
Cause / Solution
Page
iPod cannot be connected. 0 When using iPod by connecting it to the USB port, some iPod variations are not supported.
0 When iPod is connected by using a USB cable other than the genuine cable, iPod may not be
-
0 This unit and PC / iPhone / iPod touch / iPad are not connected to the same network (LAN). Connect it to
72
0 The firmware on iTunes / iPhone / iPod touch / iPad is not compatible with AirPlay. Update the firmware to
-
0 The volume on iTunes / iPhone / iPod touch / iPad is set to the minimum level. The volume on iTunes /
-
recognized. Use a genuine USB cable.
The AirPlay icon ' is not
displayed on iTunes /
iPhone / iPod touch / iPad.
the same LAN as this unit.
the latest version.
Audio is not output.
iPhone / iPod touch / iPad is linked with the volume on this unit. Set a proper volume level.
0 The AirPlay playback is not performed, or this unit is not selected. Click the AirPlay icon ' on the
117
0 Quit the application running in the background of the iPhone/iPod touch/iPad, and then play using
-
0 Some external factors may be affecting the wireless connection. Modify the network environment by
-
0 Enable the “Allow iTunes audio control from remote speakers” setting on iTunes. Then, you can perform
-
iTunes / iPhone / iPod touch / iPad screen and select this unit.
Audio is interrupted during
the AirPlay playback on
iPhone / iPod touch / iPad.
AirPlay.
taking measures such as shortening the distance from the wireless LAN access point.
iTunes cannot be played
back through the remote
control unit.
Front panel
67
playback, pause, and skip operations through the remote control unit.
Display
Rear panel
290
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
o USB memory devices cannot be played back
Symptom
“No connection” is
displayed.
Cause / Solution
Page
0 This unit cannot recognize the USB memory device. Disconnect and reconnect the USB memory device.
67
0 Mass storage class compatible USB memory devices are supported.
-
0 This unit does not support a connection through a USB hub. Connect the USB memory device directly to
-
0 The USB memory device must be formatted to FAT16 or FAT32.
-
0 Not all USB memory devices are guaranteed to work. Some USB memory devices are not recognized.
-
0 Files of a type not supported by this unit are not displayed.
85
0 This unit is able to display files in a maximum of eight folder layers. A maximum of 5000 files (folders) can
-
the USB port.
When using a type of portable hard disc drive compatible with the USB connection that requires power
from an AC adapter, use the AC adapter that came with the drive.
Files on the USB memory
device are not displayed.
also be displayed for each layer. Modify the folder structure of the USB memory device.
Files on a USB memory
device cannot be played.
0 When multiple partitions exist on the USB memory device, only files on the first partition are displayed.
-
0 Files are created in a format that is not supported by this unit. Check the formats supported by this unit.
304
0 You are attempting to play a file that is copyright protected. Files that are copyright protected cannot be
-
0 Playback may not be possible if the album art file size exceeds 2 MB.
-
played on this unit.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
291
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
o File names on the iPod/USB memory device are not displayed properly
Symptom
The file names are not
displayed properly (“...”,
etc.).
Cause / Solution
Page
0 Characters that cannot be displayed have been used. On this unit, characters that cannot be displayed
are replaced with a “. (period)”.
-
o Bluetooth cannot be played back
Symptom
Bluetooth devices cannot
be connected to this unit.
The sound is cut off.
Cause / Solution
Page
0 The Bluetooth function in the Bluetooth device has not been enabled. See the Owner’s Manual of the
-
0 Bring the Bluetooth device near to this unit.
-
Bluetooth device to enable the Bluetooth function.
0 The Bluetooth device cannot connect with this unit if it is not compatible with the A2DP profile.
-
0 Turn the power of the Bluetooth device off and on again, and then try again.
-
0 Bring the Bluetooth device near to this unit.
-
0 Remove obstructions between the Bluetooth device and this unit.
-
0 To prevent electromagnetic interference, locate this unit away from microwave ovens, wireless LAN
-
0 Reconnect the Bluetooth device.
-
devices and other Bluetooth devices.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
292
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
o The Internet radio cannot be played back
Symptom
Cause / Solution
Page
A list of broadcasting
stations is not displayed.
0 The LAN cable is not properly connected, or the network is disconnected. Check the connection status.
Internet Radio cannot be
played.
0 The selected radio station is broadcasting in a format that is not supported by this unit. Formats that can
0 Perform the network diagnostic mode.
72
-
be played back in this unit are MP3, WMA and AAC.
0 The firewall function is enabled on the router. Check the firewall setting.
307
-
0 The IP address is not properly set.
244
0 Check the power of the router is on.
-
0 To obtain the IP address automatically, enable the DHCP server function on the router. Also, set the
244
0 To obtain the IP address manually, set the IP address and proxy on this unit.
244
0 Some radio stations broadcast silently during some time period. In this case, no audio is output. Wait for a
105
DHCP setting to “On” on this unit.
while and select the same radio station, or select another radio station.
Cannot connect to favorite
radio stations.
0 Radio station is not currently in service. Register radio stations in service.
-
For some radio stations,
“Connection down” is
displayed and station
cannot be connected to.
0 The selected radio station is not in service. Select a radio station in service.
-
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
293
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
o Music files on PC or NAS cannot be played back
Symptom
Files stored on a computer
cannot be played.
Cause / Solution
Page
0 Files are stored in a non-compatible format. Record in a compatible format.
306
0 Files that are copyright protected cannot be played on this unit.
-
0 The set’s USB port cannot be used for connection to a computer.
-
0 Media sharing settings are not correct. Change media sharing settings so that the unit can access the
folders on your computer.
Server is not found, or it is
not possible to connect to
the server.
0 The computer’s or router’s firewall is activated. Check the computer’s or router’s firewall settings.
-
0 Computer’s power is not turned on. Turn on the power.
-
0 Server is not running. Launch the server.
-
0 Set’s IP address is wrong. Check the set’s IP address.
Music files on PC cannot
be played back.
241
0 Even if PC is connected to the USB port on this unit, music files on it cannot be played back. Connect PC
to this unit through the network.
Files on PC or NAS are not 0 Files of a type not supported by this unit are not displayed.
displayed.
Music stored on a NAS
cannot be played.
109
72
306
0 If you use a NAS in conformity with the DLNA standard, enable the DLNA server function in the NAS
setting.
0 If you use a NAS that does not conform with the DLNA standard, play the music via a PC. Set Windows
Media Player’s media sharing function and add NAS to the selected play folder.
0 If connection is restricted, set audio equipment as the connection target.
-
109
-
o Various online services cannot be played
Symptom
Various online services
cannot be played.
Front panel
Cause / Solution
Page
0 The online service may have been discontinued.
Display
Rear panel
294
-
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
o The HDMI control function does not work
Symptom
The HDMI control function
does not work.
Cause / Solution
Page
0 Check that “HDMI Control” in the menu is set to “On”.
186
0 You cannot operate devices that are not compatible with the HDMI control function. In addition,
146
0 Check that the HDMI control function setting is enabled on all devices connected to this unit.
146
0 When you make connection related changes such as connecting an additional HDMI device, the link
146
depending on the connected device or the settings, the HDMI control function may not work. In this case,
operate the external device directly.
operation settings may be initialized. Turn off this unit and devices connected via HDMI, and turn them on
again.
0 The HDMI MONITOR 2 connector is not compatible with the HDMI control function. Use the HDMI
MONITOR 1 connector to connect to the TV.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
295
Remote
Index
57
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
o Cannot connect to a wireless LAN network
Symptom
Cannot connect to the
network.
Cause / Solution
Page
0 The network name (SSID), password and encryption setting have not been set up correctly. Configure the
243
0 Shorten the distance from the wireless LAN access point and remove any obstructions to improve access
-
network settings according to the setting details of this unit.
first before re-connecting again. Place the unit away from microwave ovens and other network access
points.
Cannot connect to WPS.
0 Configure the access point channel settings away from channels that are being used by other networks.
-
0 This unit is not compatible with WEP (TSN).
-
0 Check that the WPS mode of the router is operating.
-
0 Press the WPS button on the router and then press the “Connect” button displayed on the TV within 2
-
0 A router/settings that are compatible with WPS 2.0 standards are required. Set the encryption time to
243
minutes.
“None”, “WPA-PSK (AES)” or WPA2-PSK (AES).
0 If the router encryption method is WEP/WPA-TKIP/WPA2-TKIP, you cannot connect by using the WPS
button. In this case, use the “Scan Networks” or “Manual” method to connect.
Cannot connect to the
network using iPhone/iPod
touch/iPad.
Front panel
-
0 Update the iPhone/iPod touch/iPad firmware to the latest version.
-
0 When using a USB cable to configure the settings, the iOS device firmware version needs to support iOS
-
5 or later. When configuring the settings via a wireless connection, iOS 7 or later needs to be supported.
Display
Rear panel
296
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
o When using HDMI ZONE2, the devices does not function properly
Symptom
When using MAIN ZONE,
video output is interrupted
in HDMI ZONE2.
Cause / Solution
Page
0 With the same input source selected for MAIN ZONE and ZONE2, when you operate MAIN ZONE, video
-
may be interrupted in HDMI ZONE2.
When using HDMI ZONE2, 0 Check that the power is on for ZONE2.
no video or audio is output 0 Check the input source for ZONE2.
from the TV in ZONE2.
0 The AUX1-HDMI connector on the front panel does not support the HDMI ZONE2 function.
0 In ZONE2, playback is only possible when the input signals are HDMI signals.
on the playback device. Alternatively, set “ZONE2 Setup” - “HDMI Audio” in the menu to “PCM”.
0 When the TV is not compatible with the resolution of the input video, no video is output. Set the output
resolution on the playback device to a resolution that is compatible with the TV.
When using HDMI ZONE2, 0 When the same input source is selected for MAIN ZONE and ZONE2, the audio format is limited
MAIN ZONE audio is
according to the specifications of the TV in ZONE2.
played back as PCM.
Display
Rear panel
297
Remote
159
-
-
0 When the TV does not support the input audio format, audio is not output. Set the audio format to “PCM”
Front panel
159
Index
250
-
-
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Resetting factory settings
Perform this procedure if the display is abnormal or if operations cannot be performed.
Various settings are reset to the factory default values. Make settings again.
X
1
2
INFO
3
Turn off the power using X.
Press X while simultaneously pressing INFO and
BACK.
Remove your fingers from the two buttons when
“Initialized” appears on the display.
Before restoring the default setting, the “Save” function of the web control function
can be used to store the various settings of the unit. (v p. 153)
However, account information for network content and information on registered
favorites cannot be stored.
.
BACK
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
298
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
About HDMI
HDMI is an abbreviation of High-Definition Multimedia Interface, which is
an AV digital interface that can be connected to a TV or amplifier.
With the HDMI connection, high definition video and high quality audio
formats adopted by Blu-ray Disc players (Dolby Digital Plus, Dolby
TrueHD, DTS-HD, DTS-HD Master Audio) can be transmitted, which is not
possible with the analog video transmission.
Furthermore, in the HDMI connection, audio and video signals can be
transmitted through a single HDMI cable, while in conventional
connections it is necessary to provide audio and video cables separately
for connection between devices. This allows you to simplify the wiring
configuration that tends to be quite complex in a home theater system.
This unit supports the following HDMI functions.
0 3D
This unit supports input and output of 3D (3 dimensional) video signals
of HDMI. To play back 3D video, you need a TV and player that
provide support for the HDMI 3D function and a pair of 3D glasses.
0 4K
This unit supports input and output of 4K (3840 x 2160 pixels) video
signals of HDMI.
0 Content Type
It automatically makes settings suitable for the video output type
(content information).
0 Adobe RGB color, Adobe YCC601 color
0 Deep Color
The color space defined by Adobe Systems Inc. Because it is a wider
color space than RGB, it can produce more vivid and natural images.
An imaging technology supported by HDMI. Unlike RGB or YCbCr,
which uses 8 bits (256 shades) per color, it can use 10 bits (1024
shades), 12 bits (4096 shades), or 16 bits (65536 shades) to produce
colors in higher definition.
Both devices linked via HDMI must support Deep Color.
0 sYCC601 color
Each of these color spaces defines a palette of available colors that is
larger than the traditional RGB color model.
0 “x.v.Color”
This function lets HDTVs display colors more accurately. It enables
display with natural, vivid colors.
“x.v.Color” is trademark of Sony Corporation.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
299
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
0 Auto Lip Sync
0 ARC (Audio Return Channel)
This function can automatically correct delay between the audio and
video.
Use a TV that is compatible with the Auto Lip Sync function.
Even when the power to this unit is set to standby, signals input from
the HDMI input connector are output to a TV or other device that is
connected to the HDMI output connector.
0 HDMI Control
If you connect the unit and an HDMI control function compatible TV or
player with an HDMI cable and then enable the HDMI control function
setting on each device, the devices will be able to control each other.
0 Power off link
This unit power off can be linked to the TV power off step.
0 Audio output destination switching
From the TV, you can switch whether to output audio from the TV or
the AV amplifier.
0 Volume adjustment
You can adjust this unit’s volume in the TV volume adjustment
operation.
0 Input source switching
You can switch this unit input sources through linkage to TV input
switching.
When playing the player, this unit input source switches to the
source for that player.
Display
Rear panel
Appendix
This function transmits audio signals from the TV to this unit through
the HDMI cable and plays back the audio from the TV on this unit
based on the HDMI control function.
If a TV without the ARC function is connected via HDMI connections,
video signals of the playback device connected to this unit are
transmitted to the TV, but this unit can not play back the audio from the
TV. If you want to enjoy surround audio for TV program, a separate
audio cable connection is required.
In contrast, if a TV with the ARC function is connected via HDMI
connections, no audio cable connection is required. Audio signals from
the TV can be input to this unit through the HDMI cable between this
unit and the TV. This function allows you to enjoy surround playback
on this unit for the TV.
0 HDMI Pass Through
Front panel
Tips
300
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
o Supported audio formats
Tips
Appendix
Copyright protection system
2-channel Linear
PCM
2-channel, 32 kHz – 192 kHz, 16/20/24 bit
Multi-channel
Linear PCM
7.1-channel, 32 kHz – 192 kHz, 16/20/24 bit
Bitstream
Dolby Digital / DTS / Dolby Atmos / Dolby TrueHD /
Dolby Digital Plus / DTS-HD Master Audio / DTS-HD
High Resolution Audio / DTS Express
DSD
2-channel – 5.1-channel, 2.8224 MHz
In order to play back digital video and audio such as BD video or DVD
video via HDMI connection, both this unit and the TV or player must to
support the copyright protection system known as HDCP (Highbandwidth Digital Content Protection System). HDCP is copyright
protection technology comprised of data encryption and authentication of
the connected AV devices. This unit supports HDCP.
0 If a device that does not support HDCP is connected, video and audio
are not output correctly. Read the owner’s manual of your television or
player for more information.
o Supported video signals
When connecting this unit to a device that is compatible with the Deep Color, 4K and
ARC functions, use a “High Speed HDMI cable with Ethernet” that bears the HDMI
logo.
0 480i
0 480p
0 576i
0 576p
0 720p 60/50Hz
0 1080i 60/50Hz
0 1080p 60/50/24Hz
0 4K 60/50/30/25/24 Hz
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
301
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Video conversion function
This unit automatically converts the input video signals as shown in the diagram before outputting them to the TV.
This unit
HDMI-compatible TV
Video device
Input (IN)
Output
Output
(MONITOR OUT)
HDMI signal
HDMI signal
HDMI connector
HDMI connector
HDMI connector
HDMI connector
HDMI-incompatible TV
Component video
signal
Component video
signal
Component video
connectors
Video connector
Front panel
Video signal
Component video
connectors
Video connector
Display
Component video
connectors
Video signal
Component video
connectors
Video connector
Rear panel
302
The main zone video conversion
function is compatible with the following
formats: NTSC, PAL, SECAM,
NTSC4.43, PAL-N, PAL-M and PAL-60.
Video connector
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
This unit can convert the input video signals to the resolution that is set for “Resolution” in the menu before outputting them to the TV. (v p. 190)
Input signal
HDMI
Component Video
Video
Output signal
480i/576i
480p/576p
720p
1080i
480i/576i
480p/576p
720p
1080i
1080p 24Hz
1080p
4K 30/25/24Hz
4K 60/50Hz
P
P
P
P
P
P
P
P
P
P
P
480i/576i
480p/576p
720p
1080i
1080p
480i/576i
P
P
P
P
P
P
P
P
P
P
P
P
P
P
P
Rear panel
303
HDMI
1080p
1080p 24Hz
P
P
P
P
P
P
4K 30/25/24Hz
4K 60/50Hz
P
P
P
P
P
P
P
P
P
P
P
P
P
P
P
P
P
P
P
Pz
P
P
P
P
P
P
P
P
P
P
P
P
P
P
P
P
P
P
z The HDMI connector on the front panel is not compatible.
Front panel
Display
Remote
Index
P
P
P
P
P
P
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Playing back a USB memory devices
0 This unit is compatible with MP3 ID3-Tag (Ver. 2) standard.
0 This unit can show the artwork that was embedded by using MP3 ID3-Tag Ver. 2.3 or 2.4.
0 This unit is compatible with WMA META tags.
0 If the image size (pixels) of an album artwork exceeds 500 × 500 (WMA/MP3/WAV/FLAC) or 349 × 349 (MPEG-4 AAC), then music may not be played
back properly.
o Compatible formats
Sampling frequency
WMAz1
32/44.1/48 kHz
MP3
32/44.1/ 48 kHz
WAV
32/44.1/48/88.2/
96/176.4/192 kHz
Bit rate
48 – 192
kbps
32 – 320
kbps
Extension
.mp3
–
.wav
32/44.1/48 kHz
16 – 320
kbps
32/44.1/48/88.2/
96/176.4/192 kHz
32/44.1/48/88.2/
96 kHz
.aac/
.m4a/
.mp4
–
.flac
–
.m4a
DSD
2.8 MHz
–
AIFF
32/44.1/48/88.2/
96/176.4/192 kHz
–
.dsf/
.dff
.aif/
.aiff
MPEG-4 AACz1
FLAC
ALACz2
Front panel
Display
z1 Only files that are not protected by copyright can be played on this unit.
Content downloaded from pay sites on the Internet are copyright protected.
Also, files encoded in WMA format when ripped from a CD, etc. on a computer
may be copyright protected, depending on the computer’s settings.
.wma
Rear panel
z2 Copyright [2012] [D&M Holdings. Inc.]
Licensed under the Apache License, Version 2.0 (the “License”); you may not
use this file except in compliance with the License. You may obtain a copy of
the License at
http://www.apache.org/licenses/LICENSE-2.0
In ZONE2, it is not possible to play the DSD signal.
304
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
o Maximum number of playable files and folder
Item
Memory capacity
USB memory device
8 levels
Number of folders
500
filesz2
5000
Number of
This unit supports the following Bluetooth profile.
0 A2DP (Advanced Audio Distribution Profile):
When a Bluetooth device that supports this standard is connected,
monaural and stereo sound data can be streamed at a high quality.
0 AVRCP (Audio/Video Remote Control Profile):
When a Bluetooth device that supports this standard is connected, the
Bluetooth device can be operated from this unit.
FAT16 : 2 GB, FAT32 : 2 TB
Number of folder directory levels z1
o About Bluetooth communications
z1 The limited number includes the root folder.
z2 The allowable number of files may differ according to the USB memory device
capacity and the file size.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
Appendix
Playing back a Bluetooth device
The limits on the number of folders and files that can be displayed by
this unit are as follows.
Media
Tips
Radio waves broadcast from this unit may interfere with the operation
of medical devices. Make sure you turn off the power of this unit and
Bluetooth device in the following locations as radio wave interference
may cause malfunctions.
0 Hospitals, trains, aircraft, petrol kiosks and places where flammable
gases are generated
0 Near automatic doors and fire alarms
305
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Playing back a file saved on a PC or NAS
0 This unit is compatible with MP3 ID3-Tag (Ver. 2) standard.
0 This unit can show the artwork that was embedded by using MP3 ID3-Tag Ver. 2.3 or 2.4.
0 This unit is compatible with WMA META tags.
0 If the image size (pixels) of an album artwork exceeds 500 × 500 (WMA/MP3/WAV/FLAC) or 349 × 349 (MPEG-4 AAC), then music may not be played
back properly.
0 A server or server software compatible with distribution in the corresponding formats is required to play music files via a network.
o Specifications of supported files
Sampling frequency
Bit rate
48 – 192
kbps
32 – 320
kbps
Extension
–
.wav
32/44.1/48 kHz
16 – 320
kbps
32/44.1/48/88.2/
96/176.4/192 kHz
32/44.1/48/88.2/
96 kHz
.aac/
.m4a/
.mp4
–
.flac
–
.m4a
DSD
2.8 MHz
–
AIFF
32/44.1/48/88.2/
96/176.4/192 kHz
–
.dsf/
.dff
.aif/
.aiff
WMAz1
32/44.1/48 kHz
MP3
32/44.1/ 48 kHz
WAV
32/44.1/48/88.2/
96/176.4/192 kHz
MPEG-4 AACz1
FLAC
ALACz2
Front panel
Display
z1 Only files that are not protected by copyright can be played on this unit.
Content downloaded from pay sites on the Internet are copyright protected.
Also, files encoded in WMA format when ripped from a CD, etc. on a computer
may be copyright protected, depending on the computer’s settings.
.wma
.mp3
Rear panel
z2 Copyright [2012] [D&M Holdings. Inc.]
Licensed under the Apache License, Version 2.0 (the “License”); you may not
use this file except in compliance with the License. You may obtain a copy of
the License at
http://www.apache.org/licenses/LICENSE-2.0
In ZONE2, it is not possible to play the DSD signal.
306
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Playing back Internet Radio
Personal memory plus function
o Playable broadcast station specifications
The most recently used settings (input mode, HDMI output mode, sound
mode, tone control, channel level, MultEQ® XT32, Dynamic EQ, Dynamic
Volume, Restorer and audio delay, etc.) are saved for each input source.
WMA
Sampling frequency
32/44.1/48 kHz
MP3
32/44.1/ 48 kHz
Bit rate
48 – 192
kbps
32 – 320
kbps
MPEG-4 AAC
32/44.1/48 kHz
16 – 320
kbps
Front panel
Display
Extension
.wma
“Surround Parameter” settings are stored for each sound mode.
.mp3
Last function memory
.aac/
.m4a/
.mp4
Rear panel
This function stores the settings which were made before going into the
standby mode.
307
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Sound modes and channel output
S This indicates the audio output channels or surround parameters that can be set.
D This indicates the audio output channels. The output channels depend on the settings of “Speaker Config.” (v p. 230).
Channel output
Sound mode
Front L/R
Direct/Pure Direct (2-channel)
S
Direct/Pure Direct (Multi-channel)
S
DSD Direct (2-channel)
S
DSD Direct (Multi-channel)
S
Stereo
S
Multi Ch In
Dolby Surround z1
Center
Surround
L/R
Surround
back L/R
D
D
Dz 3
Front wide
Front
L/R
height L/R
Top Front
Top
Top Rear
L/R
Middle L/R
L/R
Rear
Height L/R
Front
Dolby
Enabled
L/R
Surround
Dolby
Enabled
L/R
Back
Dolby
Enabled
L/R
Subwoofer
Dz7
Dz3
D
Dz3
Dz7
D
D
D
S
D
D
Dz 3
S
D
D
Dz 4
Dz5
D
DTS Neo:X z2
S
D
D
Audyssey DSX®
S
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D z5
Dz5
D
Dz6
Dz6
D
Dolby Digital
S
D
D
Dolby Digital Plus
S
D
D
Dz3
Dz3
Dz3
Dolby TrueHD
S
D
D
Dz3
Dz3
Dz3
Dolby Atmos
S
D
D
D
D
D
D
DTS Surround
S
D
D
D
DTS 96/24
S
D
D
D
DTS-HD
S
D
D
Dz3
DTS Express
S
D
D
D
Multi Ch Stereo
S
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
Dz3
Dz3
D z5
D z5
D z5
Dz5
Dz5
D z5
Dz5
D
z5
z5
z5
z5
z5
z5
z5
D
Wide Screen
S
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
Super Stadium
S
D
D
D z5
D z5
D z5
Dz5
Dz5
D z5
Dz5
D
Rock Arena
S
D
D
S
D
D
D z5
D z5
D z5
D z5
Dz5
Dz5
Dz5
Dz5
D z5
D z5
Dz5
Dz5
D
Jazz Club
D z5
D z5
Classic Concert
S
D
D
D z5
D z5
D z5
Dz5
Dz5
D z5
Dz5
D
Mono Movie
S
D
D
D z5
D z5
D z5
Dz5
Dz5
D z5
Dz5
D
Video Game
S
D
D
D z5
D z5
D z5
Dz5
Dz5
D z5
Dz5
D
Matrix
S
D
D
D z5
D z5
D z5
Dz5
Dz5
D z5
Dz5
D
Virtual
S
D
D
D
.
Front panel
Display
D
Rear panel
308
Remote
Index
Contents
z1
z2
z3
z4
z5
z6
z7
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
The applicable sound mode includes “Dolby Surround” and sound modes that have “+Dolby Surround” in the sound mode name.
The applicable sound mode includes “DTS Neo:X” and sound modes that have “+Neo:X” in the sound mode name.
A signal for each channel contained in an input signal is output as audio.
Audio is not output when “Speaker Config.” - “Surr. Back” in the menu is set to “1 spkr”. (v p. 231)
Audio is output from the speakers specified in the “Surround Parameter” – “Speaker Select” settings. (v p. 172)
Audio is output from the speakers specified in the “Audyssey DSX®” settings. (v p. 178)
Audio is output when “Subwoofer Mode” in the menu is set to “LFE+Main”. (v p. 237)
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
309
Remote
Index
Appendix
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Sound modes and surround parameters
Surround Parameter
Subwoofer
Level
Adjust
Sound mode
Direct/Pure Direct (2-channel) z4
Direct/Pure Direct (Multi-channel) z4
DSD Direct (2-channel)
Cinema EQ
Dynamic
Loudness
Management Compression
z2
z1
Sz5
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
Low
Frequency
Effects z3
Delay Time
Effect Level
Room Size
Speaker
Select
S
Sz5
DSD Direct (Multi-channel) z4
S
Stereo
S
Multi Ch In
S
S
Dolby Surround
S
S
S
S
DTS Neo:X
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
Audyssey DSX®
S
S
S
S
S
Dolby Digital
S
S
S
S
S
Dolby Digital Plus
S
S
S
S
S
Dolby TrueHD
S
S
S
S
S
Dolby Atmos
S
S
S
S
S
DTS Surround
S
S
S
S
DTS 96/24
S
S
S
DTS-HD
S
S
S
DTS Express
S
S
Multi Ch Stereo
S
S
S
S
Wide Screen
S
S
S
S
S
Super Stadium
S
S
S
S
S
S
Rock Arena
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
Jazz Club
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
Classic Concert
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
Mono Movie
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
Video Game
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
Matrix
S
S
S
S
Virtual
S
S
S
S
S
S
.
z1
- z5 : “Sound modes and surround parameters” (v p. 312)
Front panel
Center
Spread
Display
Rear panel
310
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Surround
Parameter
Center Gain
Playback
Tips
Appendix
Audyssey
Dialog
Enhancer
Tone z6
Stereo
S
Multi Ch In
S
Dolby Surround
Sound mode
Settings
MultEQ®
XT32 z7
Dynamic EQ
z8
Dynamic
Volume z8
Audyssey
LFCTM z8
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
Audyssey
DSX®
Restorer z9
Bass Sync
z10
Direct/Pure Direct (2-channel) z4
Direct/Pure Direct (Multi-channel) z4
DSD Direct (2-channel)
DSD Direct (Multi-channel) z4
DTS Neo:X
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
Audyssey DSX®
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
Dolby Digital
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
Dolby Digital Plus
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
Dolby TrueHD
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
Dolby Atmos
S
S
S
S
S
S
DTS Surround
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
DTS 96/24
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
DTS-HD
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
DTS Express
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
Multi Ch Stereo
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
Wide Screen
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
Super Stadium
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
Rock Arena
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
Jazz Club
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
Classic Concert
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
Mono Movie
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
Video Game
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
Matrix
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
.
Virtual
S
z4, z6
- z9 : “Sound modes and surround parameters” (v p. 312)
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
311
Remote
Index
S
Contents
z1
z2
z3
z4
z5
z6
z7
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
This item can be selected when the Dolby Digital, Dolby Digital Plus, Dolby TrueHD or Dolby Atmos signal is played back.
This item can be selected when the Dolby Digital, Dolby Digital Plus, Dolby TrueHD, Dolby Atmos or DTS is played back.
This item can be selected when a Dolby Digital or DTS signal or DVD-Audio is played.
During playback in Pure Direct mode, the surround parameters are the same as in Direct mode.
This setting is available when “Subwoofer Mode” in the menu is set to “LFE+Main”. (v p. 237)
This item cannot be set when “Dynamic EQ” is set to “On”. (v p. 176)
This item cannot be set when Audyssey® Setup (Speaker Calibration) has not been performed.
z8 This item cannot be set when “MultEQ® XT32” in the menu is set to “Off”. (v p. 175)
z9 This item can be set when the input signal is analog, PCM 48 kHz or 44.1 kHz.
z10 This can be set when the LFE signal is included in the input signal.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
312
Remote
Index
Appendix
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Types of input signals, and corresponding sound modes
.
F This indicates the default sound mode.
S This indicates the selectable sound mode.
2-channel signal
Sound mode
NOTE
Analog /
PCM
Dolby
Digital
(+/HD)
DTS
(-HD)
Multi-channel signal
DSD
(Super
Audio
CD)
PCM
Multi
DTS-HD
DTS
Express
DTS ES
Dscrt6.1
DTS ES
Mtrx6.1
DTS
Dolby
Atmos
Dolby
TrueHD
Dolby
Digital
Plus
Dolby
Digital
(EX)
DTS Surround
DTS-HD MSTR
Fz3
DTS-HD HI RES
Fz4
DTS ES Dscrt6.1
z1
DTS ES Mtrx6.1
z1
F
F
S
DTS Surround
S
DTS 96/24
S
DTS(-HD) + Dolby Surround
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
F
DTS Express
DTS(-HD) + Neo:X
F
Fz 5
S
z2
S
DTS Neo:X
S
F
S
S
Dolby Surround
F
Dolby Atmos
Dolby TrueHD
Sz6
Dolby Digital+
Sz7
Dolby(D+)(HD) + Dolby Surround
S
S
F
F
S
S
Dolby(D)(D+)(HD) + Neo:X
z2
Sz8
S
Dolby Surround
z1
F
S
S
- z8: “Types of input signals, and corresponding sound modes” (v p. 315)
Front panel
F
S
Dolby Digital
Display
Rear panel
313
Remote
Index
S
DSD
(Super
Audio
CD)
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
.
Contents
2-channel signal
Sound mode
NOTE
Analog /
PCM
Dolby
Digital
(+/HD)
DTS
(-HD)
Multi-channel signal
DSD
(Super
Audio
CD)
PCM
Multi
DTS-HD
DTS
Express
DTS ES
Dscrt6.1
DTS ES
Mtrx6.1
DTS
Dolby
Atmos
Dolby
TrueHD
Dolby
Digital
Plus
Dolby
Digital
(EX)
DSD
(Super
Audio
CD)
Multi Ch In
Multi Ch In
F
F
Multi Ch In + Dolby Surround
S
S
S
Multi Ch In + Neo:X
z2
S
Multi Ch In 7.1
z1
Fz10
Audyssey
Audyssey DSX®
S
S
S
S
S
S
Sz8
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
Direct
Direct
Sz9
S
S
DSD Direct
S
S
Pure Direct
Pure Direct
S
S
S
DSD Pure Direct
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
Original sound mode
Multi Ch Stereo
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
Wide Screen
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
Sz8
S
S
S
S
Super Stadium
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
Sz8
S
S
S
S
Rock Arena
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
Sz8
S
S
S
S
Jazz Club
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
Sz8
S
S
S
S
Classic Concert
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
Sz8
S
S
S
S
Mono Movie
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
Sz8
S
S
S
S
Video Game
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
Sz8
S
S
S
S
Matrix
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
Sz8
S
S
S
S
Virtual
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
Sz8
S
S
S
S
F
S
S
F
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
Stereo
Stereo
z1
-
z2, z8
-
z10
: “Types of input signals, and corresponding sound modes” (v p. 315)
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
314
Remote
Index
Contents
z1
z2
z3
z4
z5
z6
z7
z8
z9
z10
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
This item can be selected when surround back speakers are used.
The “Cinema” mode, “Music” mode or “Game” mode can be selected. This item can be selected when using any of the surround back, front height or front wide speaker.
This item can be selected when the input signal is DTS-HD Master Audio.
This item can be selected when the input signal is DTS-HD Hi Resolution.
This item can be selected when the input signal is DTS 96/24.
This can be selected when the Dolby Atmos signal contains the Dolby TrueHD signal.
This can be selected when the Dolby Atmos signal contains the Dolby Digital Plus signal.
This can be selected when the Dolby Atmos signal contains the Dolby TrueHD or Dolby Digital Plus signal.
The default sound mode for the AirPlay playback is “Direct”.
This item can be selected when the input signals contain surround back signals.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
315
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Explanation of terms
Audyssey Dynamic Surround Expansion (A-DSX)
o Audyssey
Audyssey DSX® is a new surround enhancement technology that raises
the surround effect and impression to realize a larger surround space by
adding a new channel to the existing 5.1 channel system.
In research on human hearing characteristics, two points can be broadly
cited as elements that enhance the surround effect. The most important
point is the creation of horizontal spread (wide channel) at the front
(forward) area in composing a realistic surround space. The next
important point is the creation of vertical spread (height channel) in the
front (forward) area using recognizable (audible) acoustic signals so as to
create a surround space with depth.
Audyssey Dynamic EQ®
Dynamic EQ solves the problem of deteriorating sound quality as volume
is decreased by taking into account human perception and room
acoustics.
Audyssey Dynamic EQ® works in tandem with Audyssey MultEQ® XT32
to provide well-balanced sound for every listener at any volume level.
Audyssey DSX® then creates a pair of Height channels to reproduce the
next most important acoustical and perceptual cues. In addition, Audyssey
DSX® does not simply add a channel but combines the existing front,
surround and rear surround sound to develop a technology known as
“Surround Envelopment Processing” which has been incorporated into
Audyssey DSX® to further enhance the effect.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
316
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Dynamic Volume solves the problem of large variations in volume level
between television programs, commercials, and between the soft and loud
passages of movies. Audyssey Dynamic EQ® is integrated into Dynamic
Volume so that as the playback volume is adjusted automatically, the
perceived bass response, tonal balance, surround impression, and dialog
clarity remain the same.
Dolby Atmos
Introduced first in the cinema, Dolby Atmos brings a revolutionary sense of
dimension and immersion to the Home Theater experience. Dolby Atmos
is an adaptable and scalable object based format that reproduces audio
as independent sounds (or objects) that can be accurately positioned and
move dynamically throughout the 3 dimensional listening space during
playback. A key ingredient of Dolby Atmos is the introduction of a height
plane of sound above the listener.
Audyssey LFC™ (Low Frequency Containment)
Audyssey LFC™ solves the problem of low frequency sounds disturbing
people in neighboring rooms or apartments. Audyssey LFC™ dynamically
monitors the audio content and removes the low frequencies that pass
through walls, floors and ceilings. It then applies psychoacoustic
processing to restore the perception of low bass for listeners in the room.
The result is great sound that no longer disturbs the neighbors.
Dolby Atmos Stream
Dolby Atmos content will be delivered to your Dolby Atmos enabled AV
receiver via Dolby Digital Plus or Dolby TrueHD on Blu-ray Disc,
downloadable files and streaming media. A Dolby Atmos stream contains
special metadata that describes the positioning of sounds within the room.
This object audio data is decoded by a Dolby Atmos AV receiver and
scaled for optimum playback through Home Theater speaker systems of
every size and configuration.
Audyssey MultEQ® XT32
Audyssey MultEQ® XT32 is a room equalization solution that calibrates
any audio system so that it can achieve optimum performance for every
listener in a large listening area. Based on several room measurements,
MultEQ® XT32 calculates an equalization solution that corrects for both
time and frequency response problems in the listening area and also
performs a fully automated surround system setup.
Display
Rear panel
Appendix
o Dolby
Audyssey Dynamic Volume®
Front panel
Tips
317
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Dolby Digital
Dolby Surround
Dolby Digital is a multi-channel digital signal format developed by Dolby
Laboratories.
A total of 5.1-channels are played: 3 front channels (“FL”, “FR” and “C”), 2
surround channels (“SL” and “SR”) and the “LFE” channel for low
frequency effects.
Because of this, there is no crosstalk between channels and a realistic
sound field with a “three-dimensional” feeling (sense of distance,
movement and positioning) is achieved. This delivers a thrilling surround
sound experience in the home.
Dolby surround is a next generation surround technology that intelligently
up mixes stereo; 5.1 and 7.1 content for playback through your surround
speaker system. Dolby surround is compatible with traditional speaker
layouts, as well as Dolby Atmos enabled playback systems that employ inceiling speakers or products with Dolby speaker technology.
Dolby Speaker Technology (Dolby Atmos Enabled Speakers)
A convenient alternative to speakers built into the ceiling, Dolby Atmos
Enabled speakers employ the ceiling above you as a reflective surface for
reproducing audio in the height plane above the listener. These speakers
feature a unique upward firing driver and special signal processing. These
features can be built into a conventional speaker or standalone speaker
module. The features minimally impact the overall speaker footprint while
providing an immersive listening experience during Dolby Atmos and
Dolby surround playback.
Dolby Digital Plus
Dolby Digital Plus is an improved Dolby Digital signal format that is
compatible with up to 7.1-channels of discrete digital sound and also
improves sound quality thanks to extra data bit rate performance. It is
upwardly compatible with conventional Dolby Digital, so it offers greater
flexibility in response to the source signal and the conditions of the
playback device.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
318
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
o DTS
Dolby TrueHD
Dolby TrueHD is a high definition audio technology developed by Dolby
Laboratories, using lossless coding technology to faithfully reproduce the
sound of the studio master.
This format provides the facility to support up to 8 audio channels with a
sampling frequency of 96 kHz/24 bit resolution and up to 6 audio channels
with a sampling frequency of 192 kHz/24 bit resolution.
DTS
This is an abbreviation of Digital Theater System, which is a digital audio
system developed by DTS. DTS delivers a powerful and dynamic
surround sound experience, and is found in the world’s finest movie
theaters and screening rooms.
DTS 96/24
DTS 96/24 is a digital audio format enabling high sound quality playback in
5.1-channels with a sampling frequency of 96 kHz and 24 bit quantization
on DVD-Video.
DTS Digital Surround
DTS™ Digital Surround is the standard digital surround format of DTS,
Inc., compatible with a sampling frequency of 44.1 or 48 kHz and up to
5.1-channels of digital discrete surround sound.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
319
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
DTS-ES™ Discrete 6.1
DTS-HD High Resolution Audio
DTS-ES™ Discrete 6.1 is a 6.1-channel discrete digital audio format
adding a surround back (SB) channel to the DTS digital surround sound.
Decoding of conventional 5.1-channel audio signals is also possible
according to the decoder.
DTS-HD High Resolution Audio is an improved version of the conventional
DTS, DTS-ES and DTS 96/24 signals formats, compatible with sampling
frequencies of 96 or 48 kHz and up to 7.1-channels of discrete digital
sound. High data bit rate performance provides high quality sound. This
format is fully compatible with conventional products, including
conventional DTS digital surround 5.1-channel data.
DTS-ES™ Matrix 6.1
DTS-ES™ Matrix 6.1 is a 6.1-channel audio format that inserts a surround
back (SB) channel to the DTS digital surround sound through matrix
encoding. Decoding of conventional 5.1-channel audio signals is also
possible according to the decoder.
DTS-HD Master Audio
DTS Express is an audio format supporting low bit rates (max. 5.1channels, 24 to 256 kbps).
DTS-HD Master Audio is a lossless audio format created by Digital
Theater System (DTS). This format provides the facility to support up to 8
audio channels with a sampling frequency of 96 kHz/24 bit resolution and
up to 6 audio channels with a sampling frequency of 192 kHz/24 bit
resolution. It is fully compatible with conventional products, including
conventional DTS digital surround 5.1-channel data.
DTS-HD
DTS Neo:X
DTS Express
This audio technology provides higher sound quality and enhanced
functionality than the conventional DTS and is adopted as an optional
audio for Blu-ray Disc.
This technology supports multi-channel, high data transfer speed, high
sampling frequency, and lossless audio playback. Maximum 7.1-channels
are supported in Blu-ray Disc.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
This matrix decoding technology uses the DTS Neo:X decoder to
playback 2-channel source or 5.1/6.1/7.1-channel surround sources as a
maximum of 11.1-channel surround sound. There are 3 modes: “Music”
suited for playing music, “Cinema” suited for playing movies, and “Game”
which is optimized for playing games.
320
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
o Audio
Appendix
FLAC (Free Lossless Audio Codec)
FLAC stands for Free lossless Audio Codec, and is a lossless free audio
file format. Lossless means that the audio is compressed without any loss
in quality.
The FLAC license is as shown below.
Copyright (C) 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008,
2009 Josh Coalson
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions are met:
0 Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright notice,
this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
0 Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
0 Neither the name of the Xiph.org Foundation nor the names of its
contributors may be used to endorse or promote products derived from
this software without specific prior written permission.
AL32 Processing Multi Channel
AL32 Processing for All Channels
Denon has further developed its proprietary AL32 Processing, an analog
waveform reproduction technology, to support the 192 kHz sampling
frequency. AL32 Processing, thoroughly suppresses quantization noise
associated with D/A conversion to reproduce the low-level signals with
optimum clarity that will bring out all the delicate nuances of the music.
ALAC (Apple Lossless Audio Codec)
This is a codec for lossless audio compression method developed by
Apple Inc. This codec can be played back on iTunes, iPod or iPhone. Data
compressed to approximately 60 – 70 % can be decompressed to exactly
the same original data.
Bass Sync
Audio sources such as BD and DVD inherently have time delay between
the bass components of the satellite channel and the LFE channel. This
function adjusts such a delay for reproducing (replaying) richer bass
sound during playback. This function is by default set to 0 msec. Since the
delay varies according to the title, play back the audio source and adjust to
the most effective value for playback. For some audio sources that are
played back, this function may have little effect.
Front panel
Tips
Display
Rear panel
321
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND
CONTRIBUTORS “AS IS” AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED
WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED
WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A
PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE
FOUNDATION OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT,
INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR
CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO,
PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF
USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER
CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN
CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE
OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS
SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH
DAMAGE.
Tips
MPEG (Moving Picture Experts Group), MPEG-2, MPEG-4
These are the names for digital compression format standards used for
the encoding of video and audio. Video standards include “MPEG-1
Video”, “MPEG-2 Video”, “MPEG-4 Visual”, “MPEG-4 AVC”. Audio
standards include “MPEG-1 Audio”, “MPEG-2 Audio”, “MPEG-4 AAC”.
WMA (Windows Media Audio)
This is audio compression technology developed by Microsoft
Corporation.
WMA data can be encoded using Windows Media® Player.
To encode WMA files, only use applications authorized by Microsoft
Corporation. If you use an unauthorized application, the file may not work
properly.
LFE
This is an abbreviation of Low Frequency Effect, which is an output
channel that emphasizes low frequency effect sound. Surround audio is
intensified by outputting 20 Hz to 120 Hz deep bass to the system
subwoofer(s).
MP3 (MPEG Audio Layer-3)
This is an internationally standardized audio data compression scheme,
using the “MPEG-1” video compression standard. It compresses the data
volume to about one eleventh its original size while maintaining sound
quality equivalent to a music CD.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
Appendix
322
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
o Video
Sampling frequency
Sampling involves taking a reading of a sound wave (analog signal) at
regular intervals and expressing the height of the wave at each reading in
digitized format (producing a digital signal).
The number of readings taken in one second is called the “sampling
frequency”. The larger the value, the closer the reproduced sound is to the
original.
ISF
ISF (Imaging Science Foundation) is an organization that certifies video
technicians who are then qualified to carry out calibration and adjustment
to match the installation conditions. It also sets quality standards for the
optimization of device video performance.
Speaker impedance
Progressive (sequential scanning)
This is an AC resistance value, indicated in Ω (Ohms).
Greater power can be obtained when this value is smaller.
This is a scanning system of the video signal that displays 1 frame of video
as one image. Compared to the interlace system, this system provides
images with less flickering and jagged edges.
Dialog normalization function
This function operates automatically during playback of Dolby Digital,
Dolby Digital Plus, Dolby TrueHD, Dolby Atmos, DTS or DTS-HD sources.
It automatically corrects the standard signal level for individual program
sources.
Dynamic range
The difference between the maximum undistorted sound level and the
minimum discernible level above the noise emitted by the device.
Downmix
This function converts the number of channels of surround audio to a
lower number of channels and plays back according to the system’s
configuration.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
323
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
o Network
Tips
Appendix
TKIP (Temporal Key Integrity Protocol)
This is a network key used for WPA. The encryption algorithm is RC4, the
same as for WEP, but the security level is increased by changing the
network key used for encryption for each packet.
AES (Advanced Encryption Standard)
This is a next generation standard encryption method replacing the current
DES and 3DES, and because of its high security it is expected to be
applied widely to wireless LANs in the future. It uses the “Rijndael”
algorithm developed by two Belgian cryptographers to divide the data into
blocks of fixed lengths and encrypt each block. It supports data lengths of
128, 192 and 256 bits and key lengths of 128, 192 and 256 bits as well,
offering extremely high encryption security.
vTuner
AirPlay sends (plays) contents recorded in iTunes or on an iPhone/iPod
touch/iPad to a compatible device via the network.
This is a free online content server for Internet Radio.
For inquiries about this service, visit the vTuner site below.
vTuner website:
http://www.radiodenon.com
This product is protected by certain intellectual property rights of Nothing
Else Matters Software and BridgeCo. Use or distribution of such
technology outside of this product is prohibited without a license from
Nothing Else Matters Software and BridgeCo or an authorized subsidiary.
DLNA
WEP Key (network key)
AirPlay
DLNA and DLNA CERTIFIED are trademarks and/or service marks of
Digital Living Network Alliance. Some contents may not be compatible
with other DLNA CERTIFIED® products.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
This is key information used for encrypting data when conducting data
transfer. On this unit, the same WEP key is used for data encryption and
decryption, so the same WEP key must be set on both devices in order for
communications to be established between them.
324
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Wi-Fi®
Network Names (SSID: Security Set Identifier)
Wi-Fi Certification assures tested and proven interoperability by the Wi-Fi
Alliance, a group certifying interoperability among wireless LAN devices.
When forming wireless LAN networks, groups are formed to prevent
interference, data theft, etc. These groups are based on “SSID (network
names)”. For enhanced security, a WEP key is set so that communication
is unavailable unless both the “SSID” and the WEP key match. This is
suitable for temporarily constructing a simplified network.
WPA (Wi-Fi Protected Access)
This is a security standard established by the Wi-Fi Alliance. In addition to
the conventional SSID (network name) and WEP key (network key), it also
uses a user identification function and encrypting protocol for stronger
security.
Modem
Device that connects to your broadband internet provider, and is very
often supplied with the service. A type that is integrated with a router is
also often available.
WPA2 (Wi-Fi Protected Access 2)
This is a new version of the WPA established by the Wi-Fi Alliance,
compatible with more secure AES encryption.
WPA-PSK/WPA2-PSK (Pre-shared Key)
This is a simple authentication system for mutual authentication when a
preset character string matches on the wireless LAN access point and
client.
WPS (Wi-Fi Protected Setup)
This is a standard drawn up by the Wi-Fi Alliance to ease the task of
setting up wireless LAN connections and configuring security. There are
two methods: push-button and PIN (Personal Identification Number) code.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
325
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
o Media player
o Others
iTunes
App Store
iTunes is the name of the multimedia player provided by Apple Inc.
iTunes is the name of the multimedia player provided by Apple Inc. It
enables management and playback of multimedia contents including
music and movies. iTunes supports many main file formats including AAC,
WAV, and MP3.
App Store is a site that sells application software for such devices as the
iPhone or iPod Touch, and is operated by Apple Inc.
Denon Link HD
Denon Link HD uses the clock of the AV amplifier connected by Denon
Link HD to achieve HDMI signal transfer with low jitter.
Windows Media Player
HDCP
This is a media player distributed free of charge by Microsoft Corporation.
It can play playlists created with Ver.11 or later of Windows Media Player,
as well as WMA, WAV, and other files.
When transmitting digital signals between devices, this copyright
protection technology encrypts the signals to prevent content from being
copied without authorization.
MAIN ZONE
The room where this unit is placed is called the MAIN ZONE.
ZONE2
This unit can operate in a room other than the room where this unit is
placed (MAIN ZONE) (ZONE2 playback). The room for ZONE2 playback
is called ZONE2.
ZONE3
This unit can operate in a room other than the room where this unit is
placed (MAIN ZONE) (ZONE3 playback). The room for ZONE3 playback
is called ZONE3.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
326
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Pairing
Pairing (registration) is an operation that is required in order to connect a
Bluetooth device to this unit using Bluetooth. When paired, the devices
authenticate each other and can connect without mistaken connections
occurring.
When using Bluetooth connection for the first time, you need to pair this
unit and the Bluetooth device to be connected.
This unit can store pairing information for a maximum of 8 devices.
Protection circuit
This is a function to prevent damage to devices within the power supply
when an abnormality such as an overload, excess voltage occurs or over
temperature for any reason.
If a malfunction occurs in this unit, the power indicator blinks red and the
unit switches to standby mode.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
327
Remote
Index
Appendix
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Trademark information
.
.
Manufactured under license from Audyssey Laboratories™. U.S. and
foreign patents pending. Audyssey MultEQ® XT32, Audyssey Dynamic
EQ®, Audyssey Dynamic Volume®, Audyssey DSX® and Audyssey
LFC™ are registered trademarks of Audyssey Laboratories.
.
“Made for iPod” and “Made for iPhone” mean that an electronic accessory
has been designed to connect specifically to iPod, or iPhone,
respectively, and has been certified by the developer to meet Apple
performance standards.
Apple is not responsible for the operation of this device or its compliance
with safety and regulatory standards. Please note that the use of this
accessory with iPod, or iPhone, may affect wireless performance.
AirPlay, the AirPlay logo, iPad, iPhone, iPod, iPod classic, iPod nano,
iPod shuffle and iPod touch are trademarks of Apple Inc., registered in
the U.S. and other countries.
0 Individual users are permitted to use iPhone, iPod, iPod classic, iPod
nano, iPod shuffle, and iPod touch for private copy and playback of
non-copyrighted contents and contents whose copy and playback is
permitted by law. Copyright infringement is prohibited by law.
.
The Bluetooth® word mark and logos are registered trademarks owned
by Bluetooth SIG, Inc. and any use of such marks by D&M Holdings Inc.
is under license. Other trademarks and trade names are those of their
respective owners.
Manufactured under license from Dolby Laboratories. Dolby, Dolby
Atmos, Dolby Surround, and the double-D symbol are trademarks of
Dolby Laboratories.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
328
Remote
Index
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
.
Contents
For DTS patents, see http://patents.dts.com. Manufactured under license
from DTS Licensing Limited. DTS, DTS-HD, the Symbol, & DTS and the
Symbol together are registered trademarks, and DTS-HD Master Audio
and DTS Neo:X | 11.1 are a trademark of DTS, Inc. © DTS, Inc. All Rights
Reserved.
.
.
The Wi-Fi CERTIFIED logo is a registered trademark of the Wi-Fi
Alliance.
Wi-Fi Certification provides assurance that the device has passed the
interoperability test conducted by the Wi-Fi Alliance, a group that certifies
interoperability among wireless LAN devices.
.
The terms HDMI and HDMI High-Definition Multimedia Interface, and the
HDMI Logo are trademarks or registered trademarks of HDMI Licensing
LLC in the United States and other countries.
Adobe, the Adobe logo and Reader are either registered trademarks or
trademarks of Adobe Systems Incorporated in the United States and/or
other countries.
This item incorporates copy protection technology that is protected by
U.S. patents and other intellectual property rights of Rovi Corporation.
Reverse engineering and disassembly are prohibited.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
329
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Specifications
o Audio section
0 Power amplifier
Rated output:
Front:
150 W + 150 W (8 Ω/ohms, 20 Hz – 20 kHz with 0.05% T.H.D.)
190 W + 190 W (6 Ω/ohms, 1 kHz with 0.7 % T.H.D.)
Center:
150 W (8 Ω/ohms, 20 Hz – 20 kHz with 0.05% T.H.D.)
190 W (6 Ω/ohms, 1 kHz with 0.7 % T.H.D.)
Surround:
150 W + 150 W (8 Ω/ohms, 20 Hz – 20 kHz with 0.05% T.H.D.)
190 W + 190 W (6 Ω/ohms, 1 kHz with 0.7 % T.H.D.)
Surround back:
150 W + 150 W (8 Ω/ohms, 20 Hz – 20 kHz with 0.05% T.H.D.)
190 W + 190 W (6 Ω/ohms, 1 kHz with 0.7 % T.H.D.)
Height 1 / Front wide/height 2:
150 W + 150 W (8 Ω/ohms, 20 Hz – 20 kHz with 0.05% T.H.D.)
190 W + 190 W (6 Ω/ohms, 1 kHz with 0.7 % T.H.D.)
Dynamic power:
170W x 2-channel (8 Ω/ohms)
280W x 2-channel (4 Ω/ohms)
Output connectors:
Front panel
4 – 16 Ω/ohms
Display
Rear panel
330
Remote
Index
Appendix
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
0 Analog
Input sensitivity/Input impedance:
200 mV/47 kΩ/kohms
Frequency response:
10 Hz – 100 kHz — +1, –3 dB (Direct mode)
S/N:
102 dB (IHF–A weighted, Direct mode)
Distortion:
0.005 % (20 Hz – 20 kHz) (Direct mode)
Rated output:
1.2 V
0 Digital
D/A output:
Rated output — 2 V (at 0 dB playback)
Total harmonic distortion — 0.008 % (1 kHz, at 0 dB)
S/N ratio — 102 dB
Dynamic range — 100 dB
Digital input:
Format — Digital audio interface
0 Phono equalizer
Input sensitivity:
2.5 mV
RIAA deviation:
±1 dB (20 Hz to 20 kHz)
S/N:
74 dB (IHF-A)
Distortion factor:
0.03 % (1 kHz, 3 V)
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
331
Remote
Index
Appendix
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
o Video section
0 Standard video connectors
Input/output level and impedance:
1 Vp-p, 75 Ω/ohms
Frequency response:
5 Hz – 10 MHz — 0, –3 dB
0 Color component video connector
Input/output level and impedance:
Y signal — 1 Vp-p, 75 Ω/ohms
PB / CB signal — 0.7 Vp-p, 75 Ω/ohms
PR / CR signal — 0.7 Vp-p, 75 Ω/ohms
Frequency response:
5 Hz – 60 MHz — 0, –3 dB
o Tuner section
[FM]
[AM]
(Note: μV at 75 Ω/ohms, 0 dBf = 1 x 10 –15 W)
Reception frequency range:
87.5 MHz – 108.0 MHz
522 kHz – 1611 kHz
Effective sensitivity:
1.2 μV (12.8 dBf)
18 μV
50 dB sensitivity:
MONO ― 2.8 μV (20.2 dBf)
S/N ratio (IHF-A):
MONO ― 70 dB (IHF–A weighted, Direct mode)
STEREO ― 67 dB (IHF–A weighted, Direct mode)
Distortion (1 kHz):
MONO ― 0.7 % (1 kHz)
STEREO ― 1.0 % (1 kHz)
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
332
Remote
Index
Appendix
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
o Wireless LAN section
Network type (wireless LAN standard):
Conforming to Wi-Fi®z1
Security:
WEP 64 bit, WEP 128 bit
WPA/WPA2-PSK (AES)
WPA/WPA2-PSK (TKIP)
Radio frequency:
2.4 GHz
No. of channels:
1 – 13 ch
z1 The Wi-Fi® CERTIFIED Logo and the Wi-Fi CERTIFIED On-Product Logo are registered trademarks of the Wi-Fi Alliance.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
333
Remote
Index
Appendix
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
o Bluetooth section
Communications system:
Bluetooth Version 2.1 + EDR (Enhanced Data Rate)
Transmission power:
Maximum 2.5 mW (Class 2)
Maximum communication range:
Approx. 10 m in line of sightz2
Frequency band:
2.4 GHz band
Modulation scheme:
FHSS (Frequency-Hopping Spread Spectrum)
Supported profiles:
A2DP (Advanced Audio Distribution Profile) 1.2
AVRCP (Audio Video Remote Control Profile) 1.4
Corresponding codec:
SBC, AAC
Transmission range (A2DP):
20 Hz - 20,000 Hz
z2 The actual communication range varies depending on the influence of such factors as obstructions between devices, electromagnetic waves from
microwave ovens, static electricity, cordless phones, reception sensitivity, antenna performance, operating system, application software etc.
o General
Power supply:
AC 230 V, 50/60 Hz
Power consumption:
780W
Power consumption in standby mode:
0.1 W
Power consumption in CEC standby
mode:
0.5 W
Power consumption in network standby
mode:
4.5 W
For purposes of improvement, specifications and design are subject to change without notice.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
334
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
25
22
65
245
427
383
73
22
o Dimensions (Unit : mm)
60
344
259
45
.
45
196
16
180
434
o Weight: 17.8 kg
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
335
Remote
Index
Appendix
Contents
Connections
Index
Playback
Settings
vB
11.1-channel ............................................ 44, 53
3D ................................................................ 299
4K ................................................................ 299
5.1-channel .................................. 34, 41, 50, 51
7.1-channel .................................. 33, 42, 47, 48
9.1-channel .............................................. 43, 46
vA
Accessories ..................................................... 8
Add New Feature ......................................... 257
Adjusting the volume ...................................... 79
Adjusting volume of each channel ................ 126
AirPlay .......................................................... 116
All Zone Stereo ............................................ 130
Audio formats ....................... 301, 304, 306, 307
Audio settings ....................................... 161, 167
Audyssey DSX® .......................................... 316
Audyssey Dynamic EQ® ............................. 316
Denon Link HD ............................................. 326
Direct sound mode ....................................... 139
vC
Cables ............................................................ 28
Connecting a Blu-ray Disc player ................... 62
Connecting a cable TV ................................... 61
Connecting a DVD player ............................... 62
Connecting a game console ........................... 64
Connecting a satellite tuner ............................ 61
Display ........................................................... 19
DLNA ........................................................... 324
Dolby Atmos ................................................. 317
Dolby sound mode ............................... 135, 318
DTS sound mode ................................. 136, 319
vE
Connecting a set-top box ............................... 61
ECO Mode ................................................... 248
Connecting a TV ................................. 57, 58, 59
Error messages (Audyssey® Setup) ............ 208
Connecting a video camera ........................... 64
Explanation of terms/technology .......... 299, 316
Connecting an external control device ........... 74
Connecting an iPod ........................................ 67
Connecting an USB memory device .............. 67
Connecting a Denon Link HD ......................... 63
Connecting an FM/AM antenna ...................... 70
Connecting a power cord ............................... 76
Connecting to a home network (LAN) ............ 72
Connecting ZONE2/ZONE3 ................... 49, 154
Audyssey Dynamic Volume® ...................... 317
vF
Firmware Update .......................................... 256
Front panel ..................................................... 15
vG
General settings ................................... 163, 248
vH
HDCP ........................................................... 301
Audyssey MultEQ® XT32 ............................ 317
HDMI Control ....................................... 146, 186
Audyssey settings ................................ 175, 202
Audyssey® Setup ........................................ 200
Auto Standby ............................................... 249
Front panel
Display
Appendix
vD
Bi-amp connection ......................................... 45
v Numerics
Tips
Rear panel
336
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
vI
Playback
Settings
vO
Input Assign ................................................. 195
Input signal ................................................... 313
Input source settings ............................ 162, 195
Inputting characters ...................................... 165
Inserting the batteries ....................................... 9
iPod Browse Mode ......................................... 82
iTunes .......................................................... 326
vJ
JPEG ...................................................... 85, 108
vL
Listening to FM/AM broadcasts ...................... 94
Listening to Spotify ....................................... 119
vP
Menu map .................................................... 161
Quick select plus .......................................... 149
vR
Pairing a Bluetooth device ........................ 89, 92
Random playback .................................. 84, 121
PCM multi-channel sound mode .................. 137
Rear panel ...................................................... 21
Picture Mode ................................................ 129
Remote control unit ........................................ 24
Playing back a Bluetooth device .................... 90
Remove from Favorites ................................ 123
Playing back a Blu-ray Disc player ................. 79
Repeat playback .................................... 84, 121
Playing back a DVD player ............................. 79
Resetting factory settings ............................. 298
Playing back an iPod ...................................... 80
Restorer ....................................................... 173
Playing back from PC ................................... 108
Playing back Internet Radio ......................... 104
Playing back NAS ........................................ 108
Playing back USB memory device ................. 85
Playing back ZONE2/ZONE3 ....................... 154
vM
Appendix
vQ
Original sound mode .................................... 138
Playing back Flickr ....................................... 115
Listening position ......................................... 200
Tips
Protection circuit .......................................... 327
Pure Direct ................................................... 133
vN
vS
Save to Favorites ......................................... 122
Selecting the input source .............................. 78
Setup Assistant ............................................ 163
Sleep timer ................................................... 147
Slideshow .................................................... 124
Slideshow Interval ........................................ 125
Sound mode ................................. 132, 308, 310
Speaker connection ....................................... 29
Network settings ................................... 241, 241
Speaker Settings .................................. 162, 200
Stereo sound mode ...................................... 139
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
337
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
vT
Text Search .................................................. 123
Tips .............................................................. 278
Tone Control ................................................ 127
Troubleshooting ........................................... 280
Turning off the sound temporarily (Muting) ..... 79
Turning the power on ..................................... 78
vV
Video Conversion ................................. 189, 302
Video Select ................................................. 128
Video settings ....................................... 161, 181
vW
Web control .................................................. 152
Wi-Fi settings ............................................... 242
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
338
Remote
Index
Appendix
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
License
This section describes software license used for this unit.
To maintain the correct content, the original (English) is used.
Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining a copy of this
software and associated documentation files (the “Software”), to deal in the Software
without restriction, including without limitation the rights to use, copy, modify, merge,
publish, distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies of the Software, and to permit
persons to whom the Software is furnished to do so, subject to the following
conditions:
The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be included in all copies
or substantial portions of the Software.
o Boost
http://www.boost.org/
Boost Software License – Version 1.0 – August 17th, 2003
Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person or organization obtaining
a copy of the software and accompanying documentation covered by this license
(the “Software”) to use, reproduce, display, distribute, execute, and transmit the
Software, and to prepare derivative works of the Software, and to permit third-parties
to whom the Software is furnished to do so, all subject to the following:
THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED “AS IS”, WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND,
EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES
OF MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND
NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT
HOLDERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY,
WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING
FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR
OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE.
The copyright notices in the Software and this entire statement, including the above
license grant, this restriction and the following disclaimer, must be included in all
copies of the Software, in whole or in part, and all derivative works of the Software,
unless such copies or derivative works are solely in the form of machine-executable
object code generated by a source language processor.
THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED “AS IS”, WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND,
EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES
OF MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE, TITLE AND
NON-INFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS OR
ANYONE DISTRIBUTING THE SOFTWARE BE LIABLE FOR ANY DAMAGES OR
OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING
FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR
OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE.
o FastDelegate
http://www.codeproject.com/KB/cpp/FastDelegate.aspx
THE WORK (AS DEFINED BELOW) IS PROVIDED UNDER THE TERMS OF THIS
CODE PROJECT OPEN LICENSE (“LICENSE”). THE WORK IS PROTECTED BY
COPYRIGHT AND/OR OTHER APPLICABLE LAW. ANY USE OF THE WORK
OTHER THAN AS AUTHORIZED UNDER THIS LICENSE OR COPYRIGHT LAW IS
PROHIBITED.
o Expat
BY EXERCISING ANY RIGHTS TO THE WORK PROVIDED HEREIN, YOU
ACCEPT AND AGREE TO BE BOUND BY THE TERMS OF THIS LICENSE. THE
AUTHOR GRANTS YOU THE RIGHTS CONTAINED HEREIN IN CONSIDERATION
OF YOUR ACCEPTANCE OF SUCH TERMS AND CONDITIONS. IF YOU DO NOT
AGREE TO ACCEPT AND BE BOUND BY THE TERMS OF THIS LICENSE, YOU
CANNOT MAKE ANY USE OF THE WORK.
http://www.jclark.com/xml/expat.html
Expat License. Copyright (c) 1998, 1999, 2000 Thai Open Source Software Center
Ltd
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
339
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Definitions. “Articles” means, collectively, all articles written by Author which
describes how the Source Code and Executable Files for the Work may be used by a
user.
“Author” means the individual or entity that offers the Work under the terms of this
License.
“Derivative Work” means a work based upon the Work or upon the Work and other
pre-existing works.
“Executable Files” refer to the executables, binary files, configuration and any
required data files included in the Work.
“Publisher” means the provider of the website, magazine, CD-ROM, DVD or other
medium from or by which the Work is obtained by You.
“Source Code” refers to the collection of source code and configuration files used to
create the Executable Files.
“Standard Version” refers to such a Work if it has not been modified, or has been
modified in accordance with the consent of the Author, such consent being in the full
discretion of the Author.
“Work” refers to the collection of files distributed by the Publisher, including the
Source Code, Executable Files, binaries, data files, documentation, whitepapers and
the Articles.
“You” is you, an individual or entity wishing to use the Work and exercise your rights
under this License.
Display
Rear panel
Appendix
You may otherwise modify Your copy of this Work (excluding the Articles) in any way
to create a Derivative Work, provided that You insert a prominent notice in each
changed file stating how, when and where You changed that file.
You may distribute the standard version of the Executable Files and Source Code or
Derivative Work in aggregate with other (possibly commercial) programs as part of a
larger (possibly commercial) software distribution.
The Articles discussing the Work published in any form by the author may not be
distributed or republished without the Author’s consent. The author retains copyright
to any such Articles. You may use the Executable Files and Source Code pursuant to
this License but you may not repost or republish or otherwise distribute or make
available the Articles, without the prior written consent of the Author.
Any subroutines or modules supplied by You and linked into the Source Code or
Executable Files this Work shall not be considered part of this Work and will not be
subject to the terms of this License.
Patent License. Subject to the terms and conditions of this License, each Author
hereby grants to You a perpetual, worldwide, non-exclusive, no-charge, royalty-free,
irrevocable (except as stated in this section) patent license to make, have made, use,
import, and otherwise transfer the Work.
Restrictions. The license granted in Section 3 above is expressly made subject to
and limited by the following restrictions: You agree not to remove any of the original
copyright, patent, trademark, and attribution notices and associated disclaimers that
may appear in the Source Code or Executable Files.
You agree not to advertise or in any way imply that this Work is a product of Your
own.
The name of the Author may not be used to endorse or promote products derived
from the Work without the prior written consent of the Author.
You agree not to sell, lease, or rent any part of the Work. This does not restrict you
from including the Work or any part of the Work inside a larger software distribution
that itself is being sold. The Work by itself, though, cannot be sold, leased or rented.
Fair Use/Fair Use Rights. Nothing in this License is intended to reduce, limit, or
restrict any rights arising from fair use, fair dealing, first sale or other limitations on the
exclusive rights of the copyright owner under copyright law or other applicable laws.
License Grant. Subject to the terms and conditions of this License, the Author hereby
grants You a worldwide, royalty-free, non-exclusive, perpetual (for the duration of the
applicable copyright) license to exercise the rights in the Work as stated below: You
may use the standard version of the Source Code or Executable Files in Your own
applications.
You may apply bug fixes, portability fixes and other modifications obtained from the
Public Domain or from the Author. A Work modified in such a way shall still be
considered the standard version and will be subject to this License.
Front panel
Tips
340
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
You may distribute the Executable Files and Source Code only under the terms of
this License, and You must include a copy of, or the Uniform Resource Identifier for,
this License with every copy of the Executable Files or Source Code You distribute
and ensure that anyone receiving such Executable Files and Source Code agrees
that the terms of this License apply to such Executable Files and/or Source Code.
You may not offer or impose any terms on the Work that alter or restrict the terms of
this License or the recipients’ exercise of the rights granted hereunder. You may not
sublicense the Work. You must keep intact all notices that refer to this License and to
the disclaimer of warranties. You may not distribute the Executable Files or Source
Code with any technological measures that control access or use of the Work in a
manner inconsistent with the terms of this License.
You agree not to use the Work for illegal, immoral or improper purposes, or on pages
containing illegal, immoral or improper material. The Work is subject to applicable
export laws. You agree to comply with all such laws and regulations that may apply to
the Work after Your receipt of the Work.
Display
Rear panel
Appendix
This License and the rights granted hereunder will terminate automatically upon any
breach by You of any term of this License. Individuals or entities who have received
Derivative Works from You under this License, however, will not have their licenses
terminated provided such individuals or entities remain in full compliance with those
licenses. Sections 1, 2, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10 and 11 will survive any termination of this
License.
If You bring a copyright, trademark, patent or any other infringement claim against
any contributor over infringements You claim are made by the Work, your License
from such contributor to the Work ends automatically.
Subject to the above terms and conditions, this License is perpetual (for the duration
of the applicable copyright in the Work). Notwithstanding the above, the Author
reserves the right to release the Work under different license terms or to stop
distributing the Work at any time; provided, however that any such election will not
serve to withdraw this License (or any other license that has been, or is required to
be, granted under the terms of this License), and this License will continue in full
force and effect unless terminated as stated above.
Representations, Warranties and Disclaimer. THIS WORK IS PROVIDED “AS IS”,
“WHERE IS” AND “AS AVAILABLE”, WITHOUT ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED
WARRANTIES OR CONDITIONS OR GUARANTEES. YOU, THE USER, ASSUME
ALL RISK IN ITS USE, INCLUDING COPYRIGHT INFRINGEMENT, PATENT
INFRINGEMENT, SUITABILITY, ETC. AUTHOR EXPRESSLY DISCLAIMS ALL
EXPRESS, IMPLIED OR STATUTORY WARRANTIES OR CONDITIONS,
INCLUDING WITHOUT LIMITATION, WARRANTIES OR CONDITIONS OF
MERCHANTABILITY, MERCHANTABLE QUALITY OR FITNESS FOR A
PARTICULAR PURPOSE, OR ANY WARRANTY OF TITLE OR NONINFRINGEMENT, OR THAT THE WORK (OR ANY PORTION THEREOF) IS
CORRECT, USEFUL, BUG-FREE OR FREE OF VIRUSES. YOU MUST PASS THIS
DISCLAIMER ON WHENEVER YOU DISTRIBUTE THE WORK OR DERIVATIVE
WORKS.
Indemnity. You agree to defend, indemnify and hold harmless the Author and the
Publisher from and against any claims, suits, losses, damages, liabilities, costs, and
expenses (including reasonable legal or attorneys’ fees) resulting from or relating to
any use of the Work by You.
Limitation on Liability. EXCEPT TO THE EXTENT REQUIRED BY APPLICABLE
LAW, IN NO EVENT WILL THE AUTHOR OR THE PUBLISHER BE LIABLE TO YOU
ON ANY LEGAL THEORY FOR ANY SPECIAL, INCIDENTAL, CONSEQUENTIAL,
PUNITIVE OR EXEMPLARY DAMAGES ARISING OUT OF THIS LICENSE OR THE
USE OF THE WORK OR OTHERWISE, EVEN IF THE AUTHOR OR THE
PUBLISHER HAS BEEN ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGES.
Termination.
Front panel
Tips
Publisher. The parties hereby confirm that the Publisher shall not, under any
circumstances, be responsible for and shall not have any liability in respect of the
subject matter of this License. The Publisher makes no warranty whatsoever in
connection with the Work and shall not be liable to You or any party on any legal
theory for any damages whatsoever, including without limitation any general, special,
incidental or consequential damages arising in connection to this license. The
Publisher reserves the right to cease making the Work available to You at any time
without notice
Miscellaneous
This License shall be governed by the laws of the location of the head office of the
Author or if the Author is an individual, the laws of location of the principal place of
residence of the Author.
If any provision of this License is invalid or unenforceable under applicable law, it
shall not affect the validity or enforceability of the remainder of the terms of this
License, and without further action by the parties to this License, such provision shall
be reformed to the minimum extent necessary to make such provision valid and
enforceable.
341
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
http://www.xiph.org/vorbis/
Copyright (c) 2002-2004 Xiph.org Foundation
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without modification, are
permitted provided that the following conditions are met:
0 Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright notice, this list of
conditions and the following disclaimer.
0 Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright notice, this list
of conditions and the following disclaimer in the documentation and/or other
materials provided with the distribution.
0 Neither the name of the Xiph.org Foundation nor the names of its contributors may
be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software without
specific prior written permission.
o libogg
http://www.xiph.org/ogg/
Copyright (c) 2002, Xiph.org Foundation
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without modification, are
permitted provided that the following conditions are met:
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND
CONTRIBUTORS “AS IS” AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES,
INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF
MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE
DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE FOUNDATION OR CONTRIBUTORS BE
LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR
CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO,
PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA,
OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON
ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR
TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT
OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
SUCH DAMAGE.
0 Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright notice, this list of
conditions and the following disclaimer.
0 Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright notice, this list
of conditions and the following disclaimer in the documentation and/or other
materials provided with the distribution.
0 Neither the name of the Xiph.org Foundation nor the names of its contributors may
be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software without
specific prior written permission.
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND
CONTRIBUTORS “AS IS” AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES,
INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF
MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE
DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE FOUNDATION OR CONTRIBUTORS BE
LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR
CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO,
PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA,
OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON
ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR
TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT
OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
SUCH DAMAGE.
Display
Rear panel
Appendix
o libvorbis
No term or provision of this License shall be deemed waived and no breach
consented to unless such waiver or consent shall be in writing and signed by the
party to be charged with such waiver or consent.
This License constitutes the entire agreement between the parties with respect to the
Work licensed herein. There are no understandings, agreements or representations
with respect to the Work not specified herein. The Author shall not be bound by any
additional provisions that may appear in any communication from You. This License
may not be modified without the mutual written agreement of the Author and You
Front panel
Tips
o Tremolo
http://wss.co.uk/pinknoise/tremolo
Copyright (C) 2002 – 2009 Xiph.org Foundation Changes Copyright (C) 2009 – 2010
Robin Watts for Pinknoise Productions Ltd
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without modification, are
permitted provided that the following conditions are met:
342
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
0 Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright notice, this list of
conditions and the following disclaimer.
0 Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright notice, this list
of conditions and the following disclaimer in the documentation and/or other
materials provided with the distribution.
0 Neither the name of the Xiph.org Foundation nor the names of its contributors may
be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software without
specific prior written permission.
o Mersenne Twister
http://www.math.sci.hiroshima-u.ac.jp/~m-mat/MT/MT2002/CODES/mt19937ar.c
Copyright (C) 1997 – 2002, Makoto Matsumoto and Takuji Nishimura,
All rights reserved.
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without modification, are
permitted provided that the following conditions are met:
Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright notice, this list of
conditions and the following disclaimer.
Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright notice, this list of
conditions and the following disclaimer in the documentation and/or other materials
provided with the distribution.
The names of its contributors may not be used to endorse or promote products
derived from this software without specific prior written permission.
o Tremor
http://wiki.xiph.org/index.php/Tremor
Copyright (c) 2002, Xiph.org Foundation
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without modification, are
permitted provided that the following conditions are met:
0 Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright notice, this list of
conditions and the following disclaimer.
0 Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright notice, this list
of conditions and the following disclaimer in the documentation and/or other
materials provided with the distribution.
0 Neither the name of the Xiph.org Foundation nor the names of its contributors may
be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software without
specific prior written permission.
Display
Rear panel
Appendix
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND
CONTRIBUTORS “AS IS” AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES,
INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF
MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE
DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE FOUNDATION OR CONTRIBUTORS BE
LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR
CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO,
PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA,
OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON
ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR
TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT
OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
SUCH DAMAGE.
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND
CONTRIBUTORS “AS IS” AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES,
INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF
MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE
DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE FOUNDATION OR CONTRIBUTORS BE
LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR
CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO,
PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA,
OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON
ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR
TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT
OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
SUCH DAMAGE.
Front panel
Tips
343
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
http://curl.haxx.se
COPYRIGHT AND PERMISSION NOTICE
Copyright (c) 1996 – 2011, Daniel Stenberg, <daniel@haxx.se>.
All rights reserved.
Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software for any purpose with or
without fee is hereby granted, provided that the above copyright notice and this
permission notice appear in all copies.
THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED “AS IS”, WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND,
EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES
OF MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND
NONINFRINGEMENT OF THIRD PARTY RIGHTS. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE
AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES
OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OR
OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE
SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE.
o zlib
http://www.zlib.net/
zlib.h -- interface of the “zlib” general purpose compression library version 1.2.3, July
18th, 2005
Except as contained in this notice, the name of a copyright holder shall not be used in
advertising or otherwise to promote the sale, use or other dealings in this Software
without prior written authorization of the copyright holder.
Copyright (C) 1995 – 2004 Jean-loup Gailly and Mark Adler
This software is provided “as-is”, without any express or implied warranty. In no event
will the authors be held liable for any damages arising from the use of this software.
o c-ares
Permission is granted to anyone to use this software for any purpose, including
commercial applications, and to alter it and redistribute it freely, subject to the
following restrictions:
http://c-ares.haxx.se
Copyright 1998 by the Massachusetts Institute of Technology.
The origin of this software must not be misrepresented; you must not claim that you
wrote the original software. If you use this software in a product, an acknowledgment
in the product documentation would be appreciated but is not required.
Altered source versions must be plainly marked as such, and must not be
misrepresented as being the original software.
This notice may not be removed or altered from any source distribution.
Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software and its documentation
for any purpose and without fee is hereby granted, provided that the above copyright
notice appear in all copies and that both that copyright notice and this permission
notice appear in supporting documentation, and that the name of M.I.T. not be used
in advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the software without specific,
written prior permission. M.I.T. makes no representations about the suitability of this
software for any purpose. It is provided “as is” without express or implied warranty.
Jean-loup Gailly jloup@gzip.org, Mark Adler madler@alumni.caltech.edu
Display
Rear panel
Appendix
o cURL
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND
CONTRIBUTORS “AS IS” AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES,
INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF
MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE
DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE COPYRIGHT OWNER OR
CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL,
SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT
NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES;
LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER
CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT,
STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE)
ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF
ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.
Front panel
Tips
344
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
o License information for the software used in
the unit
About GPL (GNU-General Public License), LGPL (GNU Lesser
General Public License) License
This product uses GPL/LGPL software and software made by other
companies.
After you purchase this product, you may procure, modify or distribute
the source code of the GPL/LGPL software that is used in the product.
Denon provides the source code based on the GPL and LPGL
licenses at the actual cost upon your request to our customer service
center.
However, note that we make no guarantees concerning the source
code.
Please also understand that we do not offer support for the contents of
the source code.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
345
Remote
Index
Appendix
.
www.denon.com
346
D&M Holdings Inc.
3520 10312 00AD